113 24 95MB
English Pages 504 Year 1983
TM 9-1440-600-10
DI01.11: 9-1440-600-10/rep.
OPERATOR'S MANUAL
LAUNCHING STATION M901
TABLE OF CONTENTS
GUIDED MISSILE SEMITRAILER MOUNTED HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION
UNIVERSITY OF VIRGINIA LIBRARY
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND
X004787122
INDICATORS
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE CHECKS AND SERVICES
EMPLACEMENT
MARCH ORDER
Y
R
A
R
B
I
L MAN ALDER D OCU P REF UBLIC DEPARMENTS ERE TME NCE NT
1 R 25 985
AP
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD
VE
IA
RS
IT
O Y
IN
F RG VI
OPERATION UNDER UNUSUAL CONDITIONS
This copy is a reprint which includes current
pages from
Change 1 .
PATRIOT AIR DEFENSE GUIDED MISSILE SYSTEM HEADQUARTERS , DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY
DECEMBER 1983
TM 9-1440-600-10
RECORD OF CHANGES
CHANGE NO.
DATE
TITLE OR BRIEF DESCRIPTION
ENTERED BY
TM 9-1440-600-10
WARNING
DANGEROUS VOLTAGE
is used to operate this equipment
DEATH ON CONTACT
may result if safety precautions are not observed .
Never work on electronic equipment unless there is another person nearby who is familiar with the
operation
and
hazards
of the
equipment and
is
able to give first aid . When the technician is aided by operators , he must warn them about dangerous areas .
When possible, shut off power to the equipment before beginning work on equipment. Ground every capacitor likely to hold a dangerous potential . When working inside equipment, after power has been turned off, always ground every part before touching it.
Be careful not to contact high-voltage connections when
installing or op-
erating this equipment.
When possible, keep one hand away from the equipment to reduce the hazard of current flowing through the vital organs of the body.
Do not be misled by the term "low voltage. " Under adverse WARNING
conditions potentials as low as 50 volts may cause death .
a
TM 9-1440-600-10
INSTRUCTIONS FOR ARTIFICIAL RESPIRATION
(Extracted (with modifications ) from FM 21-11 , First Aid for Soldiers)
a.
Take a deep breath , open your mouth wide ,
and
make an airtight seal around the
casualty's nose , using one of the techniques shown in the figure.
b.
With your eyes focused on the casualty's chest , blow forcefully into the airway (mouth or nose). Rising of the casualty's chest indicates that the air is reaching the lungs . In this case, the procedure is continued . If the chest does not rise , corrective action must be taken . First , hold the jaw up more forcefully and blow harder , making sure that the air is not leaking from the mouth or nose . If the chest still does not rise , recheck the mouth for foreign matter. If necessary , turn the casualty on one side . Strike the casualty between the shoulders with considerable force , repeatedly if necessary , to dislodge obstruction in the airway; then resume attempts to inflate lungs .
C.
Remove your mouth from the casualty's airway opening and listen for the return of air . If the casualty's exhalation is noisy , elevate the jaw more.
d.
After each exhalation of air from the casualty's lungs , blow another deep breath into the airway. Make the first five to ten breaths deep and give them at a rapid rate in order to provide fast reoxygenation . Thereafter, give the breaths at a rate of 12 to 20 per minute until the casualty is able to breathe satisfactorily or until you are positive life is gone . A smooth rhythm is desired but split - second timing is not essential . As the casualty attempts to breathe , adjust the timing of your efforts to assist.
Le WARNING
After a period of resuscitation , the casualty's abdomen may bulge indicating that some of the air is going into the stomach . Since inflation of the stomach makes it more difficult to inflate the lungs , apply gentle pressure to the abdomen with your hand between inflations .
If your breathing at the start has been very deep and rapid , you may become faint , tingle , or even lose consciousness if you persist. After administering the first five to ten deep , rapid breaths , you should adjust your breathing to a rate of 12 to 20 times a minute , with only moderate increase in normal volume so that you will be able to continue to give artificial respiration for a long period without temporary ill effects .
b
TM 9-1440-600-10
a.
b.
a.
NOSE SEALED WITH THUMB AND FINGER
b.
NOSE SEALED WITH CHEEK
MOUTH-TO-MOUTH ARTIFICIAL RESPIRATION
c
M 9-1440-600-10
A Le WARNING
HIGH NOISE LEVEL
When the radar set , engagement control station , electric power plant, electric power unit, communications relay group , and launching station are operating , potentially dangerous noise
levels exist. Without protection ,
to this noise may cause a hearing
loss .
long exposure
Use ear protectors when working
within 10 meters of any of the equipment. See AR 40-5 for additional formation .
in-
During live fire exercises or operations , approved ear protection must be worn by unsheltered personnel within 800 feet WARNING
(244 meters) of a launching station to prevent loss of hearing from missile launch impulse noise.
WARNING
HIGH TEMPERATURE
This equipment contains items which operate at temperatures above 140°F (60°C) . If maintenance gloves .
is
required when equipment is
hot, wear protective
TM 9-1440-600-
WARNING
EXPLOSIVES HAZARDS
Do not perform
electrical checks of the safety and arming devices or the
propulsion arming and firing units at any time during transportation , handling , or storage operations involving the guided missile. These safe/arm devices require no electrical checkout from the time of assembly until the missile is returned for surveillance or until the missile is loaded on the launcher. On the launcher, these devices are checked by BITE to insure their readiness for a launch operation . Air-defense guided missile MIM - 104 contains explosives . All applicable safety regulations will be strictly enforced . Explosive components containing electrical wiring must be protected at all times from stray voltages or induced electrical currents .
Le WARNING
Handling or reload operations must not be performed during electrical storms .
A Gas under high
pressure is stored
in
pressure vessels in
WARNING the guided missile .
Le WARNING
MECHANICAL HAZARDS
Before
raising
or lowering the
platform
or
rotating the
turntable , the
crewmember must insure that all personnel and equipment are clear of the LS. A person can turntable .
be crushed to death if struck by a moving
platform or
When any activity is to be performed in the vicinity of the launching station , the LOCAL- RMT
switch on LCU Display Panel A1A14 must be in the LOCAL
position. The local condition prevents remote training of the turntable .
TM 9-1440-600-10
Le
WARNING
MECHANICAL HAZARDS - Continued
The LOCAL- RMT keylock switch key on LCU Display Panel A1A14 must be removed and retained by a crewmember when the launching station is in the local mode and is manned.
Le
All personnel working on platforms and at elevated positions on the launching station must exercise extreme care to pre-
WARNING vent falling. Always insure solid footing and solid handholds before transferring body weight.
Before
using
hoisting
equipment,
certification data plate . Do not certification date has expired .
inspect the
use
any
equipment's
hoisting
periodic
load
equipment whose
load
Do not walk on cables between the generator set and the launcher electronics to avoid damaging equipment . Personnel must use the platforms provided .
Rotating equipment ( blower fans) is used in the operation of this equipment . When performing maintenance , know the location and status (operating/off) of the rotating equipment . Disable all rotating equipment before performing maintenance.
Avoid power, data , and control cables interconnecting emplaced equipment , and driven ground
rods to
prevent tripping
injuries and
possible damage
to equipment connectors.
Site survey reference stakes are driven into the ground in the emplacement area. They are a tripping
hazard
and
if dislodged
alinement of the firing platoon during emplacement.
or moved could affect
TM 9-1440-600-10
WARNING
COLD AND HOT WEATHER HAZARDS
Failure to comply with the content of this warning result in serious injury.
could
PROTECTING THE HANDS IN COLD WEATHER OPERATIONS
Observe normal precautions for cold weather operations and wear proper clothing as described in FM 31-70. For mechanical tasks , observe the following measures .
If hands feel rewarm .
numb or
painful ,
stop work.
Immediately take
measures to
Do not touch metal with bare (ungloved) hands at temperatures below + 32°F (0°C) .
At temperatures approaching -50°F (-45°C) , with
no wind , the glove liners
without arctic mittens may be worn to perform tasks for periods of no more than three minutes . After these brief exposures , rewarm the hands with vigorous exercise and/or return to a heated area. Do not remove the arctic mittens under windy conditions .
In the event of injury from
cold
or frostbite ,
immediately
perform
first
aid/recovery methods described in FM 21-11 .
g
TM 9-1440-600-10
WARNING
WORK TIME LIMITS IN HOT WEATHER OPERATIONS
If heat exhaustion ,
cramps ,
or heatstroke occur,
immediately perform
first
aid/recovery procedures described in FM 21-11 . Observe normal precautions for hot/humid weather operations and wear proper light clothing as described in TM 10-276. For the temperature- humidity combinations listed in the attached table , limit continuous work to the times shown with appropriate rest/recover periods and fluid replacement for tasks which take longer than the recommended time .
NOTE
Recommendations are approximately one - half the heat tolerance time values given in MIL-STD- 1472.
TEMP
RELATIVE HUMIDITY (%)
(°F)
(°C)
10
140
60
30 MIN
130❘
54
1 HR
120
49
30
50
70
90
100
NO WORK RECOMMENDED
2 HRS❘ 1 HR
110
43
6 HRS
100❘ 38
2 HRS
1 HR
30 MIN
6 HRS
2 HRS
1 HR
30 MIN
15 MIN
6 HRS
3 HRS
2 HRS
NO LIMIT
90
h
32
WITH PRECAUTIONS
TM 9-1440-600-10
TECHNICAL MANUAL
)
HEADQUARTERS
)
DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY
No. 9-1440-600-10
Washington, D.C. , 15 December 1983
OPERATOR'S MANUAL LAUNCHING STATION M901 GUIDED MISSILE SEMITRAILER MOUNTED PATRIOT AIR DEFENSE GUIDED MISSILE SYSTEM
REPORTING ERRORS AND RECOMMENDING IMPROVEMENTS You can help improve this manual . If you find any mistakes or if you know of a way to
improve the procedures ,
please let us know.
Mail your letter,
DA Form 2028 (Recommended Changes to Publications and Blank Forms) , or DA Form 2028-2 , located in back of this manual , direct to : Commander U.S. Army Missile Command ATTN : DRSMI-SNPM Redstone Arsenal , AL 35898
A reply will be furnished to you .
TABLE OF CONTENTS Paragraph
CHAPTER 1 Section I
Section II
CHAPTER 2 Section I
Page
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
iv
INTRODUCTION
1-1
General Information
1-1
Scope .....
1-1
1-1
Maintenance Forms, Records and Reports
1-2
1-1
Reporting of Equipment Improvement Recommendations
1-3
1-1
Nomenclature Cross-Reference .....
1-4
1-1 1-4
Equipment Description Equipment Purpose, Capabilities , and Features
1-5
1-4
Location and Description of Major Components
1-6
1-5
Differences Between Models ..........
1-7
1-13
Equipment Data ..........
1-8
1-14
OPERATING INSTRUCTIONS
2-1
Description and Use of Operator's Controls and Indicators
2-1
TM 9-1440-600-10
TABLE OF CONTENTS - Continued Paragraph Description and Use of Operator's Controls and Indicators Section II
Section III
ii
2-1
Page
2-1 2-33
Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services General
2-2
2-33
Responsibility
2-3
2-33
Intervals
2-4
2-33
General Procedures for all Services and Inspections ........
2-5
2-33
Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services .......
2-6
2-35
Lubrication Instructions ..........
2-7
2-38
2-39
Operation Under Usual Conditions , Emplacement
2-8
2-39
Position of Controls Prior to Application of Power ......
2-9
2-123
Power-Up
2-10
2-132
Power-Down
2-11
2-152
Energize Launcher Electronics Module A1
2-12
2-161
Energize Data Link Terminal Module A2
2-13
2-167
Energize Generator Set A6 ....
2-14
2-169
Deenergize Launcher Electronics Module A1
2-15
2-175
Deenergize Data Link Terminal Module A2 .....
2-16
2-178
Deenergize Generator Set A6 .........
2-17
2-182
LCU Display Panel A1A14 Semiautomatic BITE Test ..........
2-18
2-183
Electrically Raise Launcher Platform ......
2-19
2-185
Electrically Lower Launcher Platform
2-20
2-190
Elevation Handcrank Operations ..
2-21
2-195
Electrically Rotate Launcher Mechanics .....
2-22
2-199
Azimuth Manual Operations
2-23
2-202
Data Link Terminal Turn - On ..........
2-24
2-205
Data Link Terminal Quick Start
2-25
2-209
Data Link Terminal Tuning ......
2-26
2-213
Data Link Terminal Loopback .........
2-27
2-227
Data Link Terminal Slave Synchronizing
2-28
2-235
Data Link Terminal Auto Synchronizing ....
2-29
2-243
March Order
2-30
2-247
Guided Missile Reload
2-31
2-283
TM 9-1440-600-10
TABLE OF CONTENTS - Continued Paragraph
Section IV
Page
2-388
Operation Under Unusual Conditions Chemical , Biological , and Radiological Environment ..
2-32
2-388
High Velocity Winds .
2-33
2-388
Extreme Cold Weather Operation .....
2-34
2-388
Extreme Hot Weather Operation .....
2-35
2-394
Sandy or Dusty Conditions
2-36
2-394
High Humidity
2-37
2-397
Changing Weather ......
2-38
2-399
Weather Shield Assembly
2-39
2-401
Weather Shield Disassembly .
2-40
2-405
Lightning Safety Precautions
2-41
2-408
APPENDIX A
REFERENCES
A-1
APPENDIX B
COMPONENTS OF END ITEM AND BASIC ISSUE ITEMS LISTS
B-1
APPENDIX C
ADDITIONAL AUTHORIZATION LIST
C- 1
APPENDIX D
EXPENDABLE SUPPLIES AND MATERIELS LIST
D-1
GLOSSARY
Glossary 1
INDEX
Index 1
iii
TM 9-1440-600-10
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL In training you were told the best way to perform your duties is to
use your manual .
Become familiar with the
it to see what it
manual .
Spend some time
looking through
contains. Notice there are three ways to find information : Front cover index.
•
Table of contents . Index at the rear of the manual .
The best way to find what you want depends on how familiar you are with the manual and with the equipment . The fastest way usually is to use the front cover index.
1.
Using the Front Cover Index
Look at the cover of your
manual .
On
the right side you find a listing of important information in the manual . Bend
the pages a bit . See the blue bars that aline with the bars on the cover? Put your on the bar alined with EM-
TM 9-1440-600-10 OPERATOR'S MANUAL LAUNCHING STATION M901 GUIDED MISSILE SEMITRAILER MOUNTED
TABLE OF CONTENTS HOWTO USE THIS MANUAL
thumbnail
PLACEMENT You'll find
and
open the
paragraph
2-8
manual .
EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION
EMPLACE-
MENT where you opened the manual .
The cover index lists the manual you use most often .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS
parts of the PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE CHECKS AND SERVICES EMPLACEMENT
MARCH ORDER GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD OPERATION UNDER UNUSUAL CONDITIONS
PATRIOT AIR DEFENSE GUIDED MISSILE SYSTEM HEADQUARTERS, DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY
iv
TM 9-1440-600-10
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL- Continued
2.
Using the table of contents . The index on the cover lists TABLE OF CONTENTS . Open the manual to the TABLE OF CONTENTS. It lists all the chapters, sections , and paragraphs and gives the page number they start on . Notice some of these titles are boxed in , the boxed titles are listed on the front cover.
3.
Using the index in the back of the manual. Index in the
back of the
alphabetical order. you
most likely
manual
Subjects you
use.
Each
lists
are
all the
that are
likely to look for are listed
subject is listed
will tell you where to find descriptions , cedures for the launching station (LS).
4.
subjects
in the
manual in
under the
names
under two or three topics . The index
preventive
maintenance , and operating pro-
All the indexing is O.K. , but how do I operate the LS? The LS is operated remotely , but you have to emplace it, prepare it for road march , and reload the guided missiles (GM) . You will also have to perform other operating procedures. You will find ATION
EMPLACEMENT,
UNDER USUAL CONDITIONS
MARCH
paragraphs
ORDER ,
using the
RELOAD and OPERindexes. A section for
operation under unusual conditions is also provided . You must become familiar with this section as it contains special procedures LS under the unusual conditions listed .
5.
required
to operate and
protect the
How do I know when the LS needs repair? All operating procedures give expected results for your actions. If the expected results do not occur, something is wrong . You should recheck all your steps to make sure you operated the LS according to procedure . If your operations were correct, a fault has occurred. Refer all faults to Organizational Maintenance for repair.
v/(vi blank)
C
TM 9-1440-600-10 CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION
Section I.
1-1 .
GENERAL INFORMATION
SCOPE
This technical manual (TM ) contains operating instructions for the PATRIOT Semitrailer Mounted Guided Missile Launching Station M901 . The TM describes the launching station (LS) and tells how to operate it .
Procedures for emplacing an LS ,
preparing for march
order, and reloading guided missiles (GM ) are provided . Preventive maintenance performed by the crewmember is also included . This TM is one of a series of publications covering operation and maintenance of the PATRIOT Weapon System . A complete list of PATRIOT TMs appears on the back cover.
1-2 .
MAINTENANCE FORMS , RECORDS , AND REPORTS
Department of the Army forms and procedures used for equipment maintenance will be those prescribed by TM 38-750 , The Army Maintenance Management System (TAMMS) .
1-3.
REPORTING OF EQUIPMENT IMPROVEMENT RECOMMENDATIONS
If your launching station
( LS)
needs improvement ,
let us know.
Send
us a quality
deficiency report (QDR) . You , the user , are the only one who can tell us what you don't like about your equipment . Let us know why you don't like the design or performance . Put it on a QDR SF 368. Mail it to us at : Commander
U.S. Army Missile Command ATTN : DRSMI - SNEM Redstone Arsenal , AL 35898
1-4.
NOMENCLATURE CROSS- REFERENCE
Launching station ( LS) equipment or groups of equipment which have a common name that is different from its official nomenclature are listed in Table 1-1 . The common names of the equipment or groups of equipment are listed in the first column ; the reference designation and official nomenclature in the second and third columns .
related to the common
name of each are listed
CONTINUED
1-1
TM 9-1440-600-10
TABLE 1-1 . NOMENCLATURE CROSS- REFERENCE LIST
COMMON NAME
Azimuth Actuator
REFERENCE DESIGNATION
A7A13
Azimuth Bearing
OFFICIAL NOMENCLATURE
Rotary Electro- Mechanical Actuator Azimuth Ball Bearing
Azimuth Drive Motor
A7B3
Direct Current Motor
CCW Limit Switch (No.
A7A4/A7A5
Sensitive Switch
A1A10/A2A10
Electronic Equipment Fan Assem-
1/No. 2) Centrifugal Fan
bly
Clock Power Supply
A2A9
General Purpose 28 VDC 20 A Power Supply
CW Limit Switch (No. 1 /No.
A7A2/A7A3
Sensitive Switch
A2A1
Electronic Key Generator KG-30
A2A2
Computer-To-Communications
2) Data Link Terminal (DLT)
Interface Processor (CCIP)
Data Link Terminal Power
A2A3
Radio Receiver-Transmitter
A2A5
Radio Frequency Tuner
A2A6
Power Supply Assembly ( DLT)
A2A6
Power Supply Assembly (DLT)
A7A6/A7A7
Linear Electro- Mechanical Actuator
A7B1 /A7B2
Direct Current Motor
A6
DOD Model MEP- 113A 120/208
Supply Elevation Actuator (Roadside/Curbside) Elevation Drive Motor ( No. 1 Roadside, No. 2 Curbside) Generator Set
and 240/416-volt, 3- phase , 400 Hz , 15 kw Tactical Skid Mounted Diesel Engine Driven Generator Set
Guided Missile (GM )
4A1 (All positions)
Aerial- Intercept Guided Missile MIM -104 CONTINUED
1-2
TM 9-1440-600-10
TABLE 1-1 . NOMENCLATURE CROSS- REFERENCE LIST - Continued
COMMON NAME
REFERENCE DESIGNATION
Launcher Base Launching Station ( LS)
OFFICIAL NOMENCLATURE
Launcher Base Welded Assembly 5
Semitrailer Mounted Guided Missile Launching Station M901
Launching Station Test Set
29
Guided Missile Launching Station Test Set AN/TSM- 165
( LSTS) LCU Display Panel
A1A14
Display Panel Assembly
Motor Control Unit (MCU)
A1A9
Motor Controller
Pointer
Alignment Bracket Gage A1A2/A2A4
Power Distribution Drawer
Power Supply
A1A4/A1A8
Logic Power Supply
Power Supply
A1A5
Ordnance Power Supply
Power Supply
A1A6/A1A7
Selectable Voltage Power Supply
Power Supply
A1A12
TWT Power Supply
Power Supply
A1A13
General Purpose 28 VDC 20 A Power Supply
Receiver-Transmitter
A2A3
Radio Receiver-Transmitter
Relay Assembly
A2A11
Launcher Missile Round Distributor
Power Distribution Unit (PDU )
(LMRD) Relay Assembly Semitrailer
42
M860A1
Electrical Connector Plug
Shorting Plug Travel Lock Sensor Switch
Semitrailer
A7A8/A7A9
Sensitive Switch
(No. 1 Curbside , No. 2
Roadside) Travel Lock Pin
Quick Release Pin
Turntable
Launcher Platform Turntable
Zero Lock Sensor Switch
A7A10
Sensitive Switch
Change 1
1-3
TM 9-1440-600-10 Section II .
1-5 .
EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION
EQUIPMENT PURPOSE , CAPABILITIES AND FEATURES
Purpose of Launching Station (LS) A mobile tactical
element of the PATRIOT air defense fire
unit .
Used to transport,
aim and launch the guided missiles ( GM ) . Remotely operated , carrying its own generator set and up to four GMs.
1-4
Capabilities and Features Major LS components : M860A1 Semitrailer Generator Set, 15 kw
Launcher Mechanics ( LM ) Launcher Electronics (LE) Launcher Electronics Module ( LEM ) Data Link Terminal Module ( DLTM ) Launcher Missile Round Distributor (LMRD ) Missile Round Cable Test Set (MRCTS) Mobile. Towed by a 10-ton tractor. Can be emplaced on a 10° slope .
Leveled with outriggers . Remotely operated under control of the engagement control station ( ECS) via a VHF link. Manually raised to a fixed angle for firing . Cannot be remotely raised or lowered . Rotates (azimuth train) on remote command . Reloaded at firing platoon ( FP) station .
LS and GM can be remotely tested . Built-in-test-equipment . Standard circuit modules for maintenance .
Change 1
t
TM 9-1440-600-10
1-6 .
LOCATION AND DESCRIPTION OF MAJOR COMPONENTS
The launching station
( LS)
is mounted
on
an
M860A1
Semitrailer and towed by
an M983 Tractor . The sides of the LS are assigned : front (end near the generator set); rear (end near the wheels) ; roadside (driver's side when tractor is connected ) ; curbside (passenger's side when tractor is connected) .
CURBSIDE
ROADSIDE
CONTINUED
Change 1
1-5
TM 9-1440-600-10
1-6 .
LOCATION AND DESCRIPTION OF MAJOR COMPONENTS
Continued
1
2
3
5
ROADSIDE
1
TRACTOR
M983 .
electrical system .
Tows the launching station (LS) . Has a special 100 ampere Provides over-the- road electrical power and power for the out-
riggers.
2
SEMITRAILER
M860A1 . Arigid mobile platform built to carry the PATRIOT LS.
3
OUTRIGGERS. One on each corner to level the LS.
Electrically operated by 28
Vdc power from the tractor.
4
(Deleted ) .
5
GENERATOR SET A6.
Provides on - board 120/208 Vac , 3- phase, 4-wire , 400 Hz ,
15 kw electrical power.
CONTINUED
1-6
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
1-6 .
LOCATION AND DESCRIPTION OF MAJOR COMPONENTS- Continued
D
7
ROADSIDE
6
7
FRONT STOWAGE CONTAINER . Contains the weather shield kit and range pole .
LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE (LEM ) A1 .
Control center for the LS and
the guided missiles (GM) houses :
•
Power Control Panel (PCP) A1A3
•
Power Distribution Unit (PDU) A1A2
Launch Control Unit (LCU ) Chassis A1A1 •
LCU Display Panel A1A14 Seven power supplies Motor Control Unit ( MCU ) A1A9 Fan A1A10
Pressure Switch A1A11 Cables (Interconnect harness)
CONTINUED
1-7
TM 9-1440-600-10 1-6 .
LOCATION AND DESCRIPTION OF MAJOR COMPONENTS - Continued
9
8
ROADSIDE
8
DATA LINK MAST ASSEMBLY. The receiving and transmitting antenna for data link communication with the engagement control station ( ECS) . Raises, lowers, and rotates with the launcher mechanics (LM ) . Consists of: Lower Mast Section A7A11
•
Upper Mast Section A7A12 Data link antenna RF cables
ROADSIDE STOWAGE BOX. Part of the semitrailer. Contains : 9 Handtools Elevation handcranks
Ground rod Ground cable 42W3 Guided missile ( GM) cable clamp assemblies when GMs are not aboard . Guardrail
CONTINUED
1-8
TM 9-1440-600-10 1-6.
LOCATION AND DESCRIPTION OF MAJOR COMPONENTS - Continued
-10
ROADSIDE
10
11
LAUNCHER MISSILE ROUND DISTRIBUTOR (LMRD) A3 . Distribution and control point between launcher electronics ( LE) and GM . Houses :
11
•
Four distributor modules A3A1 thru A3A4
•
Six circuit cards A3A5 thru A3A10
•
Relay assembly A3A11
•
Wiring harness
REAR STOWAGE CONTAINER . Contains the aiming circle tripod .
CONTINUED
1-9
TM 9-1440-600-10 LOCATION AND DESCRIPTION OF MAJOR COMPONENTS- Continued
1-6.
12
13
CURBSIDE
12
OUTRIGGER CONTROL PANEL . Contains controls and indicators for leveling the
LS. DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE ( DLTM ) A2 . Secures radio digital data link be13 tween ECS and LS. Contains:
Filter and Connector Panel A2A8 Power Input Filter Assembly (PIFA) A2A7 •
Power Distribution Unit ( PDU ) A2A4 Two Power Supplies A2A6 and A2A9 Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5 Receiver-Transmitter A2A3
•
Computer-To-Communications Interface Processor (CCIP) A2A2 Electronic Key Generator KG -30 A2A1
•
Centrifugal Fan A2A10 Pressure Switch A2A11
•
Cables (interconnect harness)
CONTINUED
1-10
TM 9-1440-600-10
1-6 .
LOCATION AND DESCRIPTION OF MAJOR COMPONENTS - Continued
14
15
ख CURBSIDE
be
14
CURBSIDE STOWAGE BOX . Contains :
Gunner's quadrant
15
•
Aiming circle
•
Rod level for the range pole
CANISTER
HEATER
POWER
CONTROL BOX 23A1 . Contains controls and
in-
dicators for the canisters ' heaters.
CONTINUED
1-11
TM 9-1440-600-10 1-6 .
LOCATION AND DESCRIPTION OF MAJOR COMPONENTS - Continued
CURBSIDE
2
1
ROADSIDE 4
1
STEADYREST . Supports and locks the platform when lowered .
2
ELEVATION ACTUATORS A7A6 AND A7A7 . Two identical actuators , roadside A7A6 and curbside A7A7 , raise the platform to the firing angle .
3
LAUNCHER
BASE . A steel assembly bolted to the semitrailer that supports the
other LM assemblies .
4
LAUNCHER
PLATFORM . A welded steel structure that supports and alines the
four GMs.
CONTINUED
1-12
TM 9-1440-600-10 1-6 .
LOCATION AND DESCRIPTION OF MAJOR COMPONENTS - Continued
CURBSIDE
5
6
ROADSIDE
7
5
TURNTABLE . A welded steel structure that rotates on the azimuth bearing to train the GM in azimuth .
6
AZIMUTH DRIVE UNIT. Drives turntable in azimuth . Consists of:
Azimuth Actuator A7A13
7
•
Azimuth Drive Motor A7B3
•
Digital Encoder A7A1
AZIMUTH BEARING . A steel ball bearing with gear teeth that supports the turntable , platform , and up to four GMs.
1-7.
DIFFERENCES BETWEEN MODELS
There are no differences between models .
1-13
TM 9-1440-600-10 1-8 .
EQUIPMENT DATA
WEIGHT :
78,690 lb (35,694 kg ) with tractor and four guided missiles (GMs)
(approximate)
63,690 lb (28,890 kg) with tractor , but w/o GMs 48,000 lb (21,773 kg ) w/o tractor, but with GMs
33,000 lb ( 14,969 kg ) w/o tractor or GMs LENGTH :
55.33 ft ( 16.86 m) with tractor 33.08 ft ( 10.08 m ) w/o tractor
WIDTH :
19.00 ft (5.79 m) with outriggers lowered 9.42 ft (2.87 m) with outriggers raised
HEIGHT :
34.66 ft ( 10.57 m ) approximately , to top of antenna when raised 13.10 ft (3.99 m) lowered
CURBSIDE
ROADSIDE
NOTE Weights with tractor include self- recovery winch .
CONTINUED
1-14
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10 1-8 .
EQUIPMENT DATA - Continued
EMPLACEMENT SLOPE
Maximum Ground Slope
10°
Maximum Slope After Leveling
5°
MAXIMUM WIND VELOCITY Road March
51 MPH (45 knots)
Emplacement and Reload
62.5 MPH (55 knots) Gusts to 96.5 MPH (85 knots) Hold downs required over 96.5 MPH (85 knots)
TEMPERATURE LIMITS
-50°F (-45.6°C) to 120° F (48.9°C) Generator Set A6 requires preparation for temperature below -25°F (-31 °C)
ELECTRICAL POWER INPUT REQUIREMENTS
Launching Station
120/208 Vac, 3- phase, 4-wire , 400 Hz , 15 kw
Over-the-Road (Tractor supplies)
28 Vdc, not greater than 217 watts
POSITIONING RATES
Elevation
0° to 38° in 2 minutes 32 seconds
Azimuth
90° in 30 seconds
POSITIONING LIMITS
Elevation
38° ± 20.6 minutes above the payload bed reference
Azimuth
Approximately 110° cw and ccw from the travel position
1-15/(1-16 blank)
TM 9-1440-600-10
CHAPTER 2 OPERATING INSTRUCTIONS
Section I.
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS
During tactical operation the LS is unmanned , under control of the engagement control station ( ECS) digital data link. In this remote mode of operation the ECS can : test the LS and GM, point the
GM for firing
(azimuth train) ; give the GM prelaunch data ; give
the firing command .
In the local mode the LS may be safely manned . A secure voice radio set in the tractor is used for voice contact with the ECS . The ECS cannot train the LS nor fire a GM when
in the
local
mode . The
ECS can
perform
some tests
in
local .
There is
a 1 - minute delay when the LS is changed from local to remote . This delay time is called remote enable .
C GENERATOR SET A6 A
DO
LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE A1
G OUTRIGGER CONTROL PANEL
E
B
MISSILE ROUND CABLE TEST SET A8
DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2
D
FL
LAUNCHER MECHANICS A7
CANISTER HEATERS POWER CONTROL BOX 23A1
CONTINUED
2-1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
A
Launcher Electronics Module A1
Equipment Description . Control center for LS
and guided missiles ( GM ) . Sends LS and GM status to ECS by data link . Contains BITE controls for testing
Launcher
Electronics
Module
( LEM ) A1
and
Launcher
Missile Round Distributor ( LMRD) A3 circuits when in local mode . Contains circuit breakers for routing main generator set power to LS. Also contains controls to energize power supplies and operate azimuth and elevation circuits . Will trip main ac power off if blower in Data Link Terminal Module ( DLTM ) A2 or LEM A1 fails .
D ROTAR MOD JA 133
LCU DISPLAY PANEL A1A14 POWER CONTROL PANEL A1A3
POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT A1A2
LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE A1
CONTINUED
2-2
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
A
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
Launcher Electronics Module A1 Equipment Description - Continued.
(1)
Power Distribution Unit A1A2.
(a)
Technical
Principles of Operation .
Power Distribution
Unit
(PDU) A1A2
distributes main ac power through LEM A1 and provides circuit breaker protection . (b)
Controls and Indicators.
MISSILE
Panel lights : Light control
panel
when
LAMPS
HEATER
AC
circuit breakers :
Control ac power to missile heater.
switch is ON .
UPR L MSL upper left missile heat-
•
er control.
UPR R MSL heater control .
upper
right
missile
LWR L MSL lower left missile heater control.
BLOWER OPR light : On indicates :
LWR R MSL heater control .
lower right
missile
Fan is on. Pressure switch is actuated . LAMPS switch is ON .
O
LOIR ELEX OLOUR ELEX MDL POWER DISTABUTION UNIT BLOWER OP
Θ
BLOWER
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAINA
OFF
OFF
LCHR ELEX PWR SPLT
LOH ELEX
OFF
OFF
PWR SPLY
GYROCLOCK PWRSPLY
LWRL MSL
LWRA MSL
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
MOTCONT UNITAC ON
PAFURT PWRSPL ON
OFF
OFF
FWR SPLY ON OFF
LAMPS OFF TEST
O
Θ
O
CONTINUED
O
Θ OFF
OFF
Θ
CNVC OUT CAMSTERHTR
MISSILE HEATER AC LMSL UPAR MSL
2-3
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
A
Launcher Electronics Module A1 Equipment Description - Continued .
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC•
MAIN A circuit breaker: Controls ac power and provides overload protection for :
LCHR ELEX 5 VDC PWR SPLY circuit breaker: Controls ac power and protects Power Supply A1A8. •
ORD PWR SPLY circuit breaker: Controls ac power and protects Power Supply A1A5.
•
LCHR ELEX 28 VDC PWR SPLY circuit breaker: Controls ac power and protects Power Supply A1A13.
MAIN B circuit breaker : Controls ac power and provides overload protection for: LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT MSL 5 VDC PWR SPLY circuit
°
O BLOWER OFF
breaker:
Controls ac power and protects
BLOWER ON OFF
Power Supply A1A4. MSL
GYRO / CLOCK
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAIN A ON OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC UPR& MSL UPE ON OFF OFF
MAIN B
PWR
SPLY circuit breaker:
Controls ac power and protects
LCHRELEX PWR5 VDCSPLY
FWRORDSPLY
LCHRELEX 28VDC SPLY PWR
OFF
OFF
OFF
CNVCOUT MCONT CANISTERHTR AC
Power Supply A1A7.
MSI VDC PWRSPLY
MSLCLOCK GYROPWRSPLY OFF TWTSPL PWR
OFF
OFF
OFF
LAMPS
Θ
OFF
MSL PAFUITL SPLY PWR
OFF
MSL PAFUITL PWR SPLY cir-
TUST
O
cuit breaker:
OFF
Θ
Controls ac power and protects
O
0
O
6
O
Power Supply A1A6. MSL TWT FIL PWR SPLY circuit breaker: LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS AC -
Controls ac power and protects BLOWER circuit breaker: Controls
Power Supply A1A12.
ac power to Fan A1A10 .
CONTINUED
J
2-4
TM 9-1440-600-10
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS –
2-1 .
Continued Launcher Electronics Module A1 Equipment Description - Continued .
A
CNVC OUT CANISTER HTR AC circuit breaker:
MOT CONT UNIT AC circuit breaker :
Controls ac power to convenience outlets and to Canister Heater Power
Controls ac power to Motor Control Unit A1A9.
Control Box 23A1 .
0
LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT
LAMPS switch :
O
O
O
O BLOWER OPE
ON lights panel lights and supplies O
O
ELDWEA ON OFF
power to BLOWER OPR light.
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC MAIN A
MAIN B
OFF
OFF
PWNORDSPLY
LCHRELEX 20VOC PWRSPLY
OFF
OFF
CNVC OUTHTR CANISTER
MOTCONT UNITAC ON OFF
OFF
O
MSL &VOC PW SPLY ON OFF
GYROCLOCK
LAN MEL
WRAMSL
OFF
OFF
OFF
PAFUSTL PWR SPLY
TWTFIL PWRSPLY ON OFF
OFF
LAMPS ON OFF TEST
O
TEST tests panel lights and BLOWER OPR light.
O
O
CHIBFLER VDC SPLY ON
MISSILE EATER AC, UPR1 ON OFF OFF
O
Power Control Panel A1A3.
(2)
(a)
Technical Principles of Operation . Power Control Panel ( PCP) A1A3 con-
trols main ac and vehicle dc power to LS. It also monitors system on time .
(b)
Controls and Indicators .
MAIN POWER — RUN TIME - M1 meter:
•
Indicates total system on time .
AC- CB1 circuit breaker: Controls main ac power from Generator Set
A6 .
Trips off for over-
voltage or if air pressure is low in LEM A1 or DLTM A2.
• RUN TIME
M1
MAIN POWER AC DC
CB1
DC- CB2 circuit breaker: Controls 28 Vdc tractor DLT clock.
power for
CB2 CONTINUED
2-5
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1.
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
A
Launcher Electronics Module A1 Equipment Description - Continued .
(3)
LCU Display Panel A1A14 .
(a)
Technical
Principles
of Operation .
LCU
Display Panel A1A14 provides
controls to select local or remote operation , connect GMs, perform local BITE test, select launching station and firing platoon addresses, elevate and rotate the launcher mechanics , and monitor GM condition .
(b)
Controls and Indicators.
BITE lights (Red) : A B C D E indicates
POWER SUPPLIES BITE test
+5 VDC light (Green) : On inresults .
Lights cycle
during
test . If
dicates Power Supply A1A8 is test fails , light pattern indicates test
good . number.
All lights
steady if test
± 15 VDC light (Green) : On in-
passes.
dicates
15- volt A1A5 is good .
Power Supply
+28 VDC light (Green) : On indicates Power Supply A1A13 is good .
O
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
O VDC18 MISSILE UPPERL UPPER I HAZARD Ο Ο 이이 이이
O
NEETED 0101010 e
O
O
RAISE STOP 10 10: START
O O
O
LAUNCHING STA
READY
O
READY PLATFORM RAISED AZMUTH READY
O
•
PLATFORM-
POWER SUPPLIES O
LAUNCHER. LOCAL
O
BITE
ODC O OFF
CONTINUED
O
O
6
0
BITETEST STATUSLAMPS OFF STATUS OMM LAMPTEST
109
FIRINGPLATOON
O O
2-6
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
A
Launcher Electronics Module A1 Equipment Description - Continued.
MISSILE
UPPER L - Upper left guided missile (GM). •
UPPER R- Upper right GM .
•
LWR L - Lower left GM .
•
LWR R - Lower right GM.
MISSILE HAZARD lights ( Red ) : On indicates an
unsafe
GM at the
indicated
position
is in that position . Also indicates an empty canister, GM cable at that position .
if a live round or disconnected
MISSILE READYlights (Green ) : On indicates GM at the indicated
is safe ,
position
is at temperature ,
is electrically connected , and restraint pin is unlocked .
DISCONNECTED
lights (Yellow) : On indicates GM
at the in-
LAUNCH CONTROL UN
electronics
(LE ) .
LE
will
BITE
POWER SUPPLIES
-PLATFORM
MISSILE A LIPPER LIPPER
O
dicated position is electrically disconnected from launcher dis-
connect when GM fired , or for GM failure in launch sequence .
O (
LOCAL
Oi
MISSILE
O
о
Ο อ
KAISE O
O
position .
O
10110
Electrically connects or disconnects GM at the indicated
0
MESSME READY 이이 이이 READY PLATFORM RAISED AJORUTH OSCON MECTED 이이이이
CONNECT- DISC switches :
EING PLATOON 4 101
O
CONTINUED
2-7
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS . Continued
A
Launcher Electronics Module A1 Equipment Description - Continued .
LAUNCHER •
PLATFORM -
LOCAL- RMT switch :
PLATFORM
Sets launch station (LS) mode to local or remote . Circuit has
(Green) : On indicates launcher platform
1 -minute delay from local mode
is
to remote mode . Requires key
(38°).
elevated
RAISED
to
launch
light
angle
to change position .
AZIMUTH LOCAL light (Green): On indicates LS is
READY
light
(Green) : in
local
On indicates turntable can be
mode .
rotated. •
LCHR READYlight (Green) : On indicates LS can launch a
RAISE - STOP-LWR switch :
•
RAISE selects up motion
GM . Platform is at launch an-
for platform . gle,
GM
and
LEM A1
power
LWR
supplies are good.
selects down
mo-
tion for platform . LAUNCHING STA switch :
•
Sets LS address for logic input data .
STOP
stops
platform
motion .
FIRING PLATOON switch :
START switch :
Sets firing platoon address for
Starts platform to raise or lower when platform is on a limit. Di-
logic input data .
rection selected by RAISESTOP-LWR switch .
•
CCW-STOP - CW switch : Controls turntable rotation .
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT BITE
PLATFORM-
O
LAUNCHER
O
OWER SUPPLIES 000 MISSILE MOSALE HAZARO
0
Ο
READY# 0000 LCHR PLATFORM RAISED ASMUTH READY READY DISCON Macrta 0101010
๑
STOP O
101
RAISE
O
0
LAUNCHING STA
START о
FIRING TOON
CONTINUED O
O
HITETEST STATUSLAMPS NORMAL STATUS LAMPYEST
O
:0
2-8
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
A
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
Launcher Electronics Module A1 Equipment Description - Continued .
0
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
BITE
Panel lights :
PLIES
Light display panel LAMPS switch is ON .
Ο LAUNCHER-
PLATFORM
when
PANEL
MISSILE UPPERL UPPERA HAZARD 0000 O O
MISSALE READY LOVE PLATFORM 이이 이이 RAISED ADMUTH READY READY O DISCON NECTED 이이 이이 อ e LAUNCHINGSTA RAISE STOP CONNECT CONVEY CONNECT
O
PANEL LAMPS switch : START O
Turns four panel lights on and off.
O
FRINGPLATOON
1
BITE TEST STATUSLAMPS PANEL LAMPS O OM STATUS OIFF LAMPTEST
O
O
O
STATUS LAMPS switch : NORMAL — Normal brightness level for status lights . DIM
Dims brightness level of status
lights.
BITE
TEST- OFF - STATUS
LAMP
TEST switch : BITE TEST - Starts BITE test. STATUS
LAMP
status lights .
TEST -
Tests
Spring loaded to
all
OFF
from this position .
CONTINUED
2-9
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
B
Data Link Terminal Module A2 Equipment Description . Data Link radio for communication between LS and ECS. Has BITE circuits for testing data link terminal (DLT) assemblies . The DLT assemblies are :
Electronic Key Generator KG-30 A2A1 Computer-To-Communications - Interface Processor A2A2 Receiver-Transmitter A2A3 Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5 DLT Power Supply A2A6
Contains all controls for operating
DLTM . Tractor supplies 28-Vdc over-the- road
power to keep a clock running when on road march .
Blower must be operating
before turning LEM A1 28-Vdc power supply on .
ELECTRONIC KEY GENERATOR KG-30 A1A1 (BEHIND PANEL) A2A2
POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT A2A4
8
48
26te
00
000
RADIO FREQUENCY TUNER A2A5 DLT POWER SUPPLY A2A6 RECEIVER-TRANSMITTER A1A3
COMPUTER-TO-COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE PROCESSOR A2A2 DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2
CONTINUED
2-10
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
B
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
Data Link Terminal Module A2 Equipment Description - Continued .
(1 )
Electronic Key Generator KG-30 A2A1 .
(a) Technical Principles of Operation . and decrypts data sent to and from the ECS.
(b)
Key Generator KG-30 A2A1
encrypts
Controls and Indicators.
Transmitter Permuter card plunger lever: XMTR -
Lowered
releases transmitter per-
BOTH OFF - LT OFF ALM ON- LT ON ALM OFF- BOTH ON switch : Controls audible alarm and all front
muter card . Fully pressed and released causes code to be reset to 0.
panel lights .
— XMTR OPR light: On indicates start sequence complete
XMTR LT ON LT OFF AMON ALM OFF BOTH ON BOTH OFF
RCVR
and transmitter can process data. OPER
ALARM
PREP
RESET
CS RESET
OPER
POWER
XMTR - ALARM light: On indicates transmitter is in alarm state . Transmitter output is inhibited .
XMTR — RESET switch : Resets audible and visual alarm .
CS RESET switch : Starts alarm check cycle . When cycle completed , begins transmitter restart.
Transmitter permuter card : Inserted into card slot after code is set.
CONTINUED
2-11
TM 9-1440-600-10
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
2-1 .
Data Link Terminal Module A2 Equipment Description - Continued.
B
Receiver permuter card ver:
plunger le-
Receiver permuter card : Inserted into card slot after code is set.
Lowered releases receiver permuter card . Fully pressed and released causes code to be reset to 0.
RCVR - OPR light: On indicates receiver can
process
data . XMTR LT OFFON LT ON ALM ALM OFF BOTH ON BOTH OFF OPER
ALARM
PREP
RESET
RCV CS RESET
OPER
PREP 10
POWER
ON
OFF RCVR - POWER light: O
On indicates power supply voltages are at operating values .
RCVR
Permuter Door:
ON- OFF switch :
Houses transmitter and receiver per-
Controls ac power to Key Generator
muter card plungers . codes are reset to 0.
A2A1 power supply.
When opened
CONTINUED
2-12
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
B
Data Link Terminal Module A2 Equipment Description - Continued.
(2)
Computer-To-Communications Interface Processor A2A2.
(a)
Technical Principles of Operation . Computer- To-Communications Interface
Processor (CCIP) A2A2 acts as a storage buffer , encoder, and multiplexer of digital data transferred between LEM A1 and the ECS. Contains DLT clock that provides timing between LEM A1 and DLT. Includes BITE circuits for DLT.
(b)
Controls and Indicators.
FAULT•
SUMMARY FAULT light (Red) : On indicates processor fault.
•
TIME OF DAY display:
KEY GEN FAULT light :
Flashing red indicates Generator A2A1 fault.
Light emitting diode (LED ) disKey
play indicates net time in days, hours, minutes and seconds.
RESET switch - Resets fault lights on processor , tuner , and receiver-transmitter. Also tests processor lights.
TIME OF AY MIN HOUR
FAULT DLT SUMMARY FAULT KEYGEN FALAY TEST DAY RESET
PROPAGATION DELAY REQUEST SEC
ALTERNATE MASTER
NORMAL TIME SET
MODE OPROCESSOR CONTROL OUTN KORY
DAY OSC CAL 88888 TIME CONTROL OPERATE NECOUT LOADNET
SYNC OSYNC AUTO ECS-O LEA
RADIO ID LEW BCS-C
LBE
e
PROCESSOR
CONTROL
DLT TEST switch :
switch :
Used for DLT self-test and anUsed with DLT TEST switch to allow DLT tests for fault isola-
tenna tuning . Enables PROCESSOR CONTROL switch .
tion . Also enables tuner for adjustment of band pass filters.
CONTINUED
2-13
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
B
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORSContinued
Data Link Terminal Module A2 Equipment Description - Continued .
PROPAGATION DELAY REQUEST-
ECS BLight (Green): On indicates measurement of propagation delay from ECS-B is complete . Switch: Used by DLT designated
ECS-A or ECS-C in mode 2 to
measure propagation delay from ECS- B.
ECS CLight (Green): On indicates measurement of propagation delay from ECS-C is complete . Switch : Used by DLT designated ECS-A or ECS- B in mode 2 to measure propagation delay from ECS-C.
KGBY light ( Red) : On
indicates
key
generator is
bypassed .
PROPAGATION DELAY REQUEST ALT DLT TIME OF DAYSUMMARY ICSB FALA TEST FAULT KEYGEN DAY HOUR MIN SEC TEST ALTERNATE MASTER KONY NORMAL K RESEY SYNC MODE TIME SET OFF OFF DAY RADIO ID PROCESSOR CONTROL O AUTO SYNC OSC CAL ECS-C HATE ECS-4 00 10 TIME L&C LSA CONTR 051 LOADNET OPERATE REIN OSC OUT ECSA on OFF w © O
MODE switch : Selects DLT mode 1 or mode 2 op-
RADIO ID switch :
eration .
Allows identification of DLT as either ECS or LS and particular net of operation .
ALTERNATE MASTER switch : In
mode 2 ,
when
net,
designates
DLT
as
net
ECS-A is not in
ECS- B
master.
or
Used
ECS-C in
DLT
tests to start clock for certain fault conditions .
2-14
CONTINUED
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
B
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued Data Link Terminal Module A2 Equipment Description - Continued .
SYNC light (Green) : On indicates DLT is synchronized .
TIME SET switches:
AUTO SYNC - Light (Yellow) : Used to enter net start time and net
On
indicates
resynchronization of
entry time.
DLT after activating AUTO switch was not successful . Switch :
Used
at the
end
SYNC
of
road
march to allow processor to automatically resynchronize DLT.
FAULT DLT SUMMARY FAULT TEST FAULT KEYGEN DAY 2
RESEY
TIME DAY. HOUR O MIN
PROPAGATION DELAY REQUEST SEC ALTERNATE MASTER SNC
Θ
MODE TIME SET OFF OFF GAY HOUR RADIOID AUTO SYNC OSC CAL HATE 88888 TIME CONTROL O OPERATE REFIN OOCOUT LOADNET SCSA OFF
PROCESSOR CONTROL
OSC CAL TIME CONTROL -
RATE light (Yellow) : OPERATE switch : When alining master oscillator , blinking rate indicates differ-
In
external
test
equipment frequency.
•
REF IN connector: External test equipment connection .
Used
when
alining
causes TIME
OF
DAY display to run 128 times faster than real time.
ence between master oscillator frequency and
mode 2 ,
LOAD NET switch : In on , loads time entered by TIME SET switches into TIME OF DAY display .
master oscillator.
OSC OUT connector : External test equipment connection . Used to measure mas-
CONTINUED
ter oscillator frequency.
2-15
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
B
Data Link Terminal Module A2 Equipment Description - Continued.
(3)
(a)
Receiver-Transmitter A2A3.
Technical Principles of Operation .
Receiver-Transmitter A2A3 generates
and modulates carrier frequency and demodulates received signal . Transmitter output power is 25 watts.
(b)
Controls and Indicators .
FAULT•
RECEIVER A2 A1 thru A4, A7 LEDs ( Red) :
FREQUENCY SELECT switches:
On indicates card fault.
Manually selects inputs to frequency synthesizers .
•
applicable
circuit
TRANSMITTER A1 -
A10 thru A14 LEDs (Red) : On indicates card fault.
FREQUENCY SELECT
0 Θ FAULT RECEIVER TRANSMITTER A1 A2 A3 A11 A12 A13
8888
A7 A14 O →
applicable
circuit
A10
FAULT RESET Q
FAULT RESET switch : Resets fault LEDs.
CONTINUED
2-16
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued Data Link Terminal Module A2 Equipment Description - Continued.
B
(4)
eras
Technical
(b)
ac
Principles of Operation .
power to
DLTM
A2 and
Power Distribution
provides circuit
Unit
( PDU) A2A4
breaker protection to the
Controls and Indicators.
MAIN A circuit breaker: Controls ac power to CLK PWR and PWR SPLY circuit breaker.
CNVC OUT circuit breaker: Controls ac power to convenience outlets.
PWR SPLY circuit breaker: Controls ac power to Power Supply A2A6 through MAIN A circuit breaker.
O Controls ac power to FAN A2A10 . Θ
CNVC OUT ON
O
O
OFF
G
о
G
OFF LAMPS TEST
о DATA LINK TERM MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UIT O PROCESSOR MAINA ON ON ON C O Θ OFF OFF OFF BLOWEROP BLOWER CLKPAR ON ON
O
BLOWER circuit breaker :
→
O
cut
(a)
distributes main branch circuits .
ΤΟ
DOVE
Power Distribution Unit A2A4.
о
о
BLOWER OPR light: On indicates: •
CLK PWR circuit breaker:
Fan A2A10 is on . Pressure Switch A2A11
Controls ac power to Clock Power is ac-
Supply A2A9 through MAIN A circuit breaker.
tuated . LAMPS switch is ON.
CONTINUED
2-17
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
B
Data Link Terminal Module A2 Equipment Description - Continued .
LAMPS switch : ON
lights panel lights and supplies
ac power to BLOWER OPR light.
Panel Lights:
TEST - tests panel lights and BLOWER OPR light .
Light control switch is ON .
OFF BLOWER ON OFF
G
OFF LAMPS ON OFF TEST
→
0
Clock
LAMPS
OFF
OFF
О
28 VDC light (Green) : On indicates A1A9 is on .
OFF CLK PWR ON
BLOVER OPR
DGTL PROCESSOR ON
when
O
DATA LINK TERM MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT → MAIN PWR SPLY ON A ON 28 VDC
CNVC OUT ON
panel
O
0
DGTL PROCESSOR circuit breaker:
Power Supply
Controls ac power to cessor A2A2.
Digital
Pro-
CONTINUED
2-18
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
B
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS – Continued
Data Link Terminal Module A2 Equipment Description - Continued .
(5)
Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5.
(a) Technical Principles of Operation . Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5 is interface between Receiver-Transmitter A2A3 and the data link antenna . The tuner monitors power levels , filters the signal , and switches for transmit or receive functions .
(b)
Controls and Indicators.
POWER CONTROL·-
MANUAL control : Selected
by
MODE
TUNE-
switch .
Controls output power for tuning bandpass filter.
ANT switch : Allows tuning three filters for minimum reverse power.
MODE Switch : Selects either manual or auto•
matic
control
of
DLT output
Light (Yellow) : On indicates tuner controls en-
power. abled for bandpass filter tuning .
AUTO light (Green) : On indicates DLT output power
is on automatic control .
MODE AUTO
FAULT
TUNE
POWER CONTROL MANUAL
ANT
RESET
FREQ
Frequency Dial : Indicates operating frequency .
FORWARD POWER REVERSE POWER
TEST
DELAY
TUNE
DELAY control : Adjusts
rf phase .
Used with
TUNE
control to adjust for minimum reverse power.
FREQ control :
Selects operating frequency . CONTINUED
2-19
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1.
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
B
Data Link Terminal Module A2 Equipment Description - Continued .
FAULT•
•
FORWARD POWER -
RESET switch :
TEST switch :
Resets tuner fault latches and
When in TEST activates FOR-
tests all front panel lights.
WARD POWER meter. •
Light (Red) : On indicates tuner fault.
Meter: Indicates forward power measured at bandpass filter input.
POWER CONTROL MANUAL MODE AUTO
TUNE ANT
FAULT RESET
FORWARD POWER REVERSE POWER TEST
O
FREQ
DELAY
TUNE
Co の
REVERSE POWER meter: Indicates reverse power measured at bandpass filter input.
TUNE Control : Fine tunes
rf filters .
Used
with
DELAY control to adjust for minimum reverse power.
CONTINUED
2-20
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
B
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
Data Link Terminal Module A2 Equipment Description - Continued .
(6)
DLT Power Supply A2A6.
(a) Technical Principles of Operation . DLT Power Supply A2A6 provides dc power for DLT subassemblies.
(b)
Controls and Indicators.
POWER SUPPLY FAULT – PS1 thru PS5 LEDs (Red) : On indicates a fault in appli-
cable power supply . PS6 LED ( Red ) : On indicates a fault in DC to AC converter.
POWER SUPPLY FAULT
O PS1
O
O PS2
NON-INTERRUPT
PS3
LAMP TEST
PS4
O PS5
PS6
O
NONINTERRUPT LED :
LAMP TEST switch : (Red) : On indicates noninterrupt powTests LEDs . er is missing .
CONTINUED
2-21
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
C
Generator Set A6 Equipment Description .
(1 )
Technical Principles of Operation . Diesel driven Generator Set A6 supplies
on-board electrical power for launching station operation . Carries fuel for 8 hours operation . All controls located on control hours of fuel remains .
(2)
panel .
Sends fuel state to
ECS to alert
ECS when
1.5
Controls and Indicators.
Panel lights: Lights control
panel
when PANEL
LIGHTS switch is set to ON.
FAULT INDICATOR
O
e
GENERATOR
ENGINE
O
DOGARTTEMPERATURE
OKO
お ㅎ оо quneininon esto
(be
CCONTROL CIRCUITBREAKER LFOR EMERGENCYSTOP
CONTINUED
2-22
TM 9-1440-600-10
C
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
Generator Set A6 Equipment Description - Continued .
ENGINE -
AIR CLEANER
CONDITION light
(Red) :
On
indicates
engine
air
cleaner is clogged . •
OIL PRESSURE gage : Indicates engine lubricating oil pressure . COOLANT TEMPERATURE
Indicates engine
gage :
coolant tem-
perature . • •
FUEL LEVEL gage : Indicates main tank fuel level . BATTERY CHG AMMETER meter: Indicates dc current flow to and from battery .
•
RUNNING TIME hours.
•
ENGINE PRIMER switch : Actuates ether starting aid when STARTRUN-STOP switch held to START .
•
START-RUN - STOP switch :
meter: Indicates total
•
START - Starts engine.
•
STOP - Stops engine.
0 ·
2-1 .
system
FAULT INDICATOR
O
ENGINE
operating time in
GENERATOR
O
O
LONDITION
OPERATION
STOW
OPEN
OPERATION
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT PULLBREAKER FOR EMERGENCYSTOP
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-23
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
C
Generator Set A6 Equipment Description - Continued .
GENERATOR – HERTZ frequency meter: Indicates output frequency in Hertz.
PERCENT POWER kilowatt meter: Indicates power output in percent of rated power . PERCENT RATED CURRENT METER : Indicates percent of rated current output of phase selected by AMPS- VOLTS switch . •
VOLTS - AMPS switch : •
L1 - L2
L2- L3
selects line -to- neutral voltage to be in-
L3- L1
dicated on VOLTS A.C. meter.
L1 -LO
L2- LO
L3- LO : L1
L3 selects line-to- neutral volt-
L2
age to be indicated on VOLTS A.C. meter and line current to be indicated on PERCENT RATED CURRENT meter. •
VOLTS A.C. meter: Indicates line voltage output selected by AMPSVOLTS switch .
•
FREQUENCY ADJUST rheostat : Used to adjust generator set output frequency.
•
SYNCHRONIZING LIGHTS : Indicates frequency is synchronized between two parallel generator sets . VOLTAGE ADJUST rheostat : Used to adjust generator set output voltage .
O
o
PALLYINDICATOR O 301 * O
ENGINE
GENERATOR
111
O
оо
O
O
Q
お
Jo!
CONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULLFOR EMERGENCY STOP
CONTINUED
2-24
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
C
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
Generator Set A6 Equipment Description - Continued .
O
FALAT INDICATOR
O
O Ꮻ
GENERATOR
ENGINE CONDON
O O
COOLMESFELPE
oo
ð GROT VOLTAOP
6546 BATTLESHER
FARMERS
BATTLAGE
OPERATION о
O
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREARER PULLFOR EMERGENCY STOP
GENERATOR - Continued CKT BRK light (Yellow) : LS.
•
On
indicates ac power is connected to
CKT BRK switch : CLOSE connects ac power to LS. OPEN disconnects ac power from LS.
•
PANEL LIGHT switch : Turns panel lights on and off. VOLTAGE SENSING switch : Permits local or remote monitoring of the voltage regulator circuit.
•
PARALLEL OPERATION - SINGLE UNIT OPERATION switch : Selects single unit or parallel unit operation . BATTLE SHORTlight (Red) : On indicates generator set is operating with BATTLE SHORT switch set to ON. BATTLE SHORT switch: ON
bypasses
protective
devices circuits
except overspeed and short circuit to allow emergency operation . Also locks out starter circuit.
CONTINUED
2-25
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
C
Generator Set A6 Equipment Description - Continued .
FAULT INDICATOR LOW OIL PRESS light (Red) : On indicates engine oil pressure less than 20 ± 2 psi . •
•
OVERSPEED light (Red ) : On indicates engine speed reached 2400 to 2450 rpm . COOLANT HIGH
TEMP light (Red ) :
On
indicates
engine
coolant
temperature above 217°F ± 3°F ( 102.8°C ± 167°C). NO FUEL light (Red ) : On indicates day tank contains fuel for about 30 seconds operation .
O
O
O
O
O
SHORT CIRCUIT light (Red): On indicates the
FAULT INDICATOR ·
GENERATOR
ENGINE
short circuit
protective
device has operated .
O
OVERLOAD light (Red): On indicates output load
SOOLAND "DWATE on any phase is 130% of rated load .
FREE ART UNDER (Red) : CIRCDCALLONTROL BREAKER ENCYFORSTOP
о
VOLT
On
light
indicates
in-
stantly if output voltage is below 48 volts , or in 6 ± 2 seconds if output voltage drops to 99 ± 4 volts.
1 AMP fuse : Protects fault light circuits .
UNDER
FREQ
light
(Red) : On indicates output frequency less than 370 ± 5 Hz .
TEST OR RESET switch : Tests and resets fault lights .
•
OVER VOLT light (Red) : On indicates output voltage above 153 ± 3 Hz for 180 milliseconds .
DC CONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER : REVERSE POWER light Applies 24 Vdc to control circuits . Pull to remove 24 Vdc from control circuits .
(Red):
On
indicates re-
verse power is over 20 percent.
CONTINUED
2-26
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
D
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORSContinued
Launcher Mechanics A7 Equipment Description . Launcher Mechanics A7 is an electrically operated mechanical structure . It stores, aims , and serves as a stable platform for firing up to four GM .
(1 )
Engagement Control Handle.
(a)
Technical Principles of Operation . The engagement control handle is used
to select operating modes for Launcher Mechanics A7. It must be in for the ECS to train the LS when in remote operation .
(b)
ROTATE position
Controls and Indicators.
5T
ROTATE ELE >
nile tripia Muot
ROADMARCH ROADSIDE
ROTATE position :
Disengages zero lock plunger and engages azimuth
drive gears . Must be in this position to rotate launcher mechanics . Engages zero lock plunger and engages azimuth drive gears. Must be in this position to elevate launcher mechanics. ELEV position :
ROAD MARCH : Engages zero lock plunger and disengages azimuth drive gears. Must be in this position to safely perform road march .
CONTINUED
2-27
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
D
Launcher Mechanics A7 Equipment Description - Continued .
(2)
Steadyrest. A travel lock pin on each steadyrest locks platform down . When
pins are inserted they press travel lock sensor switches plunger. This signals launcher electronics that platform is locked down and stops platform from being raised .
(3) erated by
Elevation Actuators A7A6 and A7A7. Raise platform to firing position . OpRAISE - STOP - LWR switch and
An extend limit switch
in
START switch on
LCU
Display Panel A1A14 .
roadside Actuator A6 automatically stops drive
motors when
raised to 38°. Limit switch in curbside Actuator A7A7 is a backup switch . If backup switch operates , power to azimuth and elevation drives stop . Both actuators retract limit switches operate at 0° (platform on steadyrest) and stop drive motors when lowering . Covers over handcrank extension hold handcrank safety switches closed . When covers are removed , safety switches open and remove power to azimuth and elevation drive motors.
(4)
Launcher Base . Supports other LM assemblies . CW and ccw limit switches
limit turntable rotation .
First ,
No.
1 , switch in either direction stops azimuth drive motor
110° from 180° position . Second , No. 2 , switch is a backup to prevent damage . Switches are operated by switch bracket on azimuth bearing . When either No. 1
switch operates ,
azimuth drive in that direction stops . If either No. 2 switch is operated , power to azimuth and elevation drives is stopped .
(5)
Launcher Platform . Supports , alines and raises the four GM . Eight alinement
pins aline the two bottom GM . Four pins for each GM . Each GM canister has four alinement pins on top to aline top GM .
(6)
Turntable.
Bolted
between platform and
azimuth bearing .
Rear of elevation
actuators are bolted to turntable to allow them to rotate . Actuating arm for antenna lower mast assembly is also bolted to turntable . This allows antenna to turn with the GM. An ALIGNMENT DATUM is used
as a reference point when
measuring
LS angle with the
gunner's quadrant .
CONTINUED
2-28
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
D
Launcher Mechanics A7 Equipment Description - Continued .
(7) Platform
Azimuth Drive Unit .
Drives turntable through azimuth bearing to point GM .
has to be elevated to get dc power to motor. In
local mode , CCW- STOP- CW
switch on LCU Display Panel A1A14 operates this unit . In remote mode ,
ECS can train
GM. Gear trains inside actuator are connected and disconnected by engagement control handle. This handle operates an arm on actuator through a push - pull control cable . When engagement control handle is in ROTATE or ELEV position gear train is connected . When engagement control handle is in ROADMARCH position gear train is disconnected . When gear train is disconnected LM is not held in azimuth by azimuth drive unit . An overspeed switch in actuator stops
electric
power to dc motor if motor overspeeds .
Switch resets
automatically . Digital Encoder A7A1 sends azimuth position to ECS by digital data link .
(8)
Azimuth Bearing . Supports load of turntable , launcher platform , and four GM .
Zero lock plunger locks bearing
in
180° position .
Plunger is engaged when turntable is
positioned at 180° and engagement control handle is in ELEV or ROADMARCH
position .
Plunger is disengaged in ROTATE position . Zero lock sensor switch signals LE that zero lock plunger is locked or unlocked . When 180° pointer is alined with alinement strip gage on base, turntable is at 180° position .
(9)
Data Link Mast Assembly.
Used to receive and transmit data between LS
and ECS . Mast assembly raises and rotates with launcher platform .
CONTINUED
2-29
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
E
Missile Round Cable Test Set A8 Equipment Description .
(1 )
Technical Principles of Operation . Portable test set used to insure that sys-
tem is safe before connecting a signal cable to GM . Has self-test feature . Requires power from LE to operate .
(2)
Controls and Indicators .
NO GO light ( Red) : On indicates test failed . STEP
SAFE TO TEST light (Green) : On indicates LE safe to test.
dis-
plays test number.
POWER ON light : Indicates power on .
GO light (Green) : On indicates tests passed . STEP displays 99.
POWER switch :
POWER ON
Turns power on.
OFF
OWER BETO NOO
GO RESET
START START switch :
STEP Starts test when STEP reset to 00 . ⚫
Θ
RESET switch : Resets STEP to 00 .
Θ
Θ STEP display: Displays test number 00 to 99. When test fails , displays failed test number and NO GO light is on . When test passes , displays 99 and GO light is on.
CONTINUED
2-30
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
F
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORS Continued
Canister Heaters Power Control Box 23A1 Equipment Description .
(1 ) heaters.
Technical Principles of Operation . Controls ac power to each of the canister
(2)
Controls and Indicators.
CANISTER HEATER POWER UPR L light (Green ) : On indicates power applied to upper left canister heater. UPR L switch: Controls ac power to upper left canister heater . LWRL light (Green ) : On indicates power applied to lower left canister heater. LWR L switch: Controls ac power to lower left canister heater. UPR R light (Green) : canister heater.
On
indicates
power applied to
upper right
• UPR R switch: Controls ac power to upper right canister heater. LWR R light (Green) : canister heater.
On
indicates
power applied to lower right
• LWR R switch: Controls ac power to lower right canister heater.
0
UPA L LWRL UPR R LWR R
O
O TTETT TT
0
O
CANISTER HEATER POWER
CONTINUED
T
2-31
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-1 .
DESCRIPTION AND USE OF OPERATOR'S CONTROLS AND INDICATORSContinued
G
Outrigger Control Panel Description .
(1 )
Technical Principles of Operation . Controls 28 Vdc power to semitrailer out-
rigger motors . Power supplied by tractor.
(2)
Controls and Indicators.
OUTRIGGERS -
REAR switches :
POWER switch : Controls power to OUTRIGGERS switches and LEVELING DIAL
Up raises outrigger. Down lowLIGHT.
er outrigger. Top switch controls roadside . Bottom switch controls curbside . FRONT switches: Up raises outrigger. Down lowers outrigger. Top switch controls roadside . Bottom switch
OFF
ON
POWER
controls curbside .
REAR OUTRIGGERS FRONT
Leveling Dial Light : Lights leveling device when POWER
switch is ON .
LEVELING DEVICE : Circular bubble -type launching station in center of five
level .
When
is level , bubble is circles marked on
glass . Each circle indicates 1 ° off level .
2-32
TM 9-1440-600-10
Section II .
2-2.
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE CHECKS AND SERVICES
GENERAL
The
purpose
of preventive
maintenance
checks
and
services
( PMCS)
is to detect
the first signs of defects and to insure that corrective action is taken before serious equipment damage or faults occur.
2-3.
RESPONSIBILITY
Crewmembers are responsible for performing PMCS in accordance with the following paragraphs .
2-4.
INTERVALS
The standards for determining frequency of PMCS are operating hours and road movement. Since operating time and mileage in the field cannot be accurately predicted , calendar intervals are used . The calendar intervals are based on frequent use . Operation
under
unusual conditions , such as extreme temperature or abnormal operating periods , may require that intervals the
need.
During
be adjusted .
long
Reduce the intervals when
inactive periods extend the
unusual conditions indicate
intervals when authorized
by higher
authority.
2-5.
GENERAL PROCEDURES FOR ALL SERVICES AND INSPECTIONS
General . The general
procedures defined
In addition to any specific procedures given ,
in this paragraph apply to all
general
PMCS.
procedures that apply to an item
will be performed without instructions .
b.
Definition of Terms . General inspection of each item
is a check to see if the
item is in good condition , correctly assembled or stowed , secure ,
not excessively worn ,
not leaking , and properly lubricated . Inspection of each item applies to supporting or connecting materiel associated with it.
CONTINUED
T
2-33
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-5.
GENERAL PROCEDURES FOR ALL SERVICES AND INSPECTIONS- Continued
Terms associated with inspections are defined below:
(1 )
Inspection for good condition
is usually an external visual inspection to de-
termine if the unit is damaged beyond safe or serviceable limits . Good condition is defined further as meaning
not
bent or twisted ,
chafed or burred ,
broken or cracked ,
bare or
frayed , dented or collapsed , torn or cut, or deteriorated .
(2)
Inspection of a unit to see that it is correctly assembled or stowed is usually
a visual inspection to see if the
unit is in its normal
position
in the materiel and if all
its parts are present and in their correct relative position .
(3) inspection
Inspection of a unit to determine if it is secure is usually an external visual or a check by hand
or wrench for looseness .
Such an
inspection
includes
brackets , lockwashers , locknuts , locking wires, or cotter pins as well as connecting tubes , hoses, or electrical cables.
(4)
Excessively worn means beyond serviceable limits , or worn to a point where
the unit is likely to fail if it is not replaced before the next scheduled inspection . Excessive wear of mating
parts
motion). It includes
or
linkage
is
usually
evidenced
by too
not readable as applied to markings ,
much
play (lash
data and caution
or lost
plates, and
printer matter.
(5)
Such expressions as " adjust if necessary" or " replace if necessary" are not
used in PMCS procedures . It is understood that whenever inspection
reveals the need
for adjustment , repair, or replacement , the necessary action will be taken .
STAY CLEAR OF LAUNCHER MECHANICS PLANE OF ROTATION UNTIL KEYSWITCH IS SET TO LOCAL, LOCAL LIGHT IS ON, AND KEY IS REMOVED . WHEN KEYSWITCH IS SET
WARNING TO RMT, TURNTABLE CAN BE ROTATED REMOTELY CAUSING INJURY TO PERSONNEL WITHIN PLANE OF ROTATION .
CONTINUED )
2-34
TM 9-1440-600-10 GENERAL PROCEDURES FOR ALL SERVICES AND INSPECTIONS - Continued
2-5.
Conditions. Before starting PMCS you must verify that the
LOCAL- RMT switch
on LCU Display Panel A1A14 is set to LOCAL and the key is removed . If the system is energized verify that the
LOCAL lamp is on . When PMCS is complete the launching
station (LS) may rejoin the firing platoon or execute road march .
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE CHECKS AND SERVICES
2-6 .
Preventive
maintenance
crewmember are listed
checks
below .
These
and
services
( PMCS)
procedures are to be
to
be
performed
performed
by the
at the intervals
listed . All faults found will be reported in accordance with TM 38-750.
W = Weekly
M = Monthly
Q = Quarterly
S
Semiannually
INTERVAL ITEM TO BE CHECKED
ITEM NO.
PROCEDURE WMQS
1
GENERATOR SET (GS) A6 Refer to TM 5-6115-464-12 for PMCS .
1.1
SEMITRAILER , FLATBED , LAUNCHER GROUP Refer to TM 9-2330-357-14& P for PMCS.
1.2
LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE (LEM ) A1 and DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE ( DLTM ) A2 Drain water from module .
NOTES
1.
Do this step daily if humidity is high.
2.
Drain plug is captive . It does not come out .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-35
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-6 .
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE CHECKS AND SERVICES - Continued
M = Monthly
W = Weekly
Q = Quarterly
S = Semiannually
INTERVAL
ITEM NO.
ITEM TO BE CHECKED PROCEDURE WMQS
Under front center of each module , loosen drain plug , using 3/4-inch wrench . Leave drain plug loose until all water drains . Tighten drain plug . If water is in
either access door channel ,
remove it with
a rag or sponge . Inspect external surfaces of each module for:
Cleanliness •
Chipped paint Corrosion Breaks or cracks
2
LAUNCHER MISSILE ROUND DISTRIBUTOR ( LMRD) A3 Drain water from module .
NOTES
1.
Do this step daily if humidity is high.
2.
Drain plug is captive . They do not come out.
CONTINUED
2-36
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-6 .
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE CHECKS AND SERVICES - Continued
W = Weekly
M = Monthly
Q = Quarterly
S = Semiannually
INTERVAL ITEM TO BE CHECKED PROCEDURE
ITEM NO. WMQS
Under front of module , 3/4-inch wrench .
loosen three
drain
plugs ,
using
Leave drain plugs loose until all water drains . Tighten three drain plugs .
Inspect external surfaces for: Cleanliness •
Chipped paint Corrosion
Breaks or cracks
3
EXTERNAL CABLES , CONNECTORS , AND RECEPTACLES
NOTE
Do not disconnect cable connectors for this inspection .
Inspect for breaks , tears , and physical damage.
4
LAUNCHER MECHANICS ( LM ) Inspect external surfaces for: •
•
Cleanliness
Chipped paint Corrosion
Breaks or cracks
CONTINUED
2-37
TM 9-1440-600-10
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE CHECKS AND SERVICES - Continued
2-6.
W = Weekly
M = Monthly
Q = Quarterly
S = Semiannually
INTERVAL ITEM TO BE CHECKED ITEM NO. WMQS
PROCEDURE AZIMUTH BEARING
5 Oil gear teeth per LO 9-1440-600-14. Grease bearings per LO 9-1440-600-14 . ELEVATION ACTUATORS
6 Grease rod-end fitting bearings per LO 9-1440-600-14. ANTENNA MAST EJECTION LINK 7 Grease rod-end fitting bearings per LO 9-1440-600-14 .
2-7.
LUBRICATION INSTRUCTIONS
Lubrication instructions are in LO 9-1440-600-14.
2-38
TM 9-1440-600-10
Section III .
2-8.
OPERATION UNDER USUAL CONDITIONS
EMPLACEMENT
SITE PREPARATION — A site selection the emplacement site .
and
This team will position
evaluation team will select and mark
marker stakes for launching station
( LS)
location and orientation . The LS crewmembers will position the LS exactly on these markers . Refer to TM 9-1425-600-10 for site preparation information . ORIENTING AND ALINING - Accurate target firing data and
successful target en-
gagement largely depend on alinement of the firing platoon (FP) . The LS is alined after the radar set ( RS) has been oriented to a north reference . The preferred emplacement position for the LS is with its rear end toward the RS. The RS should be within a 30° arc centered on the LS. If the proper procedures are not carefully followed , effective target engagement will be degraded . The FP is normally oriented so that north , east, south , and west coordinates are accurately displayed at the engagement control station (ECS) . The north reference is necessary for radar location and orientation and for generating remote azimuth training commands. The LS is oriented with the FP by determining
its
position relative to the RS. To determine this position the following angles must be measured with an aiming circle . •
Azimuth angle between LS and RS.
•
Azimuth angle between LS and north reference .
•
Elevation angle between LS and RS .
ROADSIDE
30°
LAUNCHING STATION
RADAR SET
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-39
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
LAUNCHER LOCATION/ALINEMENT DATA
(1 )
LS NUMBER
zz
heeeeeennnnnnn
(2)
UTM
(3)
METERS ALTITUDE
(4)
BRNG NREF TO LS Bearing of Reference M2 Sighted on Launcher M2
(5)
(6)
•
0
BRNG LS TO NREF Bearing of Launcher Sighted on Reference M2
0
BRNG LS TO RDR Bearing of Launcher M2 Sighted on Radar M2
(7)
0
0
EL LS TO RDR Elevation of Launcher M2 •
0
·
0
Sighted on Radar M2
(8)
(9)
(10)
ROLL
CROSS ROLL
MISSILE UMBILICALS CONNECTED
0
UL
UR
LL
LR
NOTE UTM Emplacement , Fill in items 1 , 2, 3 , 4 , 5 , 8 , 9 , 10 LOS Emplacement, Fill in items 1 , 4, 5, 6 , 7 , 8, 9 , 10
2-40
CONTINUED
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
The procedure in this paragraph is used when line-of-sight ( LOS) exists between the LS and the RS. If LOS does not exist , the crewmembers will have to perform field survey and traverse as described in FM 6-2 , Field Artillery Survey. The data from the field survey and traverse
operation
will have to be converted
into the form
required
for
LOS em-
placement.
LS roll and cross- roll angles must be measured with a gunner's quadrant to determine LS attitude. Instructions for measuring these angles are included in this paragraph .
All data required for orienting and alining the LS must be entered on the LAUNCHER LOCATION /ALINEMENT DATA FORM . The form
must be accurately completed
and the
information promptly given to the ECS . A sample of the form is on the opposite page . BLACKOUT CONDITIONS - Emplacement is essentially the same during
daylight,
nighttime , and blackout conditions . Nighttime does not always mean blackout . When blackout conditions are in effect blackout flashlights must be used . At night when blackout conditions are
not in
effect
regular lights
may be
used . The following
general
precautions
must
be observed when emplacing under nighttime or blackout conditions.
Use signals per FM 21-60.
Use flashlights . Be aware of each crewmember's position . Get help when tasks cannot be easily performed in the dark. Put tools and equipment away after using them . Make all movements sure and deliberate . Do not climb on the LS unless required . Crewmembers on the LS must be watched by another crewmember and warned of unsafe conditions . • •
Do not move vehicles without a guide . Observe all cautions and warnings called out in the procedure and
marked
on the equipment . Do not rush .
When light is limited , guides must be used to direct the driver to the site . Guide's general instructions are as follows :
•
Inspect the path the LS must follow for soft spots , shoulders, and obstructions . Either clear the area or guide the driver around the hazards. Describe the approach to the driver. The guide's position
is left-front of the vehicle ,
at a safe distance from the
vehicle , in sight of the driver . If visibility is bad , use two guides , one in front and one by the side of the driver.
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-41
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
Do not lose visual contact with the driver. If visual contact is lost , the driver must stop the vehicle. Orientation and alinement at night are essentially the same as during daylight .
GENERATOR SET A6
OUTRIGGER CONTROL PANEL
CURBSIDE
DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2
FRONT STOWAGE CONTAINER
CURBSIDE STOWAGE BOX CANISTER HEATERS POWER CONTROL BOX 23A1
CONTINUED
2-42
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
E: DATA LINK MAST ASSEMBLY
GUIDED MISSILE (4)
ROADSIDE
LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE
ROADSIDE STOWAGE BOX ENGAGEMENT CONTROL HANDLE
REAR STOWAGE CONTAINER
Personnel Required . Three Tools and Equipment Required . Aiming Circle, M2, with equipment Quadrant, Gunner's Rod , Ground , with attachments ( MIL- R- 11461 , STYLE 2 , TYPE 2)
Lead , Electrical (Grounding Cable) , 42W3 ( 10253829-9) Pole , Range
Level , Rod Hammer, Hand Sledge , 6- Lb Pliers, Slip Joint, 12-In . Screwdriver, Flat Tip , 1 /4- In .
CONTINUED
T
2-43
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-8.
EMPLACEMENT Continued
MISSILES DROPPED ACCIDENTALLY MAY BE DANGEROUS.
La REPORT ANY DROP OF 12 INCHES OR MORE IMMEDIATELY WARNING
AND PROCEED AS FOLLOWS :
IF MISSILE IS STILL IN CANISTER , CONSIDER MISSILE TO BE UNARMED. DO NOT MOVE MISSILE FOR 1 HOUR AFTER INCIDENT. AFTER 1 HOUR , UNIT COMMANDER MAY DIRECT MISSILE TO BE REMOVED TO DEPOT. IF
MISSILE
IS
PARTLY
OR
COMPLETELY
OUT
OF
CANISTER, CONSIDER MISSILE TO BE ARMED. TELL YOUR UNIT COMMANDER AND EVACUATE AREA.
DEATH MAY RESULT FROM EXPLOSION .
Le WARNING
CREWMEMBERS ON LAUNCHING STATION (LS) MUST WATCHED BY OTHER CREWMEMBERS AND WARNED
BE OF
UNSAFE CONDITIONS TO PREVENT INJURY.
A DAMAGED CANISTER CAN INDICATE AN UNUSABLE MISSILE . REPORT ANY CANISTER DAMAGE IMMEDIATELY. UNIT COMMANDER WILL DECIDE IF MISSILE IS TO BE REPLACED OR USED.
CAUTION
DO NOT MOVE GUIDED MISSILE (GM ) WITHIN 50 FEET OF AN RF SOURCE THAT RADIATES 50 WATTS OR MORE .
CAUTION
1
POSITION LS AT PREPARED SITE .
a.
One crewmember guide driver to position LS exactly on markers.
DO NOT LEAVE TRACTOR UNATTENDED WITHOUT CHOCK-
Le WARNING
ING WHEELS . TRACTOR MAY ROLL , RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
CONTINUED 2-44
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
-
Continued .
1
b.
Pull out tractor PARKING BRAKE control , place transmission range selector lever in neutral (N ) , and leave engine running .
C.
Remove chock blocks from stowage in tractor roadside stowage box and chock tractor rear wheels as follows:
STOWAGE eee
(1 )
eee
ee
If tractor is facing uphill , place chock blocks behind tractor rear wheels ,
both
curbside
and
roadside .
ROADSIDE
(2)
If tractor is facing downhill , place chock blocks in front of rear wheels, both curbside and roadside .
OMUORO ROADSIDE
(3)
If tractor is level , place chock block in front of rear wheel on curbside and behind rear wheel
CURBSIDE ONLY
on roadside .
ROADSIDE ONLY
ROADSIDE
Through remainder of this procedure , chock blocks will be shown
NOTE
for tractor as in level position Chock as described in step c.
above
unless grade
is shown .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-45
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
ELECTRICAL POWER MUST NOT BE APPLIED TO LS UNTIL
Le
LS IS SUITABLY GROUNDED. DEATH BY ELECTROCUTION WARNING CAN RESULT FROM OPERATING AN UNGROUNDED LS .
2
INSTALL GROUND ROD.
a.
Get two ground rod sections , two couplings , a driving stud , a grounding clamp, and Grounding Cable 42W3 from roadside stowage box .
GROUND ROD ROADSIDE
DRIVING STUD
b.
Connect coupling to ground section
and
install
driving
rod -COUPLING
stud .
Make sure driving stud seats on ground rod . GROUND ROD SECTION
C.
Locate ground rod no farther than 25 feet from
LS Ground Connector 42J3.
Using 6- pound sledge hammer , drive ground rod section into ground until coupling is just above surface .
d.
Remove driving pling . Install
stud from
second
cou-
section
of
ground rod . Make sure second section seats on first section .
e.
Install another coupling and driving stud on top of second section of ground rod. Make sure driving stud seats on second section .
CONTINUED
2-46
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
2
f.
Continued .
Drive second section of ground rod into ground until coupling is just above surface .
Ground rod must be driven to minimum depth of 5 feet ( 1.52 NOTE meters) to provide effective ground .
g.
Remove driving stud and top coupling from ground rod .
h.
Connect ground bolt.
clamp and Grounding
Cable 42W3 to ground
rod . Tighten
GROUNDING 'CABLE 42W3
GROUND CLAMP
i.
Connect Grounding Cable 42W3 to LS semitrailer Connector 42J3.
64
DAIRE JACIRY?
42J3
42W3
ROADSIDE
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-47
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
3
EXTEND WORK PLATFORMS .
a.
At curbside and roadside gooseneck platforms :
(1 )
Raise and hold latch handle to release work platform .
LATCH HANDLE
GOOSENECK WORK PLATFORM
ROADSIDE
TYPICAL 2 PLACES
SIDE WORK PLATFORM
HOOD LATCH TYPICAL 2 PLACES
(2)
Carefully fold out work platform .
(3)
Release latch handle
b.
FENDER WORK PLATFORM
At fender work platform and side work platform :
(1 )
Release hood latch .
(2)
Fold out work platform .
CONTINUED
2-48
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10 EMPLACEMENT — Continued
2-8 .
DO NOT START GENERATOR SET A6
UNTIL
LS IS CON-
NECTED TO SUITABLE GROUND . DEATH BY ELECTROCUWARNING
TION CAN
RESULT FROM OPERATING
AN
UNGROUNDED
LS.
GENERATOR SET A6 MAY BE DAMAGED IF SLAVE RECEPTACLE IS USED FOR ANY PURPOSE OTHER THAN SLAVE STARTING . REFER TO TM 5-6115-464-12 FOR GENERATOR CAUTION
4
SET OPERATION BEYOND THAT COVERED IN THIS TM.
START GENERATOR SET A6.
a.
Perform before operation checks and services in TM 5-6115-464-12 .
b.
Open and latch Generator Set A6 control cubicle and air vent doors.
CONTINUED
2-49
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
4
C.
Continued.
Verify that DC CONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER is pushed in (closed) .
FAULT INDICATOR
O Ꮻ
GENERATOR
ENGINE
O O O
GODLAND DC CONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULL FOR EMERGENCY STOP
ō
оо
UPEN
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULLFOR EMERGENCYSTOP
O
d.
Set START- RUN - STOP switch to START
RUN . RUN
STOP
e.
Set BATTLESHORT switch to ON.
ON
OFF BATTLE SHORT
1.
Fuel transfer pump makes clicking sounds when transfering fuel into day tank. Pump will stop when day tank is full .
NOTES 2.
START- RUN - STOP switch must remain in
RUN ,
and BATTLE-
SHORT switch must remain ON until day tank is filled.
CONTINUED
2-50
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
Continued .
4
f.
Check that FUEL LEVEL gage indicates acceptable fuel level .
FAULT INDICATOR
о GENERATOR
O
O
LEVEL
FUEL LEVEL DCCONTROL CIRCUIT FORSTOP FULLBREAKER EMERGENCY
g.
Check that LOW OIL PRESS UNDER VOLT and UNDER
LOW OIL PRESS
UNDER VOLT
UNDER FREQ
FREQ lights are on .
h.
When day tank is full
(about 2
ON
minutes) , clicking sound stops . Set BATTLESHORT switch to
10
FAULT INDICATOR O
LOW OIL PRESS
COOLANT HIGH TEMP
OVER SPEED
NO FUEL
SHORT CIRCUIT
OVER LOAD
UNDER VOLT
UNDER FREQ
REVERSE POWER
OVER VOLT
OFF OFF . Lower safety guard. BATTLE SHORT
i.
Hold
TEST OR
RESET switch
down and check that all INDICATOR lights
FAULT
are
on .
TEST OR RESET
Release switch .
DO NOT CRANK
ENGINE FOR
MORE THAN
15 SECONDS
AT A TIME . ALLOW STARTER TO COOL AT LEAST 3 MINUTES BETWEEN TRIES . CAUTION
CONTINUED
2-51
TM 9-1440-600-10
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
2-8.
— 4
Continued .
If outside temperature NOTE
j.
is
50°F
( 10°C)
or
below,
perform
step
j . If temperature is above 50° F ( 10°C) , perform step k .
If temperature is 50° F ( 10°C) or below, start Generator Set A6 with start aid procedure as follows:
(1 )
Hold START- RUN -STOP switch to START for 15 seconds or until OIL PRESSURE gage indicates oil pressure and VOLTS A.C. meter indicates voltage .
FAULT INDICATOR O GENERATOR
ENGINE
OVER SPEED
ENGINE PRIMER ON
START
RUN お
O STOP OPENTION O
press
о
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT PULLBREAKER FORSTOP EMERGENCY
(2)
While engine is cranking , ether, then release switch .
ENGINE PRIMER switch to
ON to inject
(3)
Release switch to RUN after 15 seconds or when engine starts . When engine starts , go to step 5.
DO NOT INJECT ETHER MORE THAN THREE TIMES.
CAUTION
(4)
If engine does not start within 15 seconds, release START- RUN - STOP switch . Allow starter to cool for 3 minutes.
CONTINUED
2-52
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
-
Continued .
4
(5)
Repeat steps
( 1 ) and
(3) .
If engine does
not start after three tries ,
call
Engineer Maintenance .
137
k.
If temperature is above 50° F ( 10°C) , start engine normally.
(1 )
Hold START- RUN - STOP switch to START for 15 seconds or until OIL PRESSURE gage indicates oil pressure and VOLTS A.C. meter indicates voltage .
FAULTINDICATOR 2
GENERATOR #
ENGINE
120
AIRCLESSER
VOLTIJETER O
POWER
PRESS DOGLANTTEMPERATURE
OIL PRESSURE
оо
IMOLENDSAD
お O BATTLE SHO
START RUN
CEED O
DCCONTROL CIRCLAY PLALBREAKER FORSTOP EMERGENCY
O
STOP
012
335
ES
(2)
If engine does not start within 15 seconds , release START- RUN - STOP switch . Allow starter to cool for 3 minutes.
(3)
Repeat step ( 1 ) . If engine does Maintenance .
not start
after three tries ,
call
Engineer
CONTINUED
2-53
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT- Continued
Le WARNING
5
TO AVOID INJURY, DO NOT STEP ON LS CABLES OR BUNDLES.
PREPARE MODULES AND OUTRIGGERS FOR OPERATION .
a.
At rear of Launcher
Electronics
Module (LEM ) A1
and
Data
Link Terminal
Module ( DLTM) A2 , unsnap six snap fasteners at bottom and sides inlet cover. Roll up and tie each cover.
of air
16 Wher
TYPICAL LEM A1 DLTM A2
b.
On both sides of each module ,
origns wollA
(S)
unsnap eight snap fasteners at bottom and
sides of air exhaust cover. Roll up and tie each cover.
CONTINUED
2-54
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
5
-
C.
Continued .
Unhook snap hook and release front curbside outrigger safety chain. TRA VEL FOR TLAO CTOICA L
2-8.
SAFETY CHAIN/
CURBSIDE
d.
Remove curbside travel lockpin .
(1 )
Press and button.
(2)
Pull lockpin out of steadyrest.
(3)
Install lockpin in stowage bracket.
hold
lockpin
push-
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-55
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued —
5
Continued .
USE WHEEL CHOCK BLOCKS WHEN UNCOUPLING TO PREVENT DAMAGE TO SEMITRAILER .
CAUTION
Remove chock blocks from stowage and chock semitrailer wheels as follows:
e.
(1 )
If LS is facing
uphill ,
place
chock blocks
behind semitrailer rear wheels ,
both curbside and roadside .
CHOCK BLOCK -reuq
miqpisol blor
bre
STOWAGE CHOCK BOTH SIDES ROADSIDE
(2)
If LS is facing downhill, place chock blocks in front of semitrailer rear wheels, both curbside and roadside .
CHOCK BOTH SIDES
ROADSIDE
CONTINUED
2-56
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
EMPLACEMENT
2-8 .
-
Continued .
5
(3)
If LS is level , place chock block in front of rear wheel behind rear wheel on roadside .
on curbside and
CHOCK ROADSIDE ONLY CHOCK CURBSIDE ONLY ROADSIDE
Through remainder of this procedure , chock blocks will be shown
NOTE
for LS as in level position above unless grade is shown . Chock as described in step e.
f.
Unhook snap hooks and release rear curbside and roadside safety chains .
g.
( Deleted) .
h.
(Deleted) .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-56.1 /(2-56.2 blank)
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
5
6
—
Continued .
i.
Remove roadside travel lockpin .
j.
(Deleted)
VERIFY LAUNCHING STA AND FIRING PLATOON SWITCHES ARE SET TO CORRECT ADDRESSES .
a.
Open both
LEM
A1
doors . If wind
is
over 45
knots ,
insert locking
pin in
hole at top of door.
b.
If water is in channel at bottom of either LEM door, remove water with cloth or sponge.
B
CONTINUED
T
Change 1
2-57
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
Continued .
6
C.
On LCU Display Panel A1A14, verify that LAUNCHING STA and FIRING PLATOON Switches are set to correct addresses. O BITE PLATFORM
3
O
LAUNCHER
7
POWER SUPPLIES -n UNDER MISSILE MISSAL NAZARO
O
LAUNCHING STA 1 2
O
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
0
FIRING PLATOON 1
STOP
O
START
10
6
RAISE
O
5
O
READY LCMB PLATFORM 이이 이이 RAIDED AZMUTH MEADY READY OOO DISCOR MECTED 0101010
2 B
ODO
O
ATOON
5
3
7
оо
O OFF
o
0
TETEST STATUS LAR STATUS LAMPTEST
UNHOOK SNAP HOOK AND RELEASE FRONT ROADSIDE OUTRIGGER SAFETY CHAIN .
8
CLOSE GENERATOR SET A6 CIRCUIT BREAKER AS FOLLOWS .
a.
Check output voltage.
(1 )
Set VOLT-AMPS switch to positions L1 - LO , L2- LO , and L3 - LO . VOLTS A.C. meter should indicate 120 Vac red line in each position .
PALLY INDICATOR
GENERATOR
ENGINE
L1-LO
L3-L1
OOO
#
A.C. VOLTMETER
500 -LL1
LLO3-
AMPS VOLTS
ㅎ
оо
INCREASE
SATELE SHOR START
88
G
SROLEUNEY OPERATION
OPEN O
DCCONTROK CHICLIT PULLBREAKER FORSTOP EMERGENCY
VOLTAGE ADJUST
CONTINUED
2-58
TM 9-1440-600-10
EMPLACEMENT — Continued
2-8 .
—
Continued .
8
(2)
Set VOLTS- AMPS switch to positions L1 - L2 , L2- L3 , and L3- L1 . VOLTS A.C. meter should indicate 208 Vac red line in each position .
(3)
If voltage in any position is wrong , set VOLTS-AMPS switch to that position and use VOLTAGE ADJUST rheostat to adjust to correct voltage .
(4) b.
If voltage had to be adjusted , repeat steps ( 1 ) and (2) .
Check HERTZ frequency meter for 400 Hz indication . If necessary, use FREQUENCY ADJUST rheostat to adjust frequency to 400 Hz.
FAULTINDICATOR GENERATOR
ENGINE
IPLES
ARCLEANER
HE TZ
COOLANTCEMPERATU
09
お
INCREASE ON
O
O
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT PULLBREAKER FORSTOP EMERGENCY
FREQUENCY ADJUST
GENERATOR SET A6 MUST RUN AT LEAST 3 MINUTES TO CAUTION
NOTE
WARM UP BEFORE CIRCUIT BREAKER IS CLOSED.
Step 8c applies power to the LS.
CONTINUED
2-59
TM 9-1440-600-10 EMPLACEMENT — Continued
2-8 .
-
Continued .
8
C.
After 3 minutes engine warmup,
O CKT BRK
press CKT BRK switch to CLOSE until CKT BRK light comes on.
CKT BRK CLOSE
OPEN
IF
ANY GENERATOR
SET A6 FAULT
INDICATOR
LIGHT
COMES ON, SHUT DOWN GENERATOR SET A6 AND CALL ENGINEER MAINTENANCE .
CAUTION
Check indicators for normal in-
d.
dications :
All FAULT INDICATOR lights off.
(1 )
FAULT INDICATOR
LOW OIL PRESS
COOLANT HIGH TEMP
OVER SPEED
NO FUEL
SHORT CIRCUIT
OVER LOAD
UNDER VOLT
UNDER FREQ
REVERSE POWER
OVER VOLT
FAULT INDICATOR
O GENERATOR
ENGINE
ARGLEANER COMPTAIN
O O
EVERSI
COOLANT TEMPERATU · ㅎ
09
お BATTLESHOR
START
ON OFF
O
O
OPERATION
DCCONTROL BREAKER CIRCUIT PULLFOR EMERGENCY STOP
O
A.C. VOLTMETER
meter
(2)
VOLTS A.C. 120 Vac.
(3)
HERTZ frequency dicates 400 Hz.
indicates
meter
in-
HE TZ 500
CONTINUED
2-60
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
— 8
Continued .
(4)
OIL PRESSURE gage indicates 30 to 55 psig .
(5)
COOLANT TEMPERATURE gage indicates 170°F to 200°F.
OOOO
O
FAULTINDICATOR ·
O GENERATOR
ENGINE ARCLEANER
120 T PRESS
Lhen
120 TEMP F
O
FREUENCYAUST
854 OIL PRESSURE
BATTLEMOR
COOLANT TEMPERATURE START SPOR
9
AT LEM POWER CONTROL PANEL
OPENFOR OPEN
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULLFOR EMERGENCY STOP
RUN TIME
MAIN POWER AC DC Θ
(PCP ) A1A3 , RAISE COVER AND SET MAIN POWER - AC CB1 TO
10
M1
CB2
CB1
ge
ON.
ENERGIZE DLTM A2.
a.
Remove padlock and open DLTM A2 doors. If wind is over 45 knots , insert locking pin of door.
in
hole at top
88
Se
CONTINUED
2-61
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
10
b.
Continued .
If water is in channel at bottom of either DLTM , A2 door, remove water with cloth or sponge .
LAMPS
On Power Distribution Unit (PDU )
C.
ON A2A4, press and switch to TEST.
OFF TEST
LAMPS
O
O
O OAS
о
O O DATA LINK TERM MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O CAVC PROCESSOR OUT MAIN A PWXONSPL ON 20VDC OFF OFF GIFF OFF OBLOWER OPE LAMPSON BLOWER ON OCLXONPWR O TEST OFF OFF OFF
O
0 O
d.
hold
O
O
O
O
Check that the two panel lights and BLOWER OPR light come
28 VDC
on . Release switch . BLOWER OPR e.
+
Set LAMPS switch to ON . Check that two panel lights are on .
Logo →
→
+
CONTINUED)
2-62
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
10
EMPLACEMENT- Continued -
Continued .
f.
Set
O O
OFF
O
O
OFF CLKONPWR
BLOWER OPR
O O
O
O
о
O
O
BLOWER circuit breaker to BLOWER ON
ON. g.
о
G
O
OFF OFF LOWER LAMPS ON TEST ค OFF
10
O CNVC OUT ON
о 0 O 0 O O DATA LINK TERM MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O DOTL PROCESSOR MAIN ON ON ON →
Check that
BLOWER
BLOWER OPR
OPR light
is on before continuing . OFF
h.
Set MAIN A circuit breaker to ON.
ග
MAIN A ON +
OFF
i.
Set CLK PWR circuit breaker to ON. +
CLK PWR ON 28 VDC
j.
Check that 28 VDClight is on .
OFF
k.
Set PWR SPLY circuit breaker to
DGTL PROCESSOR
ON. PWR SPLY ON O
I.
Set
DGTL
PROCESSOR circuit
+
ON
+ (
breaker to ON. OFF
OFF
CONTINUED
2-63
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-8. 11
EMPLACEMENT - Continued AT PCP A1A3, RAISE COVER AND SET MAIN POWER — DC CB2 TO
MAIN POWER/ DC AC
RUN TIME
OFF . CB1
M1
12
CB2
AT COMPUTER -TO-COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE PROCESSOR (CCIP) A2A2, VERIFY THAT TIME OF DAY CLOCK IS COUNTING .
TIME OF DAY
PROPAGATION DELAYREQUEST
OLY
DAY OSC
88 THECONTROL
HOUR
SEC
MIN
5.
If clock is counting , go to step 13.
If clock is not counting , go to step 12a. a.
On CCIP A2A2:
(1 ) (2)
Set OPERATE switch to OFF. Set LOAD NET switch to OFF.
TIME CONTROL LOAD NET OPERATE OFF
OFF
CONTINUED
2-64
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-8.
12
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
Continued.
(3)
Set ALTERNATE MASTER switch to OFF .
PROPAGATION LAYREQUEST
TEST PROCESSORCONTROL
8 88 89 AUTOS
ALTERNATE MASTER
RADIO D
O OFF
DLT TEST
(4)
Set DLT TEST switch to TEST .
(5)
Set PROCESSOR switch to NORM .
TEST NORMAL
PROCESSOR CONTROL
CONTROL
DL TN TRBY
NORM
KGBY
CONTINUED
1 2-65
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
Continued .
12
Select any convenient net start time using TIME SET switches .
b.
TIME OF DAY DAY
HOUR
PROPAGATION DELAYREQUEST YEST DAY
DAY
MIN
TIME SET HOUR
SEC
MIN
RADIO O
PROCESSORCONTROL
AUTOSYNE
OSCCAL
88888 TIME CONTROL LOAD NET
ICONTROL
S
OFF
Set LOAD NET switch to LOAD NET then to OFF. (1 ) (2)
C.
Verify that net start time entered above appears on TIME OF DAY display.
At Key Generator KG -30 A2A1 , loosen 16 captive screws and open panel .
้
ไต
CONTINUED
2-66
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
12
d.
Continued .
On
Electronic Key Generator KG-30 A2A1 , set
POWER switch to OFF and
Verify that proper code has been keyed per SOP. Refer to manual KAO- 137E/TSEC for procedure . Close panel and secure, with
initialize key generator.
2 captive screws.
XMTR ALM
WARNING
POWER
WARNING
RCVR POWER O
PUSH TO ZERO
PUSH TO ZERO
ON
OFF
e.
On CCIP A2A2 :
(1)
Press and release RESET switch .
(2)
Set OPERATE switch to OPERATE . If TIME OF DAY clock starts , press and release RESET switch , and then go to step 13. If TIME OF DAY clock does not start, go to step f.
18
TEST
RESET
PROCESSORCONTROL
DAY
MODE OOCCAL 8 98 99 AUTOSYNC WTHOL
PROPAGATION DELAY REQUEST
RADNO10
@
OPERATE OFF
CONTINUED
9
2-67
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
12
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
f.
Continued .
Check that the fault lights at the following locations are off:
(1 )
Data Link Terminal Power Supply A2A6.
POWER SUPPLY FAULT-
O PS3
O PS2
O PS1
NON-INTERRUPT
LAMP TEST
O PS4
O PS5 PS6
T
(2)
Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5.
FAULT
RESET DELAY TURE
FREO
+
(3)
Receiver-Transmitter A2A3 .
FAULT RECEIVER
RECEIVER FAULTTRANSMITTE A
A1
A2
A3
: O
O
8888
: 0
FREQUENCYSELECT
TRANSMITTER
FRAT
A11 A12
A13
OOO
A4 O
A7
A14
Olo
A10 o
CONTINUED
2-68
TM 9-1440-600-10
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
2-8 .
12
-
Continued.
(4)
CCIP A2A2 .
@ FAULT KEY GEN SUMMARY FAULT FAULT ⚫
g.
PROCESSORCONTROL
GSC CAL 8 88 89 AUTOSYNC THE CONTACK
RADIO&
On CCIP A2A2, set OPERATE switch to OFF and ALTERNATE MASTER switch to
ALTERNATE MASTER OPERATE
ALTERNATE OFF
OFF
MASTER. Repeat steps b thru f.
h.
At Key Generator KG-30 A2A1 , secure panel with 14 remaining captive screws.
CONTINUED
2-69
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT ·- Continued ENERGIZE LEM A1 .
13
a.
On LEM -PDU A1A2 , hold LAMPS switch to TEST.
b.
Check that the two panel lights and BLOWER OPR light come on.
Release
switch .
Θ
O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O BLOWER OPE
BLOWER OPR
O LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC. MAIN A CIN OFF
BLOWER ON O OFF
Θ
LCHRELEX PARSVDCSPLY ON OFF
PWRORDSPLY ON OFF
LCHRELEX PWR29 vocSPLY O OFF
AS: VDC PWR$SPLY GN OFF
MSL GYRO-CLOCK WR MEL PAR SPLY ON O O
PAFUTTL PAIR SPLY On
M31 TWTFIL PWR SPLY ON Ꮎ OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
LAMPS
ON OFF TEST
BLOWER ON + OFF
O
O
O
ON OFF LAMPS ON OFF TEST
Θ
CNVCOUTTH MOTCONT CANISTER UNOT AC O ON ON OFF OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC UPRL MSL ON ON OFF OFF
MAIN 8 ON OFF
о
O فن نه
C.
Set LAMPS switch to ON . Check that two panel lights are on .
d.
Set BLOWER circuit breaker to ON .
e.
Check that BLOWER OPR light is on before continuing .
CONTINUED
2-70
TM 9-1440-600-
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued Continued .
13
f.
In the sequence listed below, set the following circuit breakers to ON.
1
O O O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT
2
O BLOWEN OPS
+ TRONCS AC,
LAUNCH «
BLOWER ON OFF 3
MISSILE HEATER AC, UPRA MSL 2 Θ LPR&MGI ON OFF CHFF OFF
OFF MS45 VDC PWR SPLY ON OFF
MSL GYROCLOCK PWR SPLY ON OFF
CONT MOT UNITAC ON
PAFUITL PWRSPLY ON
OFF
OFF
MEL TWTFIL PWRSPLY ON OFF
4
5 →
OFF
OFF
(WR& MSL ON OFF
MAIN A
MAIN B
ON
ON
OFF
OFF
WRRMSL
OFF 3
CAVE GUTHTR CANISTER AC OFF
+ O
O
+
ON
ON
+
LCHR ELEX 28 VDC PWR SPLY +
ON
+
о OFF
OFF
g.
ORD PWR SPLY
C
O
5
4
LCHR ELEX 5 VDC PWR SPLY
LAMPS ON OFF TEST
On PCP A1A3, check that MAIN POWER - AC CB1 set to ON.
RUN TIME
M1
OFF
circuit breaker is st
MAIN POWER AC DC
CB2
CONTINUED
2-7
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
13
h.
Continued.
On LCU Display Panel A1A14, check that all three POWER SUPPLIES lights are on .
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT BITE
LAUNCHERLOCAL
O
O
POWER SUPPLIES OO MISSILE PLATFORMUPPER HAZARD
O
O
LOHR READY
0000
PLATFORM READY RAISED AZMUTH
O
0
POWER SUPPLIES
NECTED80101010
の
LAUNCH
101 10
RAISE
STOP O
ООО 15 +5 +28 VDC VDC VDC
O
START O
FIRINGPLATOON
On LEM - PDU A1A2 , breakers to ON.
1
below,
set the following circuit
2
MSL GYRO/CLOCK PWR SPLY
MSL 5 VDC PWR SPLY +
in the sequence listed
ON
+
+
O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O
O
i.
O
NORMAL FANEL LAMPY CITE TEST STATUSLAMPS OW OFF STATUS LAMPYEST
0
OBLOWER OPA
ON LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC MAIN A ON OFF
BLOWER ON OFF OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC, UPD I MEL UPA8 MEL ON OFF OFF
MAINO OFF
OFF
→
ON
+
3 ON OFF
OFF
MSL
2)
OFF MSL TWTFIL PWRSPLY ON OFF
OFF
LWRAMS ON OFF
O
LAMPS ON O OPP TEST
O
о
MOT CONT UNIT AC
OFF
LCHR ELEX 28 VDC PWRSPLY (1 ) ON OFF OFF MS PAFUITL PWR SPLY
O
CNVC OUTHTR CANISTER AC ON OFF
3
+
PWRORDSPLY
Θ
LOMASVOCELEX PAR SPLY GN OFF
O
O
O
O
O
OFF CONTINUED
2-72
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
13
Continued .
DLT TIME
Le WARNING
OF DAY CLOCK MUST BE COUNTING
PROPER INDICATION CAN PLAY PANEL A1A14
BEFORE
BE OBTAINED FROM LCU DIS-
MISSILE HAZARD LIGHTS. A MISSILE
HAZARD LIGHT ON INDICATES A HAZARDOUS CONDITION ONLY FOR LIVE GM POSITIONS WITH UMBILICAL CONNECTED. MISSILE HAZARD LIGHT WILL NORMALLY BE ON FOR : GM POSITIONS HAVING A DUMMY MISSILE . EMPTY CANISTER . EMPTY POSITION . LIVE MISSILE WITH UMBILICAL DISCONNECTED .
THESE CONDITIONS DO NOT CONSTITUTE A HAZARD . IF ANY MISSILE HAZARD LIGHT IS ON , VISUALLY CHECK THAT POSITION . IF THAT POSITION
HAS A LIVE
MISSILE WITH
UMBILICAL CONNECTED , NOTIFY ECS IMMEDIATELY. ADVISE ECS THAT LS WILL REMAIN IN LOCAL MODE . AFTER NOTIFYING
ECS,
LEAVE AREA AND AWAIT FURTHER IN-
STRUCTIONS . ORDNANCE DEVICES RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
MAY
EXPLODE ,
CONTINUED
2-73
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 . 13
EMPLACEMENT - Continued —
j.
Continued .
On LCU Display Panel A1A14, check the following :
(1 )
LOCAL- RMT switch set to LOCAL. LOCAL light on and key removed .
ΤΟ
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT O
BITE
POWER SUPPLIES
PLATFORM
LO
VDC UPPER HAJAND
MISSILE O
CA
0
O LAUNCHERL
RM
O
MISSALE READY 이이 이이 O
LO PLATFORM READY RAISED AZMUTH MADY ооо
T
0101010
e
LAUNCHING STA
©
©
© O
e
0 • FIRINGPLATOON
O
RAISE 10 10 START
O
O
оо
LAMPS HITETEST STATUS NORMAL STATUS LAMPTEST
O
(2)
All MISSILE HAZARD lights off at all live GM positions.
UPPER L
MISSILE UPPER R LWR L
LWR R
MISSILE HAZARD 0000
(3)
All
four
MISSILE
CONNECTED lights on .
DISMISSILE DISCONNECTED 0101010
(4)
Verify that status lights are not flashing on and off.
CONTINUED
2-74
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
13
k.
Continued .
At LEM- PDU A1A2 , in sequence listed below , set the following circuit breakers to ON .
1
2
MSL PAFU/ITL PWR SPLY
+
ON
O
Θ
+
O O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O O OBLOWER O O OPR
O
ON
MSL TWT FIL PWR SPLY +
©
อ O
LCHAELEX PWR5VDCSPLT ON OFF
MARORDSPLY GN OFF
O
IF CANISTER HEAT IS REQUIRED :
3
LCHR ELEX 38 VDC PAR SPLY ON OFF
CONT 3 HTB MOT UNITAC Ꮎ ON ON OFF OFF
OFF
1 ON OFF
LINAL MSL O
LWRR MSU ON OFF
OFF
2
LAMPS
O
ON OFF TEST
OFF
O
O
CNVC OUT CANISTER HTR AC Θ ON
MSL GYRO-CLOCK PWRSPLY
MBL& VDC PWR SPLV ON OFF
о
OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC,י UPALMSI UPG A MSL ON O OFF OFF
MAIN 8 Of OFF
O
OFF
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC O MAINON A GIFF
BLOWER ON OFF
O
Θ
O
O
O
O
OFF
Check with ECS to determine if missile heaters are to be turned NOTE
I.
Set the four
on . If missile heaters are not to be turned on , go to step m .
MISSILE
O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O
HEATER
BLOWER OPR
O
AC circuit breakers to ON.
MISSILE HEATER AC UPR L MSL UPR R MSL ON ON
BLOWER ON OFF
LCHR5VDCFLEX PWR SPLY ON O GIFF
O OFF
OFF
OFF
GYROCLOCK PWR SPLY
IWR& MBL + ON
OFF MS TWYFIL PWR SPLY ON OFF
OFF
0
OFF
MOT UNITCONT AC ON OFF
VDC MSI PWR SSPLY ON OFF
MSL L PARUIT SPLY PWR
O
o
OFF
LCHERFLEX PWR29VDC SPLY O OFF
PWRORDSPLY ON OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC. LIPH &MEST UPA & MISA ON OFF OFF
MAIN 8 ON OFF
O
WARME ON OFF LAMPS ON OFF TEST
Q
LWR R MSL ON
CNVC OUTMTR CANISTER ON OFF
OFF
Θ
LWR L MSL Θ ON
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC MAIN A O ON
O
LAMPS m.
Set LAMPS switch to OFF .
ON OFF TEST
CONTINUED
T
2-75
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT- Continued
13
-
Continued .
LEM-PDU A1A2 DOOR MUST REMAIN CLOSED AFTER PDU A1A2
IS
ENERGIZED
TO
PREVENT
DEGRADING
EMI
SHIELDING .
CAUTION
n.
14
Close and secure LEM A1 left-hand door.
PERFORM LOCAL BITE TEST AT LCU DISPLAY PANEL A1A14 .
If panel lighting
a.
is
required ,
set
PANEL
LAMPS switch to
ON .
Check that
all four panel lights are on. b.
Set STATUS LAMPS switch to NORMAL or DIM as desired .
O
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT BITE
PANEL LAMPS ON
STATUS LAMPS NORMAL
OFF
DIM
POWER SUPPLIES O
LAUNCHERLOCAL
VOX MISSILE A UPPER LIPPER
PLATFORM HAZARO
O
LONE PLATFORM RAISED AUTH MAST MADY
HOSSAI LADY 이이 이이 이이 이이
о O B C
O O O O O +28 E V+5 D ±15 E VDC VDC VDC
O
.0
A O
"
RAISE STOP 00: START
POWER SUPPLIES-
O
Ø
LAUNCHING STA
BITE
O
DISCON MECTED
O
PIRINGPLATOON
O
o
NORMAL PANEL LAMPS WIFE TEST STATUSLAM STATUS LAMPTEST
O
Θ
CONTINUED
2-76
TM 9-1440-600-10
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
C.
Continued .
Check that all five BITElights are off.
이
-
14
BITE
O
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT POWER SUPPLIES
O
PLATFORM
AUNCHER
BITE
MISSILE O
HAZARD 000 LOMB
RAISED
A
ООО D C B
E
이이 이이 0
о O
NECTED 0101010
BITE TEST OFF STATUS LAMP TEST
IO !
2-8 .
:0
0
ROOM
0
BITY TEST
d.
Set BITE TEST-OFF- STATUS LAMP TEST switch to STATUS LAMP TEST . Check that all statuslights are on .
e.
Set switch to
BITE TEST.
BITElights cycle on and off for 6 seconds .
All
BITE lights are on ; test has passed .
f.
g.
Set BITE TEST- OFF - STATUS LAMP TEST switch to OFF .
On CCIP A2A2, check SUMMARY FAULTlight. If light is on ,
hold RESET
switch momentarily to RESET . SUMMARY FAULTlight will go off.
FAU SUMMARY FAULT
Θ
PROPAGAHOM DELAY REQUEST
TEST
S
SEC Θ
RESET
PROCESSOR CONTREX 10 00 00
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-77
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
15
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
If GMs are to be electrically connected , proceed as follows:
IF ANY MISSILE HAZARD LIGHT IS ON, VISUALLY CHECK THAT POSITION.
IF THAT POSITION
HAS A LIVE MISSILE
WITH UMBILICAL CONNECTED , NOTIFY ECS IMMEDIATELY. ADVISE ECS THAT LS WILL REMAIN IN LOCAL MODE. AF-
@ WARNING
TER NOTIFYING INSTRUCTIONS .
ECS, LEAVE AREA AND AWAIT FURTHER ORDNANCE DEVICES MAY EXPLODE ,
RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
a.
On LCU
Display
Panel A1A14 ,
verify that all
MISSILE
HAZARDlights are
off at all missile positions that have a live missile with umbilical connected .
POWER SUPPLIES VDC VOC UPPER MISSILE
PLATFORM
LWR R
MISSILE HAZARD C0000
O
O
• LAUNCHER LOCAL
O
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT BITE
MISSILE UPPER R LWR L
O
UPPER L
VIDOLI HAZARD O
O
MADY
이이 이이 ・ O
PLATFORM RAINED MADY ölöö
HECTED 0101010
MISSILE DISCONNECTED
101
STOP
Θ
O
Ø
0101010 LAUNCHING STA
Θ
START o
BITE FEST STATUS LANDTEST
O
PLATOON
CONNECT CONNECT
DISC
DISC
CONNECT CONNECT
DISC
DISC
O
b.
Raise cover over CONNECT- DISC switches .
C.
Hold CONNECT- DISC switches to CONNECT until corresponding MISSILE DISCONNECTEDlights go off.
CONTINUED
2-78
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
2-8 .
1.
At night crewmembers must be very careful to coordinate their work and signals while lowering outriggers and uncoupling tractor from semitrailer. Uselights to insure area is clear before starting .
DE
Use lights to signal for all operations that require signals . Make all movements sure and deliberate . Do not rush .
NOTES
PLC
2.
One
crewmember
operate
outrigger
controls .
crewmember observe outrigger and semitrailer.
Another
Observer signal
operator when area is clear and keep operator informed of outrigger and semitrailer condition .
16
LOWER OUTRIGGERS AND UNCOUPLE TRACTOR .
La
KEEP FINGERS OUTSIDE OUTRIGGER CONTROL BOX COVER UNTIL IT IS LOCKED OPEN . COVER SNAPS OPEN AND
WARNING CAN INJURE FINGERS.
a.
Remove locking hook from ccw and open cover.
outrigger control
box cover handle , turn
handle
O
CURBSIDE
CONTINUED
1
Change 1
2-79
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
16
Continued.
OFF b.
Lower cover until
spring -loaded
POWER plungers engage rods and cover is locked open .
C.
Set POWER switch to ON . Verify that leveling on.
device light comes
REAR OUTRIGGERS FRONT
ว
VERIFY THAT AREA IS CLEAR AND OUTRIGGER SAFETY CHAINS WARNING
ARE
RELEASED
BEFORE
OPERATING
OUT-
RIGGERS . INJURY OR DEATH COULD RESULT IF STRUCK BY OUTRIGGER .
• VERIFY THAT
OUTRIGGER
LIMIT SWITCHES
ARE
FREE
FROM DEBRIS , MUD , AND OTHER SUBSTANCES THAT COULD PREVENT PROPER OPERATION OF SWITCHES . CAUTIONS
• TO PREVENT TWISTING SEMITRAILER FRAME, DO NOT OPERATE DIAGONAL PAIRS OF OUTRIGGERS AT THE SAME TIME .
CONTINUED
2-80
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued —
Continued.
16
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO LIFT SEMITRAILER FIFTH WHEEL WITH OUTRIGGERS .
OFF TRACTOR
CAUTION
1.
For unlevel sites ,
outriggers may have to be operated one at
a time . Use single control switch if required . Upper switches control
roadside
outriggers .
Lower switches control
curbside
out-
NOTES riggers. 2.
d.
One crewmember observe outriggers and signal crewmember at control panel .
Using two REAR outrigger switches, lower rear outriggers until they touch ground .
OFF
ON POWER
e.
Using two FRONT outrigger switches, lower front outriggers until they touch ground .
O REAR OUTRIGGERS FRONT
Pause .
Continue to lower front outriggers to
slightly
relieve
semitrailer
weight from tractor.
AOR
DO WARNING
NOT STAND IN
PATH
OF TRACTOR
WHEELS
WHEN
RELEASING KINGPIN . TRACTOR COULD MOVE, RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
68
CONTINUED
1 2-81
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
Continued .
16
f.
Release kingpin .
(1 )
Pull out secondary lock release handle and hook in out position .
(2)
Pull out primary lock release handle all the way.
(3)
Coupling jaws will open and release kingpin .
SECONDARY LOCK RELEASE
LAUNCHING STATION
FIFTH WHEEL
PRIMARY LOCK RELEASE
ROADSIDE
DO NOT DRIVE TRACTOR TOO FAR FORWARD . AIR AND ELECTRICAL LINES MAY BE DAMAGED IF YOU DO. CAUTION
g.
Remove chock blocks from tractor wheels .
One crewmember drive tractor . Second crewmember observe and NOTE
signal driver.
CONTINUED
2-82
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT- Continued -
Continued .
16
h.
Push in tractor PARKING BRAKE control and drive tractor forward approximately 4 feet ( 1.22 meters) from
semitrailer. Insure that electrical and air lines are
not snagged or stretched .
i.
Visually check clearance
between
kingpin
and
rear frame crossmembers of
tractor. Adjust trailer height as needed by lowering outriggers if kingpin will catch on crossmember.
DO NOT LEAVE TRACTOR UNATTENDED BEFORE CHOCKLe WARNING
i.1 .
ING WHEELS . TRACTOR MAY ROLL, RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
Pull out tractor PARKING BRAKE control , place transmission range selector lever in neutral (N) . Leave engine running .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-82.1 /(2-82.2 blank)
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
16
EMPLACEMENT - Continued —
j.
17
Continued .
Chock tractor rear wheels .
LEVEL LS .
ALL FOUR OUTRIGGERS MUST HAVE FIRM CONTACT WITH
L GROUND WHEN LS IS LEVELED . OTHERWISE LS MAY TILT,
WARNING RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
TO PREVENT TWISTING SEMITRAILER FRAME , DO NOT OPERATE DIAGONAL PAIRS OF OUTRIGGERS AT THE SAME TIME .
CAUTION
LS must be leveled to not more than 5°.
NOTE
Each ring on leveling
device is 1 °. Outer ring is 6°. When leveling on slope greater than 5°, high side outriggers extension arms must be below horizontal to actuate interlock switches .
a.
Using no more than two outrigger switches at a time , observe leveling device and level LS. Bring bubble in leveling device as near center as possible . LS is leveled within 5° when bubble is in 5° leveling ring.
WEAR OUTRIGGERS
LEVELING DEVICE
CONTINUED
2-83
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
-
Continued .
17
b.
Verify with observer that :
(1 )
LS is as level as possible .
(2)
Leveling device bubble is inside 5° ring.
NOTE
C.
Wheel bogies float . wheel on ground .
One wheel
may be off ground and other
(3)
At least one wheel on each side of LS is off ground.
(4)
All four outriggers have firm contact with ground.
Verify that interlock switch plungers on all four outriggers are pressed .
SWITCH GUARD
INTERLOCK SWITCH PLUNGER
CONTINUED
2-84
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
117
—
Continued .
d.
On outrigger control panel , set POWER switch to OFF and lower safety guard .
KEEP FINGERS OUTSIDE OUTRIGGER CONTROL BOX COVLe ER WHILE CLOSING . COVER SNAPS SHUT AND CAN INJURE
WARNING
e.
FINGERS .
Close cover and turn handle cw to secure . Install locking hook to secure handle .
18
DISCONNECT AND STOW ELECTRICAL CABLES AND AIR LINES.
a.
Inside tractor cab :
(1 )
Place trailer handbrake control all the way forward in OFF position .
(2)
Pull out PARKING BRAKE control .
(3)
Pull out TRAILER AIR SUPPLY control .
b.
Uncouple EMERGENCY (red) and SERVICE (blue) airbrake lines from LS glad hand connectors .
00
2000 000000
AIR BRAKE LINES
AP CURBSIDE
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-85
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT- Continued —
Continued .
18
c
e
e
e
c e
e
c
from fifth wheel on air lines.
( c ( )) )
my couplings on tractor connector tree . Be careful not to get grease
e
connecting line couplings to dum-
e
airbrake lines by
Stow the two
c
C.
DUMMY COUPLING
d.
Connect airbrake coupling covers to airbrake couplings on LS.
COVER
50
CURBSIDE
e.
Disconnect electrical cables .
MS elquoor
(1 )
On LS , raise retaining spring on outrigger cable
connector
OUTRIGGER CABLE
and
pull connector straight out to disconnect . (2)
On LS , raise spring - loaded dust cap and pull intervehicular light cable connector straight out to disconnect.
(3)
Install or seat dust caps on the two LS electrical connectors .
INTERVEHICULAR LIGHT CABLE
CONTINUED
2-86
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT- Continued —
18
L c
c
c
e
e
c
e
c
of
c
base
c
at
s
s
e
c
ble from receptacle connector tree.
e
Disconnect intervehicular light ca-
c
f.
Continued.
INTERVEHICULAR LIGHT CABLE
CURBSIDE
BATTERY BOX
g.
h.
Disconnect outrigger cable from tractor slave connector.
Disengage
both
electrical cables
from connector mast and stow in tractor roadside stowage box. i.
Unchock tractor wheels.
SLAVE CONNECTOR OUTRIGGER CABLE
j.
Crewmember on ground , observe LS kingpin to insure that it clears tractor cross-frame member as tractor is driven forward .
k.
Tractor driver,
drive tractor forward
until it is clear of LS .
Stop tractor and
chock wheels . I.
Verify that all LS outriggers rest firmly on ground .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-87
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
19
MATE DATA LINK MAST ASSEMBLY.
DATA WARNING
LINK ANTENNA
MAY
BE
HOT.
USE
PROTECTIVE
GLOVES IF NECESSARY TO KEEP FROM INJURING HANDS.
HANDLE ANTENNA CAREFULLY TO PREVENT DAMAGE.
CAUTION
1.
At night, crewmembers must be very careful to coordinate their work and signals while
mating
data link
mast assembly.
Use
lights to insure that area is clear before starting . Make all movements sure and deliberate . Do not rush .
NOTES 2.
Two crewmembers are needed to perform this procedure . One on roadside work platform front roadside outrigger.
by Generator Set A6 and
one on
Release two hood latches securing Upper Mast Section A7A12 to Lower Mast
a.
Section A7A11 .
CLAMP UPPER MAST
HOOD LATCH
CRADLE LOWER MAST
ROADSIDE B 30051
T
CONTINUED
2-88
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
19
EMPLACEMENT - Continued —
b.
Continued .
Lift upper mast and walk it forward until it rests in forward cradle . Close top clamp to secure upper mast.
UPPER MAST
FORWARD CRADLE LOWER MAST
ROADSIDE
C.
One crewmember move to forward roadside outrigger.
d.
Two crewmembers working together, release top clamps ,lift upper mast, and move forward until upper mast flange is slightly forward of lower mast flange .
LOWER MAST
UPPER MAST
LOCATOR PIN
CONTINUED
53 2-89
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT- Continued —
19
e.
Continued .
Slide upper mast into lower mast,
alined so upper mast flange
is
secured
by locator pin on lower mast flange .
LOWER MAST
UPPER MAST
LOCATOR PIN
When mast sections are properly mated ,
dummy connector on
NOTE upper mast flange is beside rf adapter on lower mast flange .
f.
Remove
Grounding
Cable LOWER MAST
A7A12W2 from spring clip on upper mast flange and connect to Ground Connector A7A11J2 on lower mast flange .
SPRING CLIP
UPPER MAST
A7A12W2-
CONTINUED
2-90
TM 9-1440-600-10
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
2-8 .
19
Continued . LOWER MAST
g.
Disconnect
RF Cable A7A12W1
from dummy connector on upper UPPER MAST
mast flange .
A7A12W1
LOWER MAST
UPPER MAST
h.
Remove dust cap from RF Adapter A7A11J1
and
connect Cable
A7A12W1 to RF Adapter A7A11J1 .
LOWER MAST.
UPPER MAST
i.
Install dust cap on dummy connector on upper mast flange .
INSURE THAT AREA IS CLEAR BEFORE RAISING PLATFORM WARNING
TO PREVENT INJURY .
CONTINUED
2-91
T TM 9-1440-600-10 2
2-8.
20
EMPLACEMENT - Continued RAISE PLATFORM .
[ a.
Set engagement control handle to ELEV
ROADSIDE
www ROTATE
ELEV
ROADMARCH
NOTE
Launcher platform may be stopped at any position between limits by setting RAISE - STOP- LWR switch to STOP .
On LCU Display panel A1A14 , set RAISE - STOP - LWR switch to RAISE .
Hold START switch
up O
momentarily. Platform will raise to
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
O
launch angle and stop.
BITE
POWER SUPPLIES O
O O
00 LAUNCHER
VDC VDX MISSILE UPPERL UPPERS
PLATFORM HAZARD
RAISE
O
O
STOP
O
LCHR READY Ο
LWR
LAUNCHING STA
ANGSALE READY 0 |0 |0 |0 PLATFORM RAISED AZMUTH READY MISSALE Co НЕСТЕР 0101010 STOP
0
RAISE
O
b.
83990 T2AM
START 10
O
START
FIRINGPLATOON
O
O
O
BITE TEST STATUSLAM STATUS LAMPYEST
HO
O Ο
CONTINUED
2-1
2-92
TM 9-1440-600-10
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
O
Verify that PLATFORM RAISED and LCHR READY lights are on.
O
C.
Continued .
BITE
LAUNCHERLOCAL
O
POWER SUPPLIES 615 O VDC VDC PLATFORMMISSILE UPPER LIPPERA HAZARD
O
-
O
READY LCH PLATFORM 이이 이이 ・ READY RADED AUMUTH READT O
PLATFORM RAISED
о
0101010
Ø
LAUNCHINGSTA STOP нист START
O
RAISE ölö
O
O
e
FIRINGPLATOON BITE TEST STATUSLAMPS NORMAL FANEL LAMPS O STATUS OFF LAMPTEST
оо
O
LCHR READY
O
20
EMPLACEMENT- Continued
O
2-8.
O
이
d.
Set RAISE- STOP - LWR to STOP.
RAISE STOP
LWR
e.
AZIMUTH READY
Set engagement control handle to ROTATE Verify that READY light is on .
AZIMUTH O
ROADMARCH
ELEV
ROTATE
CONTINUED
T
2-93
TI
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
21
ALINE LS USING M2 AIMING CIRCLE .
[
a.
Set up aiming rod level . (1 )
Open curbside stowage box and remove aiming circle and range pole rod level .
Ho
STRAP
AIMING CIRCLE
CURBSIDE
(2)
On
curbside ,
open
front
stowage container and remove canvas
case
containing
2-
section range pole. 8
(3)
On curbside , open rear stowage container and remove aiming circle tripod .
CONTINUED
22-94
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
21
Continued .
(4)
Carry tripod and aiming circle about 26 feet (8.0 meters ) directly behind LS.
26 FT
(5)
Upend tripod .
Unbuckle retain-
ing strap and secure strap to leg to which it is attached .
CHIAT
(6)
Loosen leg clamp wing screws and extend tripod legs to desired length (convenient height for sighting LS) . Tighten clamp wing screws. Do not force wing screws .
CLAMP WING SCREW
TYPICAL 3 PLACES
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-95
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
21
Continued .
(7)
Turn tripod upright and test ad-
45°
justment of each leg by elevating each leg to horizontal position and releasing it. If leg is properly adjusted , it will fall to approximately 45° and stop . If it does not stop at about 45°, adjust it by loosening or tight-
TRIPOD CLAMPING SCREW
ening tripod clamping screw . Repeat until test is successful .
(8)
Spread tripod legs and place tripod at rear of LS in position to allow alinement with two inboard alining pins on either upper GM.
1
LAUNCHING STATION
༢. TRIPOD
RADAR SET (9)
LAUNCHING STATION
Check that tripod is at a convenient height for operator and that one leg of tripod is about in middle of angle between LS and radar set (RS) .
CONTINUED
2-96
TM 9-1440-600-10
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
2-8.
— 21
Continued. COVER
(10)
Unhook cover strap and remove HEAD
STRAP
tripod head cover.
AIMING CIRCLE AND COVER
(11 )
With aiming circle cover on , pull hinged cap
HINGED CAP
FIXING SCREW
on
bottom all the
way back.
Place
aiming circle
on tripod
head
and
thread
tripod fixing screw into bottom of aiming circle.
(12)
Release aiming circle carrying case cover latches by pulling out on strap at each side . Re-
TRIPOD HEAD COVER
move cover and hang on tripod head cover.
CONTINUED
2-97
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued —
21
Continued .
If lighting is limited , install instrument light in eyepiece slot . Hand-
NOTE
b.
light can be used for leveling and reading scales and lighting reticle . Place handlight on plastic reflector on top of telescope .
Level aiming circle .
(1 )
Curl index finger over azimuth micrometer knob and brace GM
thumb against screw on
main
housing . Squeeze , pulling azimuth knob toward you to dis-
(2)
AZIMUTH MICROMETER KNOB
r
micrometer
fo
engage azimuth knob gear.
While holding knob disengaged , rotate main body so that telescope points toward rear of GMs . Release knob and make
030914
sure that it locks in place . (3)
Loosen
the three
screws to
leveling
expose
about
1 /4-inch (0.64 mm ) of thread .
LEVELING SCREW (3 PLACES)
DO
NOT CLIMB
UP
ON
LS AT
1/4 IN.
NIGHT TO
LIGHT
UP GM
ALINEMENT PINS. INJURY OR DEATH WILL RESULT FROM
WARNING A FALL .
CONTINUED
2-98
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-8.
21
EMPLACEMENT- Continued -
Continued .
At night,
NOTE
use flashlights from ground tolight up GM alinement pins . During blackout , use blackout flashlights (with red lens).
ELEVATION KNOB (4)
Pull hinged cap away from each
TELESCOPE
orienting knob . (5) (6)
Sight through telescope at GM . Using the two orienting knobs (nonrecording) and the elevation knob, aline vertical line of telescope reticle approximately on forward and rear inboard alinement pins of either upper GM. Move tripod if necessary .
GM CIRCULAR LEVEL INDICATOR
ORIENTING KNOB (NONRECORDING ) (2 PLACES) CAP
(7)
Using the three leveling screws ,
(2 PLACES)
two at a time , center bubble in circular level indicator on main body.
(8)
Close knobs.
caps
over
orienting
LEVELING SCREW (3 PLACES)
VERTICAL LINE OF RETICLE
10 20 30 40 5060 80 יוידיויוידיוידידי-10 AO 4050 40 30 20 10 -20 30 30 60
NOTE
Make sure tripod is steady. adjustment if necessary.
Use
tripod
legs to
make
coarse
CONTINUED
2-99
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT- Continued —
21
Continued .
Aiming circle main
NOTE
body rests on three leveling screws (a, b,
and c) that form a triangular pattern on base . established along each side of this triangle .
(9)
Disengage azimuth micrometer knob.
(10)
While holding knob disengaged , rotate main body so that main body tubular level is centered
Level
must be
between leveling screws a and b. Release knob and make sure TUBULAR LEVEL
it locks in place . (11 )
Using leveling screws a and b, center bubble in tubular level . Grasp leveling
screws with
thumb and forefinger and move
LEVELING SCREW
the two leveling screws at the same time .
(12)
(13)
Disengage azimuth knob.
micrometer
While holding knob disengaged , rotate main body so that main body tubular level is centered between leveling screws b and c. Release knob and make sure
TOP VIEW WITH MAIN BODY OMITTED
a. G
C. TUBULAR LEVEL (REF)
it locks in place .
b.
CONTINUED
2-100
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT – Continued -
21
Continued .
(14)
Using leveling screw c , center bubble in tubular level .
(15)
Disengage azimuth micrometer knob.
(16)
While holding knob disengaged , rotate main body so that main body tubular level is centered between leveling screws c and a. Release knob and make sure it locks in place.
(17)
Using leveling screws c and a , center bubble in tubular level . Grasp leveling screws between thumb and forefinger and at the same time.
NOTE
move the two leveling screws
Bubble in tubular level must be centered within one graduation through 360 degrees of travel .
(18)
Disengage azimuth micrometer knob and rotate main body through 360°, checking level at 1600 , 3200, 4800 , and 6400 mils. Tubular level bubble must be centered within one graduation at each checkpoint. Adjust if necessary . ELEVATION MICROMETER
(19)
Using
elevation
micrometer
knob, center bubble in elevation tubular level . (20)
ELEVATION TUBULAR LEVEL
Read and record elevation micrometer scale . If micrometer scale is not at 0 , use this plus
T
(+) or minus (-) reading to adjust all elevation measurements .
CREWMEMBERS
ON LS MUST BE WATCHED
CREWMEMBERS
AND WARNED
OF
UNSAFE
BY OTHER
CONDITIONS
WARNING TO PREVENT INJURY .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-101
TM 9-1440-600-10
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
2-8.
21
-
C.
Continued .
Aline aiming circle with GM alining pins .
(1 )
Disengage aiming circle azimuth micrometer knob .
(2)
While holding knob disengaged , rotate main body to set azimuth main scale and azimuth micrometer scale both to (black) 0.
Release knob and make
sure it locks in place.
Last motion coming onto alining pins must be from left to right NOTE to reduce gear backlash .
WARNING
CREWMEMBERS
ON
CREWMEMBERS
AND WARNED
LS
MUST BE WATCHED OF
BY OTHER
UNSAFE CONDITIONS
TO PREVENT INJURY.
ELEVATION KNOB TELESCOPE ORIENTING KNOB (NON RECORDING) (2 PLACES) (3)
Pull hinged cap away from each orienting knob.
CAP (2 PLACES)
CONTINUED
2-102
Change 1
e
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
21
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
Continued.
(4)
Sight through telescope at GM .
FORWARD PIN
FORWARD PIN
PERFECT ALINEMENT
MINIMUM ACCEPTABLE ALINEMENT
REAR PIN
REAR PIN
VIEW
пох OF GM
PERFECT ALINEMENT
MINIMUM ACCEPTABLE ALINEMENT
(5)
Using the two orienting knobs (nonrecording) and the elevation knob, aline vertical line of telescope
reticle on forward
and
rear inboard
alining
pins
of either upper GM . If alinement cannot be made , another crewmember must
經
rotate LS turntable manually per para 2-23 in direction shown to get alinement.
ROTATE ΤΟ ALINE
(6)
Request that another crewmember verify aiming circle alinement .
(7)
Verify that azimuth scale is set to 0.
(8)
Close caps over orienting knobs .
main scale is set to
black
0 and azimuth
micrometer
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-103
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
21
Continued .
Set up range pole only when and if requested by radar set ( RS)
NOTE
d.
crew . Range pole must not be raised except when being used as aiming point.
Set up range pole.
(1)
Remove range pole from canvas case.
(2)
Join and interlock two range pole sections .
(3)
When requested , place tapered point of range pole on ground near aiming circle.
(4)
Place angular portion of rod level against range pole circular level indicator up.
(5)
with
Move top of range pole to center the bubble in level indicator. When bubble is centered , range
RANGE POLE
CIRCULAR LEVEL INDICATOR
pole is vertical . (6)
Move rod level up and down range pole . Check that bubble is centered at all locations .
(7)
When
RS crew has measured
angle , take range pole down .
NOTE
e.
When sighting on RS aiming circle , a range pole may have to be used at the RS aiming circle.
Orient LS aiming circle with RS aiming circle .
NOTE
Last motion coming onto aiming point must be from left to right to reduce gear backlash .
(1 )
Disengage azimuth micrometer knob . CONTINUED
2-104
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
21
Continued .
(2)
While holding knob disengaged , rotate main body cw (recording , fast motion) toward RS aiming circle . Uselugs holding elevation tubular level as a rough sighting device . Stay to left of RS aiming circle . Release knob and make sure it locks in place.
NORTH REFERENCE AIMING CIRCLE
TELESCOPE
ELEVATION MICROMETER
LS AIMING CIRCLE
ELEVATION MAINSCALE
RS AIMING CIRCLE
AZIMUTH MICROMETER
LAUNCHING AZIMUTH MAIN SCALE
STATION
RADAR SET
(3)
Sight in telescope and use azimuth micrometer knob (recording , slow motion) and elevation micrometer knob if necessary, bring vertical line exactly to center of RS aiming circle.
Azimuth main scale is
NOTE
marked in hundreds and numbered at 200 -mil increments . Azimuth micrometer scale is marked in mils
and numbered at 10- mil increments .
(4)
Read value of angle on azimuth main scale in hundreds of mils and azimuth micrometer scale in mils .
(5)
Add azimuth main scale value to azimuth micrometer scale value , and record the total reading .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-105
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
21
Continued .
(5.1 )
Repeat steps ( 1 ) through (5) to obtain second azimuth reading .
(5.2)
Add first and second azimuth readings and divide by two to get azimuth mean value. If mean value is within 0.5 mil of first azimuth reading , proceed to step (5.3 ) below . If not , return to step 1 above and remeasure azimuth angle .
(5.3)
Record azimuth mean value on BRG LS TO RDR line on Launcher Location/Alinement Data Form.
NOTE Leave azimuth angle on scale while measuring elevation angle .
(6)
Sight through telescope and
using
elevation
knob,
bring
horizontal line of
reticle to touch top of RS aiming circle .
1.
Use any plus ( + ) or minus (-) number obtained when aiming circle was leveled in step 21 b to adjust elevation angle measured in following steps .
NOTES
Subtract any plus ( + ) number , and add any
minus (-) number to all elevation readings. 2.
Elevation
main
scale is
marked
and
numbered
in
100 - mil in-
crements . Elevation micrometer scale is marked in mils and numbered at 10- mil increments .
(7)
Read elevation
main
scale
in
hundreds of mils and
elevation
micrometer
scale in mils . (8)
Add elevation main scale value to elevation micrometer scale value .
(9)
Adjust elevation
angle
measured
by adding
or subtracting value
recorded
when aiming circle was leveled in step 21 b. (10)
Determine polarity of elevation angle . If elevation angle is
minus (-). If
elevation
reading is on
reading is on red scale,
black scale ,
angle
is plus
( +). (11 )
Record elevation angle with proper sign , plus ( + ) or minus (−) .
CONTINUED
2-106
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
21
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
Continued .
(12 )
Repeat steps (6) through ( 11 ) to obtain second elevation reading .
(13)
Add first and second elevation readings and divide by 2 to get mean value . If mean value is within
0.5 mil of first elevation
reading ,
proceed to ( 14)
below. If not, return to step (6) above and remeasure elevation angle. (14 )
Record mean elevation value on tion/Alinement Data Form .
EL LS TO RDR line on Launcher Loca-
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-106.1 /(2-106.2 blank)
TI
2-
[
49T
2-1
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-8 .
21
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
-
Continued .
Orient LS aiming circle with north reference aiming circle.
f.
(1 )
Disengage azimuth micrometer knob.
(2)
While holding knob disengaged , rotate main body cw (recording , fast motion) toward north reference aiming circle . Use lugs holding elevation tubular level as a rough sighting device . Stay to left of north Release knob and make sure it locks in place.
reference
aiming
circle .
NORTH REFERENCE AIMING CIRCLE
LS AIMING CIRCLE RS AIMING CIRCLE
LAUNCHING STATION
RADAR SET
(3)
Sight in telescope and use azimuth micrometer knob ( recording , slow motion) , and elevation micrometer knob if necessary, to bring vertical line of telescope reticle exactly to center of north reference aiming circle.
Azimuth
main scale is
marked in
200 - mil increments . Azimuth
hundreds and
numbered
micrometer is marked in
at
mils and
NOTE numbered at 10- mil increments .
(4)
Read and record value of angle on azimuth main scale in hundreds of mils and azimuth micrometer scale in mils.
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-107
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-8.
EMPLACEMENT – Continued -
21
Continued .
(5)
Add azimuth main scale value to azimuth micrometer scale value , and record .
(6)
Repeat steps ( 1 ) through (5 ) to get second azimuth reading .
(7)
Add first and second azimuth readings and divide by 2 to get mean value . If mean value is within 0.5 mil of first azimuth reading above , (8) below.
(8)
g.
proceed to
Record azimuth mean value on BRNG LS TO NREF line on Launcher Location/Alinement Data Form.
Stow aiming circle .
(1 )
(2)
Verify that compass
needle is
locked and locking vertical .
handle
Slide
covers
is TUBULAR LEVELS
over the two
tubular levels to closed position . (3)
COMPASS LOCKING HANDLE
Verify that caps on orienting knobs are closed , covering
NOTE PAD PLATE
knobs. (4)
Set elevation
scale to 3
and
elevation micrometer to 0 .
(5)
Disengage azimuth micrometer knob. ORIENTING KNOB (NONRECORDING ) (2 PLACES)
(6)
While holding knob disengaged , rotate main body to position azimuth micrometer knob approximately over lower right corner of note pad plate .
(7)
Set azimuth micrometer knob to 0. Release knob .
CONTINUED
2-108
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-8.
21
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
COVER
Continued .
(8)
Place carrying case cover over aiming
circle and latch cover locks by pressing in .
wore
AIMING CIRCLE
AIMING CIRCLE AND COVER
TRIPOD
HINGED CAP
FIXING SCREW (9)
Loosen tripod fixing screw and remove aiming circle from tripod .
Make sure that
cap on bottom
hinged
covers tripod
mounting screw hole.
COVER
HEAD
(10)
Install tripod head fasten with strap.
STRAP
cover and
CLAMP WING SCREW
(11 )
Loosen tripod screws,
leg clamp wing
collapse tripod legs ,
and tighten screws .
leg
extension
TYPICAL 3 PLACES
CONTINUED
2-109
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-8.
EMPLACEMENT- Continued -
21
22
Continued.
TRIPOD
STRAP
(12)
Strap tripod legs together.
(13)
Stow tripod in rear stowage container and close container.
(14)
Disassemble two piece range pole and stow in front stowage container. Close container.
(15)
Stow aiming circle and range rod level in curbside stowage box.
DETERMINE LS ATTITUDE .
a.
At curbside stowage
box , release strap and remove gunner's quadrant from
door rack .
Hel
LEVEL INDICATOR
FLINT HERE
MAIN SCALE
POINTER EAD O BLACK FIGURES OF FIRE
RADIAL ARM PLUNGER
CURBSIDE MICROMETER
نف ة
b.
Remove gunner's quadrant from case.
C.
Pull back on radial arm plunger and set pointer to 0 mark on main scale .
d.
Rotate micrometer to black 0 line.
CONTINUED
2-110
TM 9-1440-600-10 EMPLACEMENT - Continued
2-8.
22
-
e.
Continued .
Set gunner's quadrant on the two cross- roll measurement bolt heads of the ALIGNMENT DATUM with LINE OF FIRE arrow pointing up-slope . Make sure gunner's quadrant frame shoes rest squarely on bolt heads .
ALI
GNA
RNY
CROSS-ROLL MEASUREMENT
SIDE OF TURNTABLE TU A
BA
ROLL MEASUREMENT ALIGNMENT DATUM
LEVEL INDICATOR
MAIN SCALE MICROMETER FRAME SHOES MAS BLACE FIGURES LINË OFFORE
ALIGNMENT DATUM
NOTE
f.
If unable to center bubble in step f, turn gunner's quadrant end for end and center bubble .
Center bubble in level indicator using radial arm plunger for coarse adjustment and micrometer for fine adjustment.
CONTINUED
2-111
TM 9-1440-600-10 EMPLACEMENT - Continued
2-8.
222
-
Continued.
Gunner's quadrant main scale is marked in 10- mil increments and numbered at 50- mil increments . Micrometer is marked in NOTE 0.2-mil increments and numbered in 1 - mil increments .
g.
Read cross roll angle from main scale and micrometer. If LINE OF FIRE arrow points forward (toward Generator Set A6) , sign is plus ( + ) . If LINE OF FIRE arrow points toward rear of LS , sign is minus (−) .
h.
Add main scale value to micrometer value . Record total with proper sign plus (+) or minus (-) on CROSS ROLL line on Launcher Location/Alinement Data Form .
i.
Set gunner's quadrant on the two roll measurement bolt heads of
SIDE OF TURNTABLE
the ALIGNMENT DATUM with LINE OF FIRE arrow pointing upslope .
Make
sure
HA
BA
CA
T
TU
A
gunner's
quadrant frame shoes squarely on bolt heads.
rest
ROLL MEASUREMENT
ALIGNMENT DATUM CROSS-ROLL MEASUREMENT
NOTE
j.
If unable to center bubble in step j , turn gunner's quadrant end for end and center bubble .
Center bubble in level indicator using radial arm plunger for coarse adjustment and micrometer for fine adjustment .
CONTINUED
2-112
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
Continued .
k.
Read roll
22
angle from
main
scale
and
micrometer.
If LINE
OF
FIRE
arrow
points curbside , the sign is plus ( + ) . If LINE OF FIRE arrow points roadside , the sign is minus (−) . Add main scale value to micrometer value . Record total with proper sign plus
I.
(+) or minus (-) on ROLL line on Launcher Location/Alinement Data Form. m.
Pull back on radial arm
plunger and set pointer to 0 mark on main scale.
Install gunner's quadrant in case.
n.
23
Stow gunner's quadrant in curbside stowage box door rack. Secure with strap .
SYNCHRONIZE DLT.
This step will resynchronize DLT after roadmarch if march order NOTE
was followed . If this is an initial emplacement or if DLT clock power was lost, synchronize DLT using DLT slave synchronizing procedure per para 2-28.
a.
On CCIP A2A2, verify that TIME OF DAY display is counting .
TIME OF DAY PROPAGATION REQUEST DELAY
DAY
HOUR
MIN
SEC
RADEDO
PROCESSOR CONTROL —
-OSCCAL 88888 TRE CONTROL
CONTINUED
2-113
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
23
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
Continued .
On
Receiver-Transmitter A2A3,
RECEIVER - A1
LED
may be
on. This is not a fault. Receiver-Transmitter A2A3 requires ap-
NOTE
proximately 45 seconds to obtain
lock after DLTM - PDU A2A4
is energized .
b.
On CCIP A2A2, momentarily hold RESET switch to up and CEIVER - A1 LED will go off.
release it .
RE-
00 :1
A1 FREQUENCYSELECT
RESET
RECEIVER 21 2
IMA! FRANGARTER
8888 FALAY 10387
FAIR
PROPAGATION GELAYREQUEST
YEST
PROCESSORCONTROL
MODE OBC CAL
AUTO SYNC
RADIO S
TRE CONTRO
SYNC DL TN
DLT TEST
TRBY NORM
KGBY
O AUTO SYNC
TEST NORMAL
O
PROCESSOR CONTROL
OFF
On CCIP A2A2:
C.
(1 )
Check that PROCESSOR CONTROL switch is set to NORM and DLT TEST switch is set to NORMAL
(2)
Set AUTO SYNC switch to up position . After 1 display will advance 9 seconds and stop.
second the TIME OF DAY
CONTINUED
2-114
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
23
EMPLACEMENT - Continued -
Continued .
Within 3 OF
minutes
after setting AUTO
SYNC
switch
up, TIME
DAY display will advance and either SYNC light or AUTO
NOTE SYNC light will come on .
During this 3- minute
interval , TIME
OF DAY display may advance 9 seconds and stop . This cycle may be repeated up to 6 times.
d.
If TIME OF
DAY
display advances and SYNC light comes on ,
go to step
f. If AUTO SYNC lamp comes on , go to step e. e.
If AUTO SYNC light comes on , set OPERATE and AUTO to OFF . Perform DLT slave synchronizing per para 2-28 .
SYNC
switches
TIME OF DAY RESET
DAY
HOUR
MIN
SEC
SYNC
PROPAGATION DELAY NOUEST
OPROCESSORCONTRO
GCCAL 88888 AUTOSYNE CONTRO
O AUTO SYNC
RADIOO
O OPERATE OFF
f.
OFF
Set AUTO SYNC switch to OFF and verify that ECS and LS TIME OF DAY clocks indicate same time . If clocks do not indicate same time ,
perform DLT
slave synchronizing per para 2-28.
g.
Hold RESET switch to RESET momentarily.
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-115
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
223
-
Continued .
Check that fault lights at the following locations are off.
h.
(1 )
DLT Power Supply A2A6.
POWER SUPPLY FAULT-
O PS1
O PS2
O PS3 LAMP TEST
NON-INTERRUPT
O PS4
O PS5 PS6
O
(2)
Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5.
FAULT POWER CONTROL MARKJAL MODE AUTO ANY
! O
TRO? RESET DELAY TUME O
+
(3)
Receiver-Transmitter A2A3.
Θ FAULT RECEIVER
FREQUENCYSELECT
RECEIVER 8888
A1
TRANSMITTER
A O oo o FALL RESET!
A2
TRANSMITTER A3
A11 A12
A7
A14
A13
Θ A4
DO A10 O
CONTINUED
2-116
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-8.
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
23
-
Continued.
(4)
CCIP A2A2 .
PROPAGATION DELAY REQUEST
TEST
FAULT KEY GEN SUMMARY FAULT FAULT PROCESSOR CONTREX
RAD G OBCCAL 888 88 ●TIME CONTROL
i.
24
-
Close and secure both DLTM A2 doors . Lock left door with padlock.
CHECK GENERATOR VOLTAGES AND FREQUENCY.
Check output voltage.
a.
(1 )
Set VOLTS-AMPS switch to positions L1 - LO, L2- LO, and L3-LO . VOLTS A.C. meter should indicate 120 vac red line in each position .
O oooo
A.C. VOLTMETER
-
13
GENERATOR
ENGINE
L1 - LO
FAULT INDICATOR
O
O
O 11 -3- .
O
. 12
L- 12 L
*1i
500
AMPS VOLTS
оо
INCREASE O 88
O
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULLFOR EMERGENCY STOP
VOLTAGE ADJUST
(2)
Set VOLTS-AMPS switch to positions L1 - L2, L2- L3 , and L3- L1 . VOLTS A.C meter should indicate 208 vac red line in each position .
CONTINUED
2-117
TM 9-1440-600-10
TM
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
2-1 . -
Continued.
24 E
(3)
If voltage in any position is wrong , set VOLTS-AMPS switch to that position and use VOLTAGE ADJUST rheostat to adjust correct voltage.
(4)
If voltage had to be adjusted , repeat steps ( 1 ) and (2).
b.
Check HERTZ frequency meter for 400 Hz indication . If necessary , use FREQUENCY ADJUST rheostat to adjust frequency to 400 Hz.
O
O
FAULT INDICATOR
GENERATOR
ENGINE
О
HE TZ
ㅎ
O
O
お
INCREASE
O
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT PULL BREAKER FORSTOP EMERGENCY FREQUENCY ADJUST
IF ANY FAULT INDICATOR LIGHT COMES ON, STOP ENGINE AND CALL ENGINEER MAINTENANCE .
CAUTION
C.
Close
Generator Set A6 control
cubicle doors .
CONTINUED
2-1
2-118
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-8 .
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
24
Continued .
1.
Check with ECS if GM torque tube handles are to be unlocked . If they are not to be unlocked , go to step 26.
NOTES 2.
Unlock GMs in following order: Upper Right ( UR) ,
Lower Right
(LR) , Upper Left ( UL) , Lower Left (LL) .
25
UNLOCK GM TORQUE TUBE HANDLE ON EACH CANISTER .
a.
b.
Remove quick release pin by GM torque tube handle .
Pull
and
hold
O DESSICANT HOLDER
RECORDS
spring - loaded J2
plunger. Rotate torque tube han-
UNLOCK
DO NOT LATCH OR UNLATCH UNLESS GM ELEVATED
dle ccw to UNLOCK position .
RELIEF VALVE PUSHTO RELEASE PRESSURE O
O
0 DESSICANT HOLDER
RECORDS
J2 C.
OCK
UNL
DONOT LATCH OR UNLATCH UNLESS GM ELEVATED
Release
plunger .
Check that
plunger seats in right detent hole
RELIEF VALVE PUSH TO RELEASE PRESSURE
to secure torque tube handle . d.
1
Check that red paint shows to left of torque tube handle.
e.
Insert quick release pin in hole to left of torque tube handle .
f.
Repeat steps a thru e for LR , UL, and LL.
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-119
TM
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 .
2-8. 26
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
TRANSFER LS CONTROL TO ECS.
E a.
One crewmember (driver) get in tractor.
b.
One crewmember remove wheel chocks from tractor.
TURNTABLE CAN BE REMOTELY TRAINED 1 MINUTE AFTER
WARNING
LOCAL- RMT SWITCH IS SET TO RMT. SERIOUS INJURY CAN RESULT IF STRUCK BY THE MOVING PLATFORM .
NOTE
C.
Check with ECS to determine if they are ready before placing LS in remote .
On LCU Display Panel A1A14 , verify the following:
(1 )
All BITE lights off.
(2)
All POWER on.
BITE
POWER SUPPLIES
SUPPLIES lights
O
O c
O
O
O +5 VDC
O 15 VDC
O +28 VDC
Το
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT の O
BITE
POWER SUPPLIES
MISSILE
PLATFORM.
MAGT ・이이 이이
O
PLATFORM RAMED AZBAUTH
O
HAZARD
READT
O
O LAUNCHER LOCAL
O
DISCON MECTED 0101010 RAME
STOP O
LAUNCHINGSTA
O
START PRING PLATOON • 5
BITE TEST O STAFUR LAMP TEST
PANE: O OFF
O CONTINUED
2-11
2-120
TM 9-1440-600-10
Continued .
(3)
LOCAL
and
LCHR
READY
LAUNCHER LOCAL- RMT
lights on . (4)
PLATFORM ר
PLATFORM RAISED and AZIMUTH READY lights on.
PLATFORM RAISED
AZIMUTH READY
O
LCHR READY LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
OOO BITE
POWER SUPPLIES O
O MISSILE UPPER UPPER
PLATFORM-
Θ O
HER
= 0 | 0 |0 | 0 O 0101010
LAUNCHING STA
STOP O
-
START O
(5)
MISSILE READY lights on if missile heaters turned on and
O
FRING
GMs at operating temperature .
BITETEST STATUS LAMPTEST
STATUSLAMPs NORMAL O
O
O
26
EMPLACEMENT - Continued
O
2-8.
(6)
MISSILE HAZARD lights off at
O
all positions having live missiles with umbilicals connected . (7)
MISSILE HAZARD lights on at all positions having dummy missiles , empty canisters , empty
UPPER L
MISSILE UPPER R LWR L
locations , or live missiles with disconnected umbilicals .
LWR R
MISSILE HAZARD 0000
(8)
MISSILE
DISCONNECTED
lights off at all positions having live missiles with umbilicals
MISSILE READY
0
| 0
| 0 | 0
connected .
MISSILE DISCONNECTED
0101010
CONTINUED
2-121
TM
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-1
2-8.
EMPLACEMENT- Continued -
Continued.
26 [
LAUNCHING STA switch set to correct address . (9)
(10)
FIRING PLATOON switch set to correct address.
Install key and set LOCAL- RMT switch to RMT.
d.
O
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
LAUNCHER RMT LOCAL
2
Ο
LAUNCHERLOCAL
O
POWER SUPPLIES
BITE
LAUNCHING STA
O
MISSILE UPPER L UPPERR 0000
PLATFORM
O
7 MADS 6
이이 이이
O
LOB PLATFORM RAISED ADRAUTH MADY READY 00
0101010
5 Ø
SAI O
FIRING PLATOON 1
O
START 2
O
6
STATUS LAMPTEXT
10
0 [
оо
o
:0
10
Ø
3
O
e.
27
Close and secure LEM A1 right- hand door.
LEAVE SITE .
a.
All crewmembers get in tractor and drive to assigned remote area.
b.
Report to ECS that area is clear.
CONTINUED
2-12
2-122
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-9 .
POSITION OF CONTROLS PRIOR TO APPLICATION OF POWER
STEP
A
LOCATION
CONTROL POSITION
CONTROL
LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS
MODULE (LEM) A1
1
MAIN POWER - AC
Power Control Panel ( PCP)
OFF
CB1 circuit breaker
MAIN POWER DC AC Θ
RUN TIME
→ CB1
M1
Insert Key
LOCAL - RMT
LCU Display Panel A1A14
LOCAL
Keyswitch O
Remove LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT POWER SUPPLIES
LOCAL
-LAUNCHERPLATFORMLOCAL RMT
Key
O
LAUNCHERBITE
RMT
1.48 VDC VEC MISSILE UPPERL UPPERR MISSILE HAZARD 0
MISSALE READY
O
LOHR PLATFORM SAISED AZIMISH READY READY
이이 이이
O
Ο
DISCON NECTED 0101010
Θ
LAUNCHINGSTA
STOP
O
RAISE
O
START O
FIRINGPLATOON LAMPS PANELLAMPS NORMAL BITE TEST STATUS OFF DIN OFF STATUS LAMPTEST
O
2
CB2
O
CONTINUED
2-123
TM
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1
2-9.
POSITION OF CONTROLS PRIOR TO APPLICATION OF POWER - Continued
STEP
3
CONTROL
LOCATION
RAISE-STOP- LWR
LCU Display Panel A1A14
CONTROL POSITION
STOP
switch LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
RAISE BITE
401P
O
O LAUNCHERLOCAL
POWER SUPPLIES
MISSILE
LWR
O
PLATFORM-
の
LAUNCHINGSTA 2
RAISE
O
O
NEADY LOR PLATFORM 이이 이이 MARY RAISED AZMUTH READY DISCON MECTED 0101010
STOP O
FRINGPLATOON
4
оо
STATUSLAMPS NORMAL PANEL OFF LAMPTEST
101
:0
% 10
2
O
O
START
BITE TEST -OFF-
OFF
STATUS LAMP TEST switch BITE TEST
OFF STATUS LAMP TEST
5
PANEL LAMPS switch
OFF
PANEL LAMPS ON
OFF
CONTINUED
2-1 :
2-124
TM 9-1440-600-10 POSITION OF CONTROLS PRIOR TO APPLICATION OF POWER - Continued
2-9 .
STEP
6
LOCATION
CONTROL POSITION
CONTROL
LAUNCHING STA
LCU Display Panel A1A14
ASSIGNED ADDRESS
O
BITE
LAUNCHING STA 1
O
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT POWER SUPPLIES
2
8
о
O
MISSILE PLATFORM . UPPERL UPPERA HAZARD
LAUNCHER LOCAL C
3
7 0| 0 |0 |0 O
BAMBO READY PLAYPOR ööö
6
# 0000 LAURICHING STA
5
O
STOP START O
NORMAL DIFE TENY STATUSLAMPS O STATUS LAMPTEST
©
оо
O
ATOON
e
7
FIRING PLATOON
AS-
SIGNED ADDRESS FIRING PLATOON 1
2
6
3
5 Ô 4
CONTINUED
2-125
TN TM 9-1440-600-10 2-1
[
POSITION OF CONTROLS PRIOR TO APPLICATION OF POWER · Continued
2-9 .
LOCATION
STEP
8
CONTROL POSITION
CONTROL
Power Distribution Unit
All circuit breakers
(PDU) A1A2
and switches.
OFF
LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT Θ Θ →
O Θ
BLOWER OPR
O
BLOWER ON
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAIN A Θ ON Θ
OFF
OFF
Θ MISSILE HEATER AC, UPR R MSL UPRL MSL MAIN B ON Θ ON ээ ON OFF
OFF
OFF
O
LCHR ELEX 5 VDC PWR SPLY ON
PWRORD SPLY ON
LCHR ELEX 28 VDC PWR SPLY ON
MSL VDC PWR5SPLY ON
MSL GYRO/CLOCK PWR SPLY ON
LWR L MSL ON
LWR R MSL ON
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
MSL PAFUTL PWRSPLY ON
MSL TWT FIL PWR SPLY ON
OFF
OFF
CNVCOUT MOT CONT CANISTER UNITAC AC HTR Ꮎ ON Ꮎ Ꮎ ON OFF
OFF
LAMPS ON OFF TEST Θ
O
O CONTINUED
2-11 2-126
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-9.
POSITION OF CONTROLS PRIOR TO APPLICATION OF POWER - Continued
STEP
B
LOCATION
CONTROL POSITION
CONTROL
DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE (DLTM) A2 Power Distribution Unit
All circuit breakers
(PDU) A2
and switches.
OFF
O DATA LINK TERM MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT
CNVC OUT ON
MAIN ON A
OFF LAMPS
OFF BLOWER ON
ON OFF TEST
28 VDC O BLOWER OPR
O →
Ꮎ
OFF CLKONPWR
DGTL PROCESSOR ON O OFF
OFF
0
O
OFF
PWR SPLY O ON
O
O
C
0
O
GENERATOR SET A6
DO NOT START GENERATOR SET A6 UNTIL LAUNCHING STATION IS
WARNING
CONNECTED TO A SUITABLE GROUND .
SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH CAN RESULT FROM OPERATING AN UNGROUNDED LAUNCHING STATION .
CONTINUED
2-127
TM TM 9-1440-600-10 2-1
2-9.
POSITION OF CONTROLS PRIOR TO APPLICATION OF POWER - Continued
STEP
1
LOCATION
Launching station ( LS ) ground terminal 42J3
CONTROL
Ground cable 42W3
CONTROL POSITIONS
Connected between
semitrailer connector
42J3 and ground rod
2
TM 5-6115-464-12
Perform generator set BEFORE OPERATION
All complete
CHECKS AND SERVICES
CONTINUED
2-1
2-128
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-9 .
POSITION OF CONTROLS PRIOR TO APPLICATION OF POWER
STEP
3
LOCATION
- Continued
CONTROL
Generator Set A6 , roadside
FUEL SELECTOR VALVE
CONTROL POSITION
SET TANK
LECTOR VALW RUB SUPPLY
4
Control panel
DC CONTROL
Pushed in
circuit breaker
(closed)
GENERATOR
O! DC CONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULL FOR EMERGENCY STOP DECONTRO PULLFOR EMERGENCYSTOP
CONTINUED
2-129
TN
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1
2-9 .
[
POSITION OF CONTROLS PRIOR TO APPLICATION OF POWER- Continued
STEP
5
CONTROL
LOCATION
ENGINE PRIMER switch
Control panel
O
CONTROL POSITION
OFF
FALLTIDEATOR
O
10
GENERATION ENGINE PRIMER ON
DCCONTROL
6
START- RUN - STOP
STOP switch
START
RUN STOP
7
CKT BRK switch
OPEN
CKT BRK CKT BRK CLOSE
OPEN
8
PANEL LIGHT switch
OFF
PANEL LIGHT ON
OFF
CONTINUED
2-1
2-130
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-9 .
POSITION OF CONTROLS PRIOR TO APPLICATION OF POWER- Continued
STEP
9
LOCATION
CONTROL
VOLTAGE SENSING
Control panel
CONTROL POSITION
LOCAL
switch
SENSING
VOLTAGE
V REMOTES
LOCAL G
09
CONFRO
10
10
PARALLEL OPERA-
SINGLE
TION - SINGLE
UNIT
UNIT OPERATION
OPERA-
switch
TION
PARALLEL OPERATION
SINGLEUNIT OPERATION
11
BATTLE SHORT
OFF
switch
KC
ON
OFF BATTLE SHORT
2-131
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-10 .
POWER - UP
Use this procedure to power-up the launching station ( LS) after NOTE a complete power-down . A typical use is after refueling Generator Set A6.
1
Open and latch Generator Set A6 control cubicle and air vent doors.
2
Roll up air inlet and air outlet covers on Launcher Electronics Module ( LEM) A1 and Data Link Terminal Module ( DLTM ) A2.
a.
At rear of each module ,
unsnap
six snap fasteners at bottom and sides of air inlet cover. Roll up and tie each cover. b.
On
both sides of each
unsnap bottom
eight snap
module ,
fasteners
at
and sides of air exhaust
cover. Roll up and tie each cover .
TYPICAL LEM A1 DLTM A2
CONTINUED
2-132
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-10. 3
POWER- UP- Continued
Remove padlock and open DLTM A2 doors. If wind is over 45 knots , insert locking pin in hole at top of door.
198
4
Open LEM A1 doors . Same as DLTM A2 access doors , except there is no padlock.
5
Position controls on LEM A1 , DLTM A2, and Generator Set A6 per para 2-9.
6 START
On Generator Set A6 , set STARTRUN -STOP switch to RUN .
STOP
Ο
о
O e
ENGINE
OOOOOO !.
RUN
FAULTINDICATOR ·
GENERATOR
O
7
Raise safety guard and set BATTLESHORT switch to ON .
OO
STOP
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULLFOR EMERGENCYSTOP ON ତ OFF BATTLE SHORT
CONTINUED
2-133
TM
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1
2-10 .
POWER - UP- Continued
1.
[
Fuel transfer pump makes clicking sounds when transferring fuel into day tank. Pump will stop when day tank is full .
NOTES 2.
START- RUN - STOP switch
must remain in
RUN and
BATTLE-
SHORT switch must remain ON until day tank is filled .
Check that FUEL LEVEL gage indicates an acceptable fuel level .
olgo
8
FAULTINDICATOR
GENERATOR
6 0
OO
O
LEVEL
FUEL LEVEL
9
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULLFOR EMERGENCYSTOP
O
Ο
Check that LOW OIL PRESS , UNDER VOLT, and
UNDER FREQ lights are
LOW OIL PRESS
UNDER FREQ
UNDER VOLT
on .
ON
When day tank is full (about 2 minutes, clicking sound stops) set BATTLESHORT switch to OFF . Lower
- ) (
10
OFF BATTLE SHORT
safety guard .
11
Hold TEST OR RESET switch down and check that all FAULT INDICATOR lights are on . Release switch .
TEST OR RESET
CONTINUED
2-1
2-134
TM 9-1440-600-10
POWER - UP- Continued
2-10.
DO NOT CRANK
ENGINE FOR MORE THAN
15 SECONDS
AT A TIME . ALLOW STARTER TO COOL AT LEAST 3 MINUTES BETWEEN TRIES.
CAUTION
If outside temperature
is
50° F
( 10°C) or
below ,
perform
step
NOTE 12. If temperature is above 50°F ( 10°C) , perform step 13.
12
If temperature is 50°F ( 10°C) or below , start Generator Set A6 with start aid procedure as follows.
a.
Hold
START- RUN - STOP switch
to START to crank engine . Do not
START
hold for more than 15 seconds.
OOOOOO!
RUN STOP
FAULTINDICATOR
O GENERATOR
ENGINE O
O
о
REVERSE
OVER
b.
While engine is cranking , hold ENGINE PRIMER switch to ON to inject ether , then switch.
ㅎ
お
09
O
C.
release
DCCONTROL CIRCUITBREAKER PULLFORSTOP EMERGENCY
ENGINE PRIMER ON
Release switch to RUN after 15 seconds or when engine starts . When engine starts go to step 14.
DO NOT INJECT ETHER MORE THAN THREE TIMES . IF ENGINE DOES NOT START AFTER THREE TRIES , NOTIFY ENGINEER MAINTENANCE .
CAUTION
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-135
TM 9-1440-600-10
TM
2-1 .
2-10.
POWER - UP- Continued -
12
Continued .
B
13
d.
If engine does not start within 15 seconds , release START- RUN -STOP Switch. Allow starter to cool for 3 minutes.
e.
Repeat steps a and b . If engine does not start after three tries notify Engineer Maintenance .
If temperature is over 50°F ( 10°C) start engine normally as follows.
a.
Hold START- RUN -STOP switch to START for 15 seconds or until OIL PRESSURE gage indicates oil pressure and VOLTS A.C. meter indicates voltage .
L
START
A.C. VOLTMETER
120
RUN
STOP
PRESS OIL PRESSURE
о
FAULT INDICATOR
о GENERATOR
ENGINE O b.
Release switch to RUN when engine starts .
ㅎ
OO
O
ORCUIT BREAKER EMERGENCY STOP
CONTINUED
2-1
2-136
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-10.
14
POWER - UP- Continued
Check output voltage.
a.
Set VOLTS-AMPS switch to positions L1 - LO,
L2- LO, and L3- LO. VOLTS A.C.
meter should indicate 120 Vac red line in each position .
b. Elo
L1-LO L1
L3-L1
tions L1 - L2, L2- L3 , and L3- L1 . VOLTS A.C. meter should in-
500
position.
A.C VO METER
dicate 208 Vac red line in each
LL3O
C.
AMPS VOLTS
Set VOLTS-AMPS switch to posi-
INCREASE
If voltage in any position is wrong , set VOLTS -AMPS switch to that position and use VOLTAGE ADJUST rheostat to adjust to correct voltage .
d.
VOLTAGE ADJUST
Ο
If voltage had to be adjusted , repeat steps a and b.
FAULT INDICATOR O
о e
GENERATOR
O
お
ㅎ
SROLEUNT OPERATION
WATTLEWORY
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULLFOR EMERGENCYSTOP
INCREASE 15
Check HERTZ frequency meter for 400 Hz indication . If necessary use FREQUENCY ADJUST rheostat to ad-
ō FREQUENCY ADJUST
just frequency to 400 Hz.
CONTINUED
2-137
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-10 .
POWER- UP - Continued
IF ANY FAULT INDICATOR LIGHT COMES ON, STOP ENGINE AND NOTIFY ENGINEER MAINTENANCE . CAUTION
NOTE
Step 16 applies power to the LS.
16
After 3 minutes engine warmup, hold CKT BRK switch to CLOSE until CKT BRK light comes on . Release CKT BRK switch .
FAULT INDICATOR
GENERATOR
ENGINE
O
OOOOO OOOOOO
O
о
·
O
O CKT BRK CKT BRK CLOSE
OPER
17
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT FULLBREAKER FOR EMERGENCYSTOP
OPEN
Check indicators for normal indications as follows:
a.
All FAULT INDICATOR lights off.
FAULT INDICATOR
2-138
LOW OIL PRESS
COOLANT HIGH TEMP
OVER SPEED
NO FUEL
SHORT CIRCUIT
OVER LOAD
UNDER VOLT
UNDER FREQ
REVERSE POWER
OVER VOLT CONTINUED
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-10.
POWER-UP - Continued
17
b.
Continued.
VOLTS A.C. meter indicates 120 Vac.
FAULTINDICATOR wtro SHORT
O
60
O GENERATOR
ENGINE
A.C. VOLTMETER
ㅎ
09
OPERATION
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULLFOR EMERGENCYSTOP
HE TZ C.
HERTZ frequency meter indicates 400 Hz.
お
160 200 d.
120
120
240
T PRESS
T TEMP F
OIL PRESSURE
COOLANT TEMPERATURE
OIL PRESSURE gage
indicates
30 to 60 psig .
e.
COOLANT TEMPERATURE gage indicates 170°F to 200°F .
CONTINUED
2-139
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-10.
18
POWER- UP - Continued Close Generator Set A6 control cubicle doors .
19
On LEM Power Control Panel ( PCP) A1A3 , raise cover and set MAIN POWER - AC CB1 to ON.
MAIN POWER AC DC
RUN TIME
Θ
Θ
20
CB2
CB1
M1
Energize DLTM A2 .
On Power Distribution Unit ( PDU) A2A4, hold LAMPS switch to TEST .
O
O CNVC OUT ON
O
OFF OFF LAMPS BLOWER OFF O TEST
O
O
O.BLOWER OPE O
G
O
O
о
LAMPS ON OFF TEST
O
b.
Θ O
O
fie
@! @
O 0 DATA LINK TERM MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT → MAINA ON C
O
a.
о
O
Check that the two panel lights and
BLOWER
OPR light come BLOWER OPR
on . Release switch . C.
Set LAMPS switch to ON.
ㅇㅎㅇ
CONTINUED
2-140
TM 9-1440-600-10
20
POWER - UP - Continued -
Continued . Ο
d.
Set
BLOWER circuit breaker to
ON O
O O O O DATA LINK TERM MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT " CNVC OUT MARIA PROCESSOR ON ON ON C OFF OFF OFF OFF O-BLOWER OP LAMPS ON BLOWER ON OFF O TEST → OFF
Ο
O
2-10
BLOWER ON
OFF
BLOWER OPR e.
Check that BLOWER OPR light is on before continuing .
O
MAIN A ON + f.
Set MAIN A circuit breaker to ON.
OFF
+ g.
Set
CLK PWR circuit breaker to
CLK PWR ON
ON OFF
28 VDC h.
Check that 28 VDClight is on.
O
NOTE
Tractor over-the- road power is not required for clock synchronization when CLK PWR circuit breaker is ON and 28 VDC light is on.
CONTINUED
2-141
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-10.
20
POWER - UP - Continued -
Continued .
O
CNVC OUT
о O O O O DATA LINK TERM MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O PROCESSOR MAIN ON
O
OFF AMPS
OFF BLOWER ON
0
O i.
Set PWR SPLY circuit breaker to
ON. OFF
OFF
BLOWEROP O
Ο
о O
O
PWR SPLY ON +
O
0 O
о
OFF DGTL PROCESSOR +
j.
Set
DGTL PROCESSOR
ON
+
circuit
breaker to ON.
OFF 21
Energize LEM - PDU A1A2 blower.
a.
O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT Θ Θ
Hold LAMPS switch to TEST. BLOWER OPR
Θ
9
LAMPS
MISSILE HEATER AC
OFF
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAINA ON OFF
LCHRSLEX SVDC PWRSPLY
LOW ELEX PWR SPLY
MSL&VOC PWSSPLY
GYROCLOCK PWR SPLY
OFF
OFF
OFF
BLOWER
MAIN OFF
ON OFF
OFF
CNVCOUT
MOT CONT UNITAC ON OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF TEST
PW
OFF
OFF
LAMPS O
OFF
PAPURTL PWRSPLY
Θ
b.
Check that the two panellights and BLOWER OPR lights come
O
O
BLOWER OPR
on. Release switch . Ö C.
Set LAMPS switch to ON.
CONTINUED
2-142
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-10.
POWER-UP - Continued
21
Continued .
Set
d.
BLOWER circuit breaker to
ON .
BLOWER +
ON
+
O O O LCHR ELEX MOL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT Θ Θ BLOWER OPR
OFF
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAIN A ON OFF
BLOWER ON OFF
CNVC OUTHTR CANISTER ON OFF
Check that BLOWER
MSL VDC PWR SPLY
OFF
OFF
MSL GYROCLOCK PWR SPLY ON O OFF
PAFURTL SPLY PWR ON OFF
TWTPSPLY PWR ON OFF
MOTCONT UNIT AC ON OFF
O
e.
LCHA ELEX 2 VDC PWR SPLY Ꮎ
LCHRVDCELEX PWR SPLY ON OFF
MAIN B ON OFF
O
O
MISSILE HEATER AC . LPHI MISL UPR & MISL ON ON OFF ON OFF
LAMPS ON
O
O
OPR light
is on before continuing .
BLOWER OPR
22
Set MAIN A and MAIN B circuit breakers to ON .
MAIN B
MAIN A +
ON
OFF
+
+
ON
+
OFF
CONTINUED
2-143
TM 9-1440-600-10
POWER- UP - Continued
2-10 . 23
In the sequence listed below, set the following circuit breakers to ON
1 LCHR ELEX 5 VDC PWR SPLY +
3
2
ON
ORD PWR SPLY +
+
ON
4
LCHR ELEX 28 VDC PWR SPLY
+
+
ON
OFF
OFF
+
6
MSL GYRO/CLOCK PWR SPLY
MOT CONT UNIT AC ON
O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O O O BLOWER OPE
0
+
BLOWER
MISSILE HEATER AC,
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC MAIN A O
OFF
OFF
2
9
8
7
MSL TWT FIL PWR SPLY
6
ON
OFF
OFF
+
5
1 ON
LAMPS
OFF
O
O
ON
3
O
MSL PAFU/ITL PWR SPLY
+
Θ
OFF
Θ
+
ON
OFF
5
ON
MSL 5 VDC PWR SPLY
O
IF CANISTER HEAT IS REQUIRED :
9 CNVC OUT CANISTER HTR AC + ON
OFF
CONTINUED)
2-144
TM 9-1440-600-10
POWER - UP - Continued
2-10 .
24
MAIN POWER DC AC
RUN TIME O
On LEM - PCP A1A3, raise cover and set MAIN POWER - DC CB2 to OFF
CB2
M1
25
Θ
On DLTM Digital Processor A2A2, check TIME OF DAY display.
TIME OF DAY
PROPAGATION DELAYREQUEST
YEST DAY
HOUR
MIN
SEC PROCESSORCONTROL OSC CAL
O AUTOSYNC 88 88 TIMECONTROL
DLT TEST
a.
If counting , set DLT TEST switch TEST
to
NORMAL and
perform
DLT
auto synchronizing per para 2-29.
NORMAL
Go to step 26 below.
• DLT TIME OF DAY CLOCK MUST BE COUNTING La
WARNINGS
BEFORE
PROPER INDICATION CAN BE OBTAINED FROM LCU DISPLAY PANEL A1A14 MISSILE HAZARD LIGHTS. A MISSILE HAZARD LIGHT ON INDICATES A HAZARDOUS CONDITION ONLY FOR LIVE GM POSITIONS WITH UMBILICAL CONNECTED. MISSILE HAZARD LIGHT WILL NORMALLY BE ON FOR : •
GM POSITIONS HAVING A DUMMY MISSILE . EMPTY CANISTER . EMPTY POSITION . LIVE MISSILE WITH UMBILICAL DISCONNECTED .
• THESE CONDITIONS DO NOT CONSTITUTE A HAZARD. IF ANY MISSILE HAZARD LIGHT IS ON , VISUALLY CHECK THAT POSITION.
IF THAT POSITION
HAS A LIVE
MISSILE WITH
NOTIFY ECS IMMEDIATELY. ADVISE ECS THAT LS WILL REMAIN IN LOCAL MODE. AFTER UMBILICAL
CONNECTED ,
NOTIFYING
ECS,
STRUCTIONS .
LEAVE AREA AND AWAIT FURTHER INDEVICES MAY EXPLODE ,
ORDNANCE
RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-145
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-10 .
POWER - UP - Continued -
25
b.
Continued .
If not counting , perform DLT quick start per para 2-25 and DLT slave synchronizing per para 2-28 . Go to step 26 below .
O
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT On LCU Display Panel A1A14 , check that all MISSILE HAZARDlights are
BITE
O
POWER SUPPLIES
off at live GM positions .
O
O
READY 0000 O
LCH PLATFORM MEADE RAISED AZMUTH READY ööö
MISSILE UPPER UPPER& HAZAR 010
0
O
PLATFORM
LAUNCHER
O
26
0000
LWR R
STOP
O
MISSILE UPPER R LWR L
UPPER L
101
LAUNCHINGSTA
START
MISSILE HAZARD
0 O
0000
e
FRINGPLATOON
O
оо
OFTETEST STATUSLAMP STATUS LAMPTEST
O
NOTE
O O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT
On LEM - PDU A1A2 , set MISSILE HEATER AC circuit breakers at live
O
27
Omit step 27 below if GM heat is not required .
Θ
O
G
BLOWER OPR
GM positions to ON if directed by engagement control station ( ECS) .
BLOWER ON OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC, UPR L MSL UPR R MSLי O ON ON Θ
OFF
LCHRELEX PWBSVDCSPLY ON OFF
OFF
CNVC OUT CANISTERHTR LWR L MSL Θ ON
LWR R MSL ON Θ
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAINA ON OFF
ORD PWRSPLY ON OFF MOT UNITCONT AC ON OFF
LCHRELEX FAR28VDC SPLY ON OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC, e MAIN ON OFF
MSL5VDC PWRSPLY
GYRO-CLOCK
OFF
OFF
MSI PARUITL PWR SPLY
TWTF FWR
OFF
OFF
OIFF
OFF LAMPS OFF
O OFF
OFF
LAMPS 28
Set LAMPS switch to OFF.
ON OFF TEST CONTINUED
2-146
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-10.
POWER - UP - Continued
p of Jon lut LEM-PDU A1A2 DOOR MUST REMAIN CLOSED AFTER PDU A1A2 IS ENERGIZED SHIELDING .
TO
PREVENT
DEGRADING
EMI
CAUTION
29
Close door.
and
secure
LEM- PDU
A1A2
30
Disconnect outrigger electrical cable from Semitrailer Connector 42W2P1 .
Is Sent Your
فن
b.
ن
a.
CURBSIDE
Raise retaining clip to release connector.
Pull connector straight out to free it. Install dust cover on semitrailer connector 42W2P1 . CONTINUED
Change 1
2-147
TM
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-1 . 2-10.
POWER - UP - Continued
31
Disconnect outrigger cable from tractor slave connector . Be careful not to get grease from fifth wheel on cable .
Stow cable in
31.1
tractor roadside BATTERY BOX
stowage box .
L
SLAVE CONNECTOR CURBSIDE OUTRIGGER CABLE
32
At LCU Display Panel A1A14 , perform local BITE test.
a.
b.
Check that all five BITE lights are off.
BITE
Set BITE TEST- OFF - STATUS LAMP TEST switch to
STATUS
LAMP TEST. Check that all BITE lights are on .
O
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT POWER SUPPLIES
BITE TEST OFF STATUS LAMP TEST
O
od LAUNCHER LOCAL
PLATFORM-
MISSILE LIPPERA
# 0000
C
LCH PLATFORM RAISED AZMUTH HEADY READY O
O
0000
MECTED 0101010 อ
START
O
:0
O
BITE
STOP 10:
O
Set switch to BITE TEST.
RAISE
10
C.
LAURICHINGSTA
FRINGPLATOON ETATUSLA NORMAN
O
STATUR LANDYERY
JO
0
Fol
lights cycle on and off for 6 seconds. All BITE lights cycle on , test passed .
d.
Set switch to OFF
CONTINUED
2-12 2-148
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-13
POWER -UP - Continued
32.1
On CCIP A2A2, check SUMMARY FAULTlight . If light is on , switch momentarily to RESET SUMMARY FAULT light will go off.
FAU SUMMARY FAULT
hold
RESET
PROPAGATIN
PROCESSOR CONTROL
RESET
10 00 00 Θ
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-148.1 /(2-148.2 blank)
TM
2-1
2-1:
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-10 .
POWER-UP - Continued
GUIDED MISSILES MUST NOT BE CONNECTED IF MISSILE HAZARD LIGHT IS ON AT A LIVE GM POSITION WITH CABLE
La
WARNING
33
On LCU
CONNECTED .
ORDNANCE DEVICES RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
Display Panel A1A14, raise cover and
MAY
EXPLODE ,
hold CONNECT- DISC
switches
to CONNECT at all positions , except where MISSILE HAZARDlights are on , having live GMs with umbilicals connected until corresponding MISSILE DISCONNECTED lights go off.
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT O POWER SUPPLIES
UPPER L
PLATFORM-
LWR R
MISSILE HAZARD C0000
O LAUNCHER
MISSILE UPPER R LWR L
O
BITE
VPC VDC MISSILE LIPPERA MOSLE HAZARD
O
O
MISSILE READY LEN PLATICIUM 이이 이이 RAIDED ATMUTH READY READY OOO DISCON MECTED 0 |0 |0 |0 LAUNCHING STA RAIDE STOP 2
MISSILE DISCONNECTED 0101010
O Θ
C
O
START O
O
:0 0 FRINGPLATOON
NORMAL SITETEST STATUSLAMPS STATUS LAMPTEST
CONNECT CONNECT
O
10
CONNECT CONNECT
DISC
DISC
DISC
DISC
の
34
On DLTM- PDU A2A4, set LAMPS switch to OFF .
о O о
0
ON OFF TEST
fee
0
LAMPS
O
O
O O о DATA LINK TERM MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O O CNVC DGTL MAINON A OUT PROCESSOR ON 28 VDC O ค OFF OFF OFF LAMPSON BLOWER OBLOWEROP ON OTEST OFF O OFF O о о
CONTINUED
2-149
TN
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-1
2-10.
POWER - UP - Continued
35
Close and secure both DLTM A2 doors . Lock left door with padlock .
36
Set engagement control handle to ROTATE
C
ELEV
ROTATE
ROADMARCH
37
On LCU Display Panel A1A14 , check the following conditions.
a.
All BITE lights off. b.
All POWER SUPPLIESlights off.
BITE
POWER SUPPLIES
ОО 00
OOO ОО +5 ±15 +28 VDC VDC VDC 10
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT C. O LAUNCHERLOCAL
C PLATFORM-
POWER SUPPLIES O VDC VDC MISSILE UPPERL UPPER B HAZARD O
O
All
MISSILE
HAZARD lights off.
MISSILE READY lights on . MS-
O
BITE
SILE DISCONNECTED lights off .
O
Ol
MECTED 0101010
UPPER L
MISSILE LWR L UPPER R
LWR R
MISSILE HAZARD 0000
STOP
O
SAIBE
이이 이이 O
LAUNCHINGSTA
MISSLE READY
O
RAISED ADMUTH READY READY PLATFORM
0 | 0 | 0 | 0
START
MISSILE READY O
[
FIRINGPLATOON
оо
LAMPS PANELLAS STATUS NORMAL O O OM OFF
O
0
STATUS LAMPTEST
MISSILE DISCONNECTED
0101010 O
CONTINUED 2-12
2-150
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-10 .
POWER- UP - Continued -
Continued .
37
d.
LOCAL and LCHR READY lights e.
on.
PLATFORM
RAISED
and AZI-
MUTH READYlights on.
LAUNCHERLOCAL- RMT
LCHR READY
f.
LAUNCHING
STA and FIRING PLATOON switches set to correct
LAUNCHING STA 2
O O
3
7 O
6
O
READY LCHR PLATFORM 이이 이이 READY READY RAISED AZIMUTH OOO DSCON MECTED 0101010
O
FIRING PLATOON 1
STOP CONNECT
2
0
e
O
O
POWER SUPPLIES O VDC VOC MISSILE PLATFORMUPPERA HAZARO
RAISE
O О
0
O
10 の
BITE
LAUNCHING STA
AZIMUTH READY
addresses .
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
LAUNCHER LOCAL
PLATFORM RAISED
START OO
O
0
O
0
MITETEST STATUS LAMPS PANELLAMP OFF D STATUS LAMPTEST
3
5
O
FIRINGPLATOON
TURNTABLE CAN BE REMOTELY TRAINED 1 MINUTE AFTER LOCAL- RMT SWITCH IS SET TO RMT, SERIOUS INJURY CAN
WARNING
38
RESULT IF STRUCK BY THE MOVING PLATFORM .
Set LS to remote mode. LO
CA
L
a.
Insert key in LOCAL- RMT switch . RM
T
39
b.
Set switch to RMT
C.
Check that LOCAL light is off.
Close and secure LCU Display Panel A1A14 door on LEM A1 .
Change 1
2-151
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-11 .
POWER - DOWN
STAY CLEAR OF LAUNCHER MECHANICS PLANE OF ROTATION WHEN
LOCAL-RMT KEYSWITCH
ON
LCU
DISPLAY
PANEL A1A14 IS SET TO RMT (REMOTE ) . TURNTABLE CAN
WARNING
BE ROTATED REMOTELY THEN , AND YOU CAN BE
HURT.
REMAIN CLEAR UNTIL KEYSWITCH IS SET TO LOCAL , LOCAL LIGHT IS ON AND KEY IS REMOVED .
1.
Use this procedure when a complete power- down is required .
2.
This procedure keeps tractor 28-volt Data Link Terminal
NOTES ( DLT)
clock power supplied to the launching station ( LS) .
Position tractor no further than 4 feet ( 1.22 meters) from electrical cable can be connected .
semitrailer so outrigger
10
OF
1
0
CURBSIDE
Le WARNING
DO NOT LEAVE TRACTOR UNATTENDED WITHOUT CHOCKING WHEELS. TRACTOR MAY ROLL , RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
CONTINUED
2-152
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-11 .
2
POWER - DOWN - Continued
-
Continued .
Pull out tractor PARKING
a.
BRAKE
control ,
place transmission range selector
lever in neutral (N ) , and leave engine running . b.
Remove chock blocks from stowage in tractor roadside stowage box and chock tractor rear wheels as follows: STOWAGE
(1 )
If tractor is facing uphill, place chock blocks behind tractor rear wheels ,
both
curbside
CHOCK BOTH SIDES
and
roadside .
ROADSIDE CHOCK BOTH SIDES
(2)
If tractor
is facing
downhill ,
place chock blocks in front of rear wheels, both curbside and roadside.
ROADSIDE
ROADSIDE ONLY
(3)
If tractor is level , place chock block in front of rear wheel on curbside and behind rear wheel CURBSIDE ONLY
on roadside .
ROADSIDE
Through remainder of this procedure , chock blocks will be shown NOTE for tractor as in level position Chock as described in step b.
above
unless grade is shown.
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-153
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-11 .
3
POWER - DOWN - Continued
Open Launcher Electronics Module ( LEM ) A1 doors. If wind is over 45 knots insert locking pin in hole at top of door.
H
4
On LCU Display Panel A1A14 , set LS to local mode .
a.
Set LOCAL- RMT switch to LOCAL
b.
(Deleted) .
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT BITE
の
CA
L
MT
0000 이이 이이
O
MADY PLATFORM AZMOUTH ööö
-R
O
O
LO
PLATFORM-
O
LAUNCHER-
POWERSUPPLIES O MISSILE UPPERL UPPERR
0101010
START
O
:0
STOP 10: O
BAIRE
Ø
O
の
LAURICHINGSTA
Fol
STATU LAMPTEST
O
STATUSLAMPS оо の
C.
Check that LOCAL light is on .
d.
Remove and retain key.
CONTINUED
2-154
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-11 .
POWER - DOWN .- Continued
IF ANY MISSILE HAZARD LIGHT IS ON, VISUALLY CHECK THAT POSITION. IF THAT POSITION HAS A LIVE
MISSILE
WITH UMBILICAL CONNECTED , NOTIFY ECS IMMEDIATELY . ADVISE ECS THAT LS WILL REMAIN IN LOCAL MODE. AFTER NOTIFYING ECS, LEAVE AREA AND AWAIT FURTHER INSTRUCTIONS . ORDNANCE DEVICES MAY EXPLODE ,
WARNING
RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
5
Check that MISSILE
HAZARD lights
are off at all positions where GM cables are connected to live GMs.
6
UPPER L
MISSILE UPPER R LWR L
LWR R MISSILE HAZARD C0000
To disconnect
missiles , raise cover and hold CONNECT- DISC switches to DISC at all positions until correspond-
ing MISSILE go off.
DISCONNECTED lights
MISSILE DISCONNECTED
0 | 0 | 0 |0 Θ Θ
CONNECT CONNECT
DISC
DISC
CONNECT CONNECT
DISC
DISC
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-154.1 /(2-154.2 blank)
TA
2-
] 2-1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-11 .
POWER - DOWN - Continued
7
Electrically rotate turntable to the 180° position per para 2-22.
8
Connect outrigger electrical cable to Semitrailer Connector 42W2P1 . a.
Remove
cable from
tractor
roadside stowage box.
BATTERY OUTRIGGER CABLE
a.1 .
Connect
outrigger
BOX
cable to
tractor slave connector .
SLAVE CONNECTOR
0
CURBSIDE
b.
Carefully route cable from tractor to semitrailer. Be careful not to get grease from fifth wheel on cable.
C.
Remove
dust cover from
Semi-
trailer Connector 42W2P1 .
d.
Connect
cable to
Connector
42W2P1 by pushing straight in . e.
Lower spring retainer to lock cable connector in place.
CONTINUED
T
Change 1
2-155
TM 9-1440-600-10
TM
2-11 .
POWER - DOWN- Continued
2-1 9
At LEM Power Control Panel (PCP) A1A3 , raise cover and set MAIN -
MAIN POWER AC DC
POWER - DC CB2 to ON.
C
RUN TIME O
C →
10
CB2
CB1
M1
Remove padlock and open Data Link Terminal Module ( DLTM ) A2 doors . If wind is over 45 knots insert locking pin in hole at top of door.
11
On Computer- To-Communications Interface Processor A2A2, set DLT TEST switch to TEST.
DLT TEST
DELAY
TEST PROCESSORCONTRO-
12
In the sequence
AUTOSTRIC 88888 THE CONTROL-
NORMAL
listed
below,
set the following circuit breakers on
LEM
Power
Distribution Unit ( PDU) A1A2 to OFF.
2
UPR L MSL
ON
3
UPR R MSL
+
+
ON
+
LWR R MSL
ON
OFF
Θ
+
BLOWER ON OFF
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAIN A ON OFF
MAIN B
00
OFF
LCHRELEX FWRSVDC SPLY ON O
FWRORDSPLY ON
LCHR ELEX 28 VDC PWR SPLY
GYRDCLOCK PWRSPLY
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
CNVC OUTHTR CANISTER ON OFF
MOTCONT UNITAC ON OFF
6
5
OFF
OFF
3
4
OFF
6
MSL TWT FIL PWR SPLY
+
ON
OFF
5
4
O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT Θ O BLOWER OPR
LWR L MSL
OFF
OFF
Offe
1
ON
@ OFF
+
MSL PAFU/ITL PWR SPLY
+
ON
O O
O
O
+
OFF CONTINUED
2-1
2-156
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-11 .
POWER - DOWN - Continued -
12
Continued .
ON
CNVC OUT CANISTER HTR AC Θ ON
OFF
OFF
MOT CONT UNIT AC +
9
8
7
11
10
MSL GYRO/CLOCK PWR SPLY +
ON
MSL 5 VDC PWR SPLY +
+
+
ON
OFF
OFF
12
LCHR ELEX 28 VDC PWR SPLY
O O O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O BLOWER OFF
ORD PWR SPLY
O +
+
ON O
ON
OFF
OFF
16
LAUNG 15 ONCS AC,
OFF
OFF 10
(13): (12) 12.11
13
7
+
+
+
TWYARSLSPLY FIS FAR ON OFF
17
Q
16
O
17
BLOWER
MAIN A
ON
MSL PARUITI PARSPLY
OFF
OFF
+
OFF
O O
15
9
OFF
OFF
Θ
ON
OFF
Θ
ON
OFF MAIN B
O MISSILE HEATER AC UPH & ABSL UPRA ARSL
ON
14
LCHR ELEX 5 VDC PWR SPLY
14 ON OFF
+
ON
LAMPS +
ON OFF
OFF
OFF
TEST T
CONTINUED
2-157
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-11 .
13
POWER - DOWN- Continued
In the sequence
listed
below,
circuit breakers on
set the following
DLTM - PDU
A2A4 to OFF.
O O NK TERM MDL POWER DISTR
о
O
2
1
2
CNVC OUT ON DGTL PROCESSOR
0
ΘON
OFF
OFF
OFF
PWR SPLY ON
65 TEST OFF
e
3 OFF
O →
Ꮎ
OFF
OFF
4
3
+
CLK PWR ON
O
O
O
→
6
5
MAIN A ON
Θ
BLOWER ON
LAMPS
ON OFF TEST
OFF
14
OFF
OFF
At LEM - PCP A1A3, raise cover and set MAIN POWER - AC CB1 to OFF .
ge
MAIN POWER DC AC
RUN TIME →
M1
CB2
CB1
Ꮎ
→
CONTINUED
2-158
TM 9-1440-600-10
15
16
POWER - DOWN- Continued Open and latch Generator Set A6 control cubicle doors.
Shut-down Generator Set A6.
a.
On control cubicle , press CKT BRK switch to OPEN until CKT
CKT BRK CKT BRK CLOSE
BRK light goes off.
b.
Allow engine to run for 3 minutes with no load.
C.
Set START- RUN -STOP switch to
OPEN STOP . Engine will stop .
START
e
οι
2-11 .
о
O
ENGINE
®
FALAT INDICATOR
GENERATOR
O
RUN STOP
OCCONTROL BREAKER CIRCUIT PULLFOR EMERGENCYSTOP
CONTINUED
2-159
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-11 .
POWER - DOWN- Continued
NOTE
17
If the LS is to 20 below.
remain
powered-down ,
perform steps
17 thru
Close and secure both DLTM A2 doors. Lock left door with padlock .
B 8
18
..
18
Close and secure both LEM A1 doors.
19
Roll down and secure air inlet and air outlet covers on LEM A1 and DLTM A2.
20
Close Generator Set A6 control cubicle and air vent doors .
2-160
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-12 .
1
ENERGIZE LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE A1 Check that all controls are set as listed in para 2-9A.
ELECTRONICS
WHEN LAUNCHER
MODULE (LEM) POWER
DISTRIBUTION UNIT (PDU) A1A2 IS ENERGIZED , KEEP LEMPDU A1A2 DOOR CLOSED UNLESS MAINTENANCE IS BEING PERFORMED . CAUTION
2
On Power Control Panel ( PCP) A1A3, raise cover and set MAIN 021 to ON.
POWER - AC
MAIN POWER/ AC DC O
RUN TIME → O
→
CB1 O
M1
On Power Distribution Unit (PDU) A1A2, hold LAMPS switch to TEST.
O O O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O BLOWER OPR
Θ
BLOWER
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAINA
OFF
OFF
LCHRELEX PWR8VDCSPLY
O
OFF
ORD PWRSPLY ON OFF
CRIVE OUTHTR CANISTER
MOT CONT UNITAC
LCHA ELEX Z VOC FWRSPLY OFF
VOC MSL &SPLY PWR ON OFF MSI PARUSTU PWA SPLY
OFF
OFF
MAIN ON OFF MSL GYRO SPLY PWR CLOCK OFF MSLFE TWY PWRSPLY ON OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC UPALMSL LIPA A MISL ON OFF OFF
LAMPS
ON LWRLMSL ON OFF
LWRRMSL ON OFF
OFF TEST
LAMPS ON TEST O
3
CB2
9
Θ O
O
O
O
CONTINUED
2-161
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-12. 4
ENERGIZE LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE A1 - Continued
BLOWER OPR
Check that the two panel lights and BLOWER OPR Release switch .
light
come
on .
O
5
O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT
Set LAMPS switch to ON .
O BLOWER OPE
LAMPS
6
BLOWER
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAINA
OFF LOHRELEX VDC FARSPLY
LCHBELEX
MEL PAR &VOC SPLY
OFF
OFF
OFF
O
ON OFF TEST
Set BLOWER circuit breaker to ON.
CNVCOUTHTR CANISTER BLOWER ON
MISSILE HEATER AC UPB &MBL OFF
GYROCL
PAFUITL
MOTCONT UNITAC ON OFF
о
O
O
O
OFF
7
Check that BLOWER OPR light is on before continuing .
Data Link Terminal Module (DLTM ) A2 blower must be on before LEM power supplies are energized . If DLTM- PDU A2A4 is not
NOTE energized , perform steps 8 thru 12. If DLTM - PDU A2A4 is energized , go to step 13.
On DLTM-PDU A2A4, hold LAMPS switch to TEST.
0 9
O
LAMPS ON OFF TEST
O O O O O DATA LINK TERM MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT PROCESSOR MAINA ON C 3 OFF OFF BLOWER BLOWER O ON
O CNVC OUT ON C OFF
O
8
O
O
O O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
CONTINUED
2-162
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-12.
ENERGIZE LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE A1 - Continued
9❘ Check that the two panel lights and BLOWER OPRlight come on . Release switch .
BLOWER OPR 10
Set LAMPS switch to ON.
LAMPS O
ON OFF TEST
O O
Set BLOWER circuit breaker to ON.
OFF O
Ο
O
O
11
OFF LAMPS O TEST OFF
O
CNVC OUT ON
O O O O DATA LINK TERM MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT G PROCESSOR MAINA ON 20VDC OFF BLOWEROPE O
G O
O
O
O
O
BLOWER ON
OFF
12
Check that BLOWER OPRlight is on before continuing .
O O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT
O
BLOWER OPA
BLOWER OFF LCHRELEX PWRVDCSPLY ON OFF
CNVCOUT CAMSTERHTR OFF
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAIN ON OFF
OFF
MOT UNITCONT AC ON OFF
LCHRELEX 28VDC PWRSPLY
MEL&VDC PWR SPLY
OFF
OFF
PAFURTL SPLY PWR OFF
MAIN OFF
GYROCLOCK PWR SPLY ON OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC, UPRLMBL UPR R MEL ON OFF OFF LWR&MBL ON OFF
TWTFSPLY PWR ON OFF
LIN OFF LAMPS ON OFF TEST
O O
13
O
O
On LEM- PDU A1A2, set MAIN A and MAIN B circuit breakers to ON.
MAIN A ON Θ
OFF
MAIN B ON Θ OFF
CONTINUED
2-163
9-1440-600-10
TM
F
14
[
ENERGIZE LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE A - Continued
In the sequence listed below, set the following circuit breakers to CN .
1 LCHR ELEX 5 VDC PWR SPLY
+
3
2
+
ON
LCHR ELEX 28 VDC PWR SPLY
ORD PWR SPLY ON
+
O
O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT Θ
OBLOWER OPP
MSL 5 VDC PWR SPLY ON
ON
OFF
4
Θ
+
OFF
OFF
+ LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC MAIN A O ON OFF
BLOWER O ON OFF
MAIN B O ON OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC UPA MS ON OFF
OFF 1 ON OFF
5
2
→
4 ON OFF
5 ON OFF
7
8 ON OFF
Θ
MSL GYRO/CLOCK PWR SPLY
OFF
OFF
ON OFF
ON OFF
LAMPS TEST
ON
Q
+
3 ON OFF
6
9
TA
2-12.
2-*
O
O
O
O
OFF
6
8
7
MOT CONT UNIT AC ON
OFF
+
MSL PAFU/ITL PWR SPLY
+
+
ON
OFF
MSL TWT FIL PWR SPLY
+
ON
OFF
IF CANISTER HEAT IS REQUIRED :
9 CNVC OUT CANISTER HTR AC + ON
OFF J
2-164
2-1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-12
ENERGIZE LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE A1 - Continued
GUIDED MISSILES (GM) MUST NOT BE CONNECTED IF MISSILE HAZARD LIGHT IS ON AT A LIVE GM POSITION WITH
WARNING
ITS CABLE
CONNECTED .
ORDNANCE
DEVICES
MAY
EX-
PLODE RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
Omit step 15 if local BITE test is to be performed or if GMs should not be connected for any reason .
NOTE
15
On LCU Display Panel A1A14 , connect GMs . Raise cover and hold CONNECT-DISC switches to CONNECT at all positions except where MISSILE HAZARD lights are on , having live GMs with umbilicals connected , until corresponding MISSILE DISCONNECTED lights go off.
UPPER L
MISSILE LWR L UPPER R
LWR R
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT MISSILE HAZARD 00 00
0 | 0 |0 |0
Θ
RA
START
MISSILE DISCONNECTED
CNBC
DISC
CASC
CONNECT DISC
O
Ok
O
の
LAUNCHING sta
O
READY 이이 이이 RAISED ADAMUTH READY PLATFORM O MISSILE DISCOM NECTED 이이 이이
Ô . FIRING PLATOON
O BITE TEST STAPLTYST LAMP
16
o
POWER SUPPLIES ၁ ဝ YDC PLATFORMLIPPERL MISSILE MISSILE MAZAND C0000
O
BITE
PANEL LAMPY O O OFF
Check that LOCAL light is on .
CONNECT CONNECT
DISC
DISC
CONNECT CONNECT
DISC
DISC
LAUNCHERLOCAL RMT Ӧ
17
Check that the three PUS lights are on.
POWER SUPPLIES ООО +5 ±15 +28 VDC VDC VDC CONTINUED
2-165
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-12 .
ENERGIZE LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE A1- Continued
DLTM A2 MUST BE ENERGIZED AND TIME OF DAY CLOCK MUST BE COUNTING BEFORE MISSILE HEATER AC CIRCUIT BREAKERS ARE SET TO ON.
CAUTION
Omit step 18 if GM heat is not required .
NOTE ए
18
On LEM - PDU A1A2 , set MISSILE HEATER AC circuit breakers at live GM positions to ON if directed by engagement control station ( ECS).
O O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT MISSILE HEATER AC UPR R MSL UPR L MSL ON ON
BLOWER OPA
BLOWER ON
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAINA
MAIS
OFF
OFF
LCH20VDC ELEX FARSPLY
GYROCLOCK PWR SPLY
MISSILE HEATER AC UPR& MSL UPR MSU OFF
LCHR
OFF O
CNVC OUTHTR CANISTER
PAPUSTL
MOT CONT UNITAC
LWR L MSL Θ ON
OFF
OFF
2-166
O
Θ O
LWR R MSL ON Θ
LAMPS TEST
OFF
O
OFF
OFF
O
O
O
OFF
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-13 .
ENERGIZE DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2
1
Check that all controls are set as listed in para 2-9B.
2
On
Launcher
Electronics
Module
(LEM ) Power Control Panel (PCP) A1A3 , raise cover and set MAIN
MAIN POWER AC DC
RUN TIME
POWER - AC CB1 to ON. CB1
M1
CB2
→
3
On Data Link Terminal LAMPS switch to TEST .
Module
Power Distribution
0
O CNVC
O
OFF
hold
O O O O O O DATA LINK TERM MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT → → → PROCESSOR MAINA
O
OPP CLAONPAR
O BLOWEROPH
G
OFF ON ON BLOWER OFF TEST OFF
O
ON ค ) OFF TEST
O
LAMPS
Unit ( DLTM- PDU ) A2A4 ,
о
O
O
O
O
O
O
4
O
Check that the two panel lights and BLOWER OPR light come on .
O
BLOWER OPR O
5
Set LAMPS switch to ON .
6
Set BLOWER circuit breaker to ON. BLOWER ON
OFF
7
Check that BLOWER OPR light is on before continuing .
8
Set MAIN A circuit breaker to ON.
MAIN A ON
OFF
CONTINUED
2-167
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-13 .
9
ENERGIZE DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2 - Continued Set CLK PWR circuit breaker to ON .
CLK PWR ON 10
Check that 28 VDC light is on .
OFF 28 VDC
lo
10
OFF LAMPSON QOFF TEST
Ο
о O O DATA LINK TERM MOL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O DGTL PROCESSOR MAIN A 20VOC ค OFF OFF O.BLOWER OWER ON
O
O
O CNVC OUT ON
O
O O
NOTE
O
O
O
Tractor over-the-road power is not required for clock synchronization when CLK FWR circuit breaker is ON .
PWR SPLY ON
Set PWR SPLY circuit breaker to ON .
OFF
12
DGTL PROCESSOR ON
Set DGTL PROCESSOR circuit breaker to ON .
OFF
13
On DLT Power Supply A2A6 , check that all POWER SUPPLY FAULT lights are off.
POWER SUPPLY FAULT
O
O
Ο
Ο
O
PS1
PS2
PS3
PS4
PS5
NON -INTERRUPT
O
LAMP TEST
PS6
O
CONTINUED
2-168
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-14 .
ENERGIZE GENERATOR SET A6
GENERATOR SET A6 MAY BE DAMAGED IF SLAVE RECEPTACLE IS USED FOR ANY PURPOSE OTHER THAN SLAVE STARTING . REFER TO TM 5-6115-464-12 FOR GENERATOR SET A6 OPERATION BEYOND THAT COVERED IN THIS TM . CAUTION
Check that all controls are set as listed in para 2-9C.
2
On Generator Set A6, set START- RUN -STOP switch to RUN.
O
O
GENERATOR
ENGINE O
O
O
O ADCLEANED
FAULT· INDICATOR PRESS OVER
OOO
1
START
RUN ㅎ
09
PUTSLEVEL
STOP li
OPENTOR SINGLEURET
SPES
1.
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULLFOR EMERGENCYSTOP
Fuel transfer pump makes clicking sounds when transferring fuel into day fuel tank. Pump will stop when day fuel tank is full.
NOTES 2.
START- RUN-STOP switch must remain
in
RUN and
BATTLE-
SHORT switch must remain ON until day fuel tank is filled .
3
Raise safety guard and set SHORT switch to ON
BATTLE-
BATTLE SHORT ON
OFF BATTLE SHORT
CONTINUED
2-169
TM 9-1440-600-10 > 14.
4
ENERGIZE GENERATOR SET A6 - Continued
Check that LOW OIL PRESS, UNDER
VOLT, and UNDER FREQ lights are on.
FAULTINDICATOR GENERATOR
ENGINE
O LOW OIL PRESS
O
ㅎ
09
batan BATTLESHORS
O DCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULLFOR EMERGENCYSTOP
OPERATION
When day tank is full (about 2 minutes) , clicking sound stops . Set BATTLESHORT switch to
OFF.
ON
Lower
OFF BATTLE SHORT
safety guard .
6
UNDER FREQ
>))]
5
UNDER VOLT
Hold TEST or RESET switch down and check that all FAULT INDICATOR lights are on. Release switch .
TEST OR RESET
FAULT INDICATOR
LOW OIL PRESS
COOLANT HIGH TEMP
OVER SPEED
NO FUEL
SHORT CIRCUIT
OVER LOAD
UNDER VOLT
UNDER FREQ
REVERSE POWER
OVER VOLT
DO NOT CRANK ENGINE FOR MORE THAN 15 SECONDS AT A TIME . ALLOW STARTER TO COOL AT LEAST 3 MINUTES BETWEEN TRIES.
CAUTION
J
2-170
TM 9-1440-600-10
179TLAS- Continued
If outside temperature
is
50°F ( 10°C)
or below,
perform step
7. If temperature is above 50°F ( 10°C) , perform step 8 .
7
If temperature is 50°F ( 10°C) or below start Generator Set A6 with start aid procedure as follows.
a.
Press and hold STAFT PISTOL switch to
to crank engine . Do not
hold for more than 15 seconds.
FAULTINDICATOR O ENGINE
GENERATOR SPEED UNES
ENGINE PRIMER ON
START
3236
RUN
VOLANTTEMPATA ㅎ
STOP
お
O
O BATTLESCR STOP
b.
While engine is cranking , press Fi'
BATTLESHORT
OPEN
switch to
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER FULLFOR EMERGENCYSTOP
to inject ether,
then release switch .
C.
Release switch to RUN after 15 seconds or when engine starts . When engine starts, go to step 9 .
DO NOT INJECT ETHER MORE THAN THREE TIMES .
CAUTION
d.
If engine does not start within 15 seconds , release Allow starter to cool for 3 minutes.
switch .
2-171
F2
TI
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-
2-14 .
ENERGIZE GENERATOR SET A6 - Continued -
7
Continued .
[ Repeat steps a and b. If engine does not start after three tries, call Engineer Maintenance .
If temperature is over 50°F ( 10°C) , start engine normally.
a.
Press and hold START-RUN -STOP switch to START for 15 seconds or until OIL PRESSURE gage indicates oil pressure and VOLTS A.C. meter indicates voltage .
VOLT 120 PRESS OIL PRESSURE
FAULTINDICATOR
O
ENGINE
looo !.
GENERATOR O
START RUN
お
STOP OPERATION OPERATION O
b.
If engine fails to start within
BATTLESHOW
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT PULLBREAKER FORSTOP EMERGENCY
15 seconds, release START- RUN- STOP switch .
Allow at least 3 minutes for cranking motor to cool before trying to start again . C.
When engine starts , release START- RUN-STOP switch to RUN .
CONTINUED
2-1
2-172
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-14.
9
ENERGIZE GENERATOR SET A6 - Continued Check output voltage as follows:
FAULT INDICATOR O O
a.
”
GENERATOR O
Set VOLTS-AMPS switch to positions L1 - LO , L2- LO , and L3 - LO . VOLTS A.C. meter should in-
Lie
dicate 120 Vac red line in each
O
о 3
position .
09 BATTLE SHORT OPEN
b.
OPERATION
DCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER FULLFOR EMERGENCYSTOP
Set VOLTS- AMPS switch to positions L1 - L2 , L2- L3 , and L3- L1 . VOLTS A.C. meter should in-
L1 -LO L1
L3-L1-
A.C. VORTMETER
LLO2-.
dicate 208 Vac red line in each
LO3-
. -12 L1
position .
AMPS VOLTS
OTARBIA
INCREASE
D VOLTAGE ADJUST
If voltage in any position is wrong , set VOLTS -AMPS switch to that position and use VOLTAGE ADJUST rheostat to adjust to correct voltage . d.
If voltage had to be adjusted , repeat steps a and b to verify that all voltages are correct.
CONTINUED 1
2-173
TM 9-1440-600-10
- Continued
211
Check
10
400
frequency meter for
Hz indication . If necessary use rheostat to ad-
just frequency to 400 Hz.
FAULT· INDICATOR O
HE TZ
GENERATOR
ENGINE AIRCLEANER
O
INCREASE O
O
お
FORMLE
START
CONGLELMET OPERATES
ō FREQUENCY ADJUST DCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULLFOR EMERGENCY STOP
LIGHT COMES ON, STOP ENGINE IF ANY AND NOTIFY ENGINEER MAINTENANCE .
GENERATOR SET A6 MUST RUN AT LEAST 3 MINUTES TO WARM UP BEFORE CIRCUIT BREAKER IS CLOSED. CAUTION
Step 11 applies power to the LS.
11
After three hold
minutes engine warmup , until switch to light comes on . Release
CKT BRK CKT BRK CLOSE
switch .
OPEN
2-174
TM 9-1440-600-10
LAUNGERELECTRONICS MODULE A1
זי י
On LCU Display Panel A1A14 , check that ... switch is set to LO-
1
-LAUNCHERLOCAL- RMT
and LOCAL light is on.
2
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT BITE
VOX MISSILE 8 UPPER L LIPPER
PLATFORM -
HAZARD lights
are off at all positions where guided missile (GM ) cables are connected to live GMs.
POWER SUPPLIES O
LAUNCHERLOCAL
Check that MISSILE
HAZARD O
0
O
이이 이이 ・ READY PLATFO RAISED AZMUTH OOO DISCON NECTED 0 |0 | 0 | 0 LAUNCHING STA RAISE STOP CONNECT CONNECT CONNECT
MISSILE LWR L UPPER R
LWR R
O
MISSILE HAZARD 0000
O
O id
CITE TEST STATUS LAMPS STATUS LAMPTEST
O
Ø
FIRING LATOON •
10
の
START
UPPER L
O
0
BITE TEST OFF O STATUS LAMP TEST
3
Check that BITE TEST OFF STAL LAMP TES
switch is set to CFE.
PANEL LAMPS ON
4 OFF
Check that PANEL LAMPS switch is set to
F.
T
2-175
TM 9-1440-600-10 TN 2-15.
DEENERGIZE LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE A1 - Continued
2-1 5
Disconnect GMs as follows : Raise cover and
hold CONNECT- DISC
switches to
リ O
DISC at all positions until corresponding MISSILE DISCONNECTED lights go on.
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
-LAUNCHER. LOCAL
-PLATFORM
O POWER SUPPLIES O VOC VOC VOC MISSILE UPPERS LIPPER
O
O
の BITE
MISSILE DISCONNECTED 0000
MISSALE READY 0 | 0 | 0 | 0
O
LOHR PLATFORM READY RAISED AZMUTH READY
Θ
Θ
O
Of
O
O
DISCON MECTED10101010
ම
e
LAUNCHINGSTA
RAISE
CONNECT CONNECT
STOP
CONNECT CONNECT
O
DISC
START
0 Ø
DISC
DISC
DISC
O
DISC
ATOON
BITE TEST STATUSLAMPS PANEL LAMPS O DIM OFF STATUS LAMPTEST Ο 6
In the sequence listed below, set the following circuit breakers on Power Distribution Unit ( PDU ) A1A2 to OFF .
2
1
UPR L MSL ON
+
O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT Θ Θ OBLOWER OPR
UPR R MSL
→
ON
+
OFF
OFF
O BLOWER ON OFF
LCHRELEX VDC PWROPLY ON OFF CNVCOUTHTR CANISTER
4
3
LWR L MSL
LWR R MSL
ON
ON
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAIN A O ON OFF
LOHRELEX SPLY FWRVOC
MBL&VDC PWR SPLY
GYROCLOCK PWRSPLY
OFF
OFF
OFF
MOT CONT UNITAC ON
PAFURTL SPLY PWR
OFF
OFF
ON
FWB
LAMPS
+ O
OFF
2
MAIN
O
O
OFF
CONTINUED,
2-176 2-1
TM 9-1440-600-10
DEENERGIZE LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODNE A1 - Continued
6
Continued .
5
6
+
G
BLOWER OFF
ON 0
OFF
O
ON
+
O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O
O
+
MSL PAFU/ITL PWR SPLY
0
MSL TWT FIL PWR SPLY
→
< 15.
OFF
16
LAUNG 15 RONCS AC.
14
OFF
OFF
OFF
13:12)
11
10
MISSILE HEATER AC. UPRAMEL LIPA&MSI
9
OFF
OFF
LIVR & MSL
WARMSL
OFF
OFF
Θ OFF 7
8
+
ON
+
1 ON OFF
CNVC OUT CANISTER HTR AC Θ ON
6
5
17
O
MOT CONT UNIT AC
TEST
OFF
OFF
Θ
0
O O
OFF
10
MSL GYRO/CLOCK PWR SPLY
11
MSL 5 VDC PWR SPLY
+
ON
OFF
ON
15
+
ON
ORD PWR SPLY
+
ON
→
MAIN A
ON
+
+
LCHR ELEX 5 VDC PWR SPLY +
ON
OFF
17
LAMPS
BLOWER
+
ON
OFF
OFF
16
MAIN B
OFF
+
13
12
LCHR ELEX 28 VDC PWR SPLY
OFF
14
+
O
OFF
9
→
O
ON
+
ON OFF
OFF
OFF
TEST
2-177
TM 9-1440-600-10
TA
2-16 .
DEENERGIZ .
-
...
2-*
Omit step 1 if clock power is not required . [
NOTE
1
If Data Link Terminal Module ( DLTM) A2 clock synchronization is required :
a.
Position tractor close enough to semitrailer so outrigger electrical cable can be connected .
CURBSIDE
Le
ING WHEELS. TRACTOR MAY ROLL, RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
WAL
b.
DO NOT LEAVE TRACTOR UNATTENDED WITHOUT CHOCK-
Pull out tractor
control , place transmission range selector lever in neutral ( ) , and leave engine running .
b.1 .
Remove chock blocks from stowage chock tractor rear wheels as follows :
in tractor
roadside
stowage
box and
STOWAGE (1 )
If tractor is facing uphill , place chock blocks behind tractor rear wheels ,
both
curbside
CHOCK BOTH SIDES
and
roadside .
ROADSIDE
Change 1
J
2-178 2-1
TM 9-1440-600-10
- Continued
1
Continued .
(2)
CHOCK BOTH SIDES
If tractor is facing downhill , place chock blocks in front of rear wheels, both curbside and roadside .
ROADSIDE
ROADSIDE ONLY (3)
If tractor is level , place chock block in front of rear wheel on curbside and behind rear wheel on roadside .
CURBSIDE ONLY ROADSIDE
Through remainder of this procedure , chock blocks will be shown for tractor as in level position Chock as described in step b.1 .
above
unless grade
is shown.
CONTA
Change 1
D
2-178.1 /(2-178.2 blank)
F
TI
2-
[
2-
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-16.
DEENERGIZE DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2 - Continued
1
Continued .
Connect outrigger electrical cable to Semitrailer Connector 42W2P1 . (1 )
Remove
cable from
tractor
roadside stowage box. BATTERY
(1.1 )
(2)
Connect outrigger cable to tractor slave connector.
OUTRIGGER CABLE
BOX
Carefully route cable from tractor to semitrailer. Be careful not to get grease from fifth wheel on cable .
SLAVE CONNECTOR
CURBSIDE
(3)
Remove dust cover from Semitrailer Connector 42W2P1 .
(4)
Connect
cable to
Connector
42W2P1 by pushing straight in . (5)
Lower spring retainer to lock cable connector in place.
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-179
TM 9-1440-600-10 TN 216
— Continued
DEENERGIZE DATA LIJE TET
2-1 2
On Launcher Electronics Module Power Control Panel set MONE
( LEM - PCP) , A1A3 to
MAIN POWER/ DC AC
RUN TIME
[
CB1
M1
CB2
CIRCUIT BREAKERS ON LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT (LEM- PDU) A1A2 MUST BE SET TO OFF WHEN CLOCK IS NOT COUNTING OR GM HEATERS MAY BE DAMAGED .
CAUTION
3
On LEM Power Distribution Unit (PDU) O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT ©
A1A2 , set four circuit breakers to
BLOWER OPE ல்
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC MAIN O ON OFF
BLOWER ON OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC
MISSILE HEATER AC MAIN OFF
OFF
GYROCLOCK PWR SPLY ON OFF
ON OFF
୮
ON
+
LCHRVDCCLEX PWR SPLY ON OFF
UPR R MSL +
ON
+
OFF
Θ
CNVC OUTHTR CANISTER ON OFF
LCHAELEX
PWR SPLY
MSL 5 VDC PARSPLY
OFF
OFF
MOT CONT UNITAC ON
PAFUITL PWRSPLY ON OFF
O
UPR L MSL
LAMPS OFF
O O
O LWR L MSL +
ON
OFF
2-180 2-1
+
LWR R MSL
→
ON
OFF
+
TM 9-1440-600-10 - Continued
In the sequence listed below, set the following circuit breakers on DLTM Power Distribution Unit ( PDU) A2A4 to
о
O Ο
CNVC ON
OFF 3 OFF
→ O
อ
O
6 TEST 5 OFF Θ O
2
DGTL PROCESSOR + ON
O
2
O BLOWER OPR
O
1
O
0 O 0 NK TERM MDL POWER DISTRI
O
4
0
4
3
PWR SPLY ON O
+
CLK PWR ON
MAIN A ON +
ค OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
If LEM - PDU A1A2 is energized leave LOWER and LAMPS switch Main ac power will trip when DLTM blower goes
off if LEM - PDU A1A2 is energized .
6
5
BLOWER ON
LAMPS
ON OFF TEST
OFF
2-181
TM 9-1440-600-10 TA
F
2-17.
DEENERGIZE GENERATOR SET A6
2-* 1
On Launcher Electronics Module Pow-
Θ
er Control Panel (LEM- PCP) , A1A3 raise cover and set MAIN POWER
RUN TIME
MAIN POWER DC AC →
AC CB1 to OFF. M1
2
3
CB1
Θ
CB2 Θ
Open and latch Generator Set A6 control cubicle doors.
On Generator Set A6, hold CKT FRK switch to OPEN until CKT BEK light CKT BRK
goes off.
CKT BRK CLOSE
FAULT INDICATOR ENGINE
GENERATOR O OPEN
O DOPLAYTEMPERATU о ENORE
о
O OPERATION
O
JO
DCCONTROL BREAKER CIRCUIT PULLFOR EMERGENCYSTOP 4
Allow engine to run for 3 minutes with no load.
5 START
RUN
STOP
2-182 2-11
Set
START- STOP RUN switch to
STOP. Engine will stop.
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-18.
LCU DISPLAY PANEL A1A14 SEMIAUTOMATIC BITE TEST
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT 18
BITE
POWER SUPPLIES O
D E MISSILE PLATFORMUPPERL LIPPERR MISSILE HAZARO
LAUNCHER LOCAL
O
RAISE
STOP
CONNECT CONNE DISC GRISC ODO
O
START
O CONNECT
O
LAUNCHINGSTA
O
0
O
MISSILE READY 0000 LCHR PLATFORM READY READY RAISED AZMUTH DISCON NECTED 0 |0 |0 |0
FIRINGPLATOON
0
BITE TEST STATUSLAMPS OFF O O DIM STATUS LAMPTEST
O OFF
0 LCU DISPLAY PANEL A1A14
1.
During this test MISSILE status lights will cycle on and off. The blinking is normal . It does not indicate that a missile is selected or that a hazard exists . Critical functions are kept safe during the test.
NOTES 2.
During the test you will hear a noise like a horn blowing . The noise is Motor Control Unit testing . The noise is normal .
3.
( MCU) A9 cycling on and off for
Ifthe test fails , call Organizational Maintenance .
1
Energize Data Link Terminal Module ( DLTM) A2 per para 2-13.
2
Energize Launcher Electronics Module ( LEM ) A1 per para 2-12.
CONTINUED
2-183
T
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-18.
LCU DISPLAY PANEL A1A14 SEMIAUTOMATIC BITE TEST- Continued
2-
3
On
LCU
and hold
Display
Panel
disconnect guided
A1A14 ,
CONNECT- DISC switches to
(GMs) .
missiles
Raise cover
DISC at all positions until corresponding
MISSILE DISCONNECTED lights come on .
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT MISSILE DISCONNECTED
BITE
POWER SUPPLIES
MISSILE LOVERL UPPER
PLATFORM
O
O
AUNCHER LOCAL
O
O
0 | 0 | 01 |0
READY PLATFORM READY ööö
CONNECT CONNECT
O
CONNECT CONNECT
=0 | 0 | 0 | 0
o 0101010
DISC
DISC
DISC
DISC
LAUNCHING STA
O
STOP 00 : LOO START O
O
PRINGPLATOOR
Q
O
O
tol
O
RIFETEST STATUE STATUS LANDTEST
4
BITE
Check that all five BITElights are off. O
5
Set BITE TEST-OFF- STATUS
O D
O E
LAMP
TEST switch to STATUS LAMP TEST. Check that all BITElights are on .
6
O C
BITE TEST OFF STATUS LAMP TEST
Set switch to BITE TEST, BITElights cycle on and off for 6 seconds . If all lights are on , test passed .
7
2-184
Change 1
T
2-1
Set switch to OFF.
>
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-18.
8
LCU DISPLAY PANEL A1A14 SEMIAUTOMATIC BITE TEST- Continued
On CCIP A2A2,
check
SUMMARY FAULTlight . If light is on , momentarily hold
RESET switch to RESET SUMMARY FAULTlight will go off.
FAU SUMMARY FAULT
PROPAGATION DELAY REQUEST
FAIRY
PROCESSORCONTROL
9
RADIO OSC CAL-
RESET
THECONTROL
If GMs are to be electrically connected , proceed as follows:
IF ANY
MISSILE HAZARD LIGHT IS ON, VISUALLY CHECK
THAT POSITION. IF THAT POSITION HAS A LIVE MISSILE
Lac
WITH UMBILICAL CONNECTED, NOTIFY ECS IMMEDIATELY. ADVISE ECS THAT LS WILL REMAIN IN LOCAL MODE . AF-
WARNING TER NOTIFYING ECS, LEAVE AREA AND AWAIT FURTHER MAY EXPLODE ,
INSTRUCTIONS . ORDNANCE DEVICES RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-184.1
T
TM 9-1440-600-10
2. 2-18 .
LCU DISPLAY PANEL A1A14 SEMIAUTOMATIC BITE TEST - Continued —
9
a.
Continued .
On LCU display panel A1A14, verify that all MISSILE HAZARD lights are off at all missile positions that have a live missile with umbilical connected .
UPPER L
Ø
MISSILE HAZARD C0000
POWER SUPPLIES VOC MISSILE UPPERL UPPER 0000
O
MISSILE READY LCHR PLATFORM 이이 이이 READY RAISED AZMUTH READY OOO 이이 이이 → LAUNCHING STA RAISE STOP
O
LAUNCHER- PLATFORMLOCAL
LWR R
O
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT BITE
MISSILE LWR L UPPER R
MISSILE DISCONNECTED
Θ 0 | 0 |0 | 0
O
Θ
O START
O
の
FIRINGPLATOON
CONNECT CONNECT
STATUSLAMPS FANEL LAMPS
2-184.2
DISC
DISC
DISC
b.
Raise cover over CONNECT - DISC switches .
C.
Hold CONNECT- DISC switches to CONNECT until corresponding MISSILE DISCONNECTED lights go off.
2-1
DISC O
10
OFF
O
O
STATUS LAMPTEST
CONNECT CONNECT
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-19 .
1
ELECTRICALLY RAISE LAUNCHER PLATFORM
Remove roadside and curbside travel lockpins .
a.
Press and hold lockpin pushbutton .
ROADSIDE
TYPICAL BOTH SIDES
b.
Pull lockpin out of steadyrest .
C.
Install lockpin in stowage bracket .
ALL FOUR OUTRIGGERS MUST HAVE FIRM CONTACT WITH Le WARNING
GROUND WHEN
LAUNCHING
STATION
(LS)
IS
LEVELED .
OTHERWISE LS MAY TILT, RESULTING IN SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH .
CONTINUED
2-185
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-19.
2
ELECTRICALLY RAISE LAUNCHER PLATFORM - Continued
Verify that all four outriggers are down and LS is level .
a.
Check that all four outriggers are down and in firm contact with ground.
OUTRIGGERS FROM
CURBSIDE
b.
Check leveling device in outrigger control panel . Insure LS is within 5° of level . Each ring is 1 °.
TO PREVENT TWISTING SEMITRAILER FRAME, DO NOT OPERATE DIAGONAL PAIRS OF OUTRIGGERS AT SAME TIME .
CAUTION
C.
If necessary use OUTRIGGER switches to level LS within 5°.
CONTINUED
2-186
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-19 .
ELECTRICALLY RAISE LAUNCHER PLATFORM - Continued
Antenna mast does not have to be mated if data link with enNOTE
3
gagement control station (ECS) is not needed .
Check that data link mast sections are mated.
LOWER MAST
ROADSIDE
5A7A12W1
UPPER MAST
ன்
Check that upper mast is inserted into lower mast. Locator pin on lower mast is in locator hole in upper mast flange .
LOCATOR PIN
5A7A12W2
Upper
flange is seated firmly lower mast flange.
mast
against
b.
Check that grounding cable A7A12W2 is connected to grounding connector A7A11J2 on upper mast flange.
C.
Check that RF Cable A7A12W1P2 is connected to RF Adapter A7A11J1 .
CONTINUED
2-187
TM 9-1440-600-10
TI
2-19 .
ELECTRICALLY RAISE LAUNCHER PLATFORM - Continued
2-
4
Verify that manual BRAKE on each , curbside and roadside , elevation is set to LOCK,
drive motor
[
BRAKE
oct
O TYPICAL BOTH SIDES ROADSIDE
5
Set engagement control handle to ELEV
ROADSIDE
B ELEV
ROTATE
ROADMARCH
CONTINUED
2-188 2-1
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-19 .
ELECTRICALLY RAISE LAUNCHER PLATFORM - Continued
DO NOT OPERATE ELEVATION ACTUATORS FOUR CYCLES IN 1
MORE THAN
HOUR . ONE CYCLE IS: FULL EXTEN-
SION ; 3-MINUTE WAIT; FULL RETRACTION . WAIT AT LEAST 3 MINUTES BETWEEN CYCLES.
CAUTION
Launcher platform may be stopped at any position between limits
NOTE
by setting RAISE - STOP - LWR switch to STOP.
On LCU Display Panel A1A14, set RAISE - STOP- LWR switch to RAISE . Hold START switch up momentarily.
Platform will raise to launch angle and stop . RAISED light will come on when platform is at launch angle .
PLATFORM
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT BITE
0000 O
LCHR PLATFORM READY READY RAISED AIMUTH O O
O
RAISE STOP
O VOC MISSILE UPPER UPPERR HAZAM 0000
LAUNCHER·LOCAL
O
POWER SUPPLIES
D PLATFORM-
O
PLATFORM RAISED
0101010 RAISE
STOP
O
の
LAUNCHINGSTA
O
LWR
о
e
START
DISC ODO
O
START 0 FIRINGPLATOON
a
STATUSLAMPS NORMAL PAREL LAMPS OFF D
O
оо
INTE TEST STATUS LAMPTEST
O
6
O
e
2-189
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-20 .
1
ELECTRICALLY LOWER LAUNCHER PLATFORM
Electrically rotate turntable to 180° position per para 2-22.
MISSILE IS FREE TO MOVE IN CANISTER IF TORQUE TUBE HANDLE IS NOT PROPERLY LOCKED . SUDDEN STOPS ON
WARNING
ROAD
MARCH
COULD
CAUSE
MISSILE TO
PENETRATE
TRACTOR CAB , RESULTING IN SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH.
2
Lock guided missile
(GM ) torque tube
handle on each canister in the following
order: upper right ( UR) ; lower right ( LR) ; upper left ( UL) ; lower left ( LL).
Have a crewmember at LCU Display Panel A1A14 check MBOLE
NOTE
a.
Remove
READY lights when (GM) torque tube handle is locked .
quick - release
torque tube handle. hold
22
springloaded
LATCHDONOT OR G UNLESSUNLATON ELEVATED
CK
Pull out and
plunger. Rotate torque tube handle cw to LOCK position .
C.
Release
plunger .
O
UNLO
b.
O о DESSICANT HOLDER
pin by
RELIEFVALVE PUSHTO RELEASE O
о O DESSICANTHOLDER
Check that
O RECORDS
plunger seats in left detent hole DO NOT UNLATOM UNLESS ELEVATEDGM LOCK
to secure torque tube handle .
MELY VALVE PUSH RELEASEFO PRESSURE O O
d.
Check that no red paint shows to left of torque tube handle.
e.
Insert quick- release pin in hole to right of torque tube handle.
f.
A4 Check with crewmember at LCU Display Panel A1A14 that MISSILE REALY lamp at correct GM position went out.
CONPAGED
2-190
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10 ELECTRICALLY LOWER LAUNCHER PLATFORM- Continued
2-20.
-
Continued.
2
g.
3
Repeat steps (LL) GMs.
On LCU off.
a thru
f for lower right (LR ) ,
Display Panel A1A14,
upper
left
( UL)
check that all four MISSILE
and
lower left
READY lights
are
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT BITE
POWER SUPPLIES
Oli
LAUNCHERLOCAL
MISSILE READY
O
O
MISSILE LOPPER& UPPERA
PLATFORM-
0
| 0
| 0
| 0
READY
PLATFORM Ol
이이 이이
0101010 e
CHENG STA
10!
STOP
START
a O
4
BUTE TEGY STATUSLAMPS STATUS LAMPTEST
O
O
•
Verify that manual BRAKE on each , curbside and roadside , elevation drive motor is set to LOCK.
BRAKE
TYPICAL BOTH SIDES
ROADSIDE
CONTINUED
2-191
TM 9-1440-600-10
2.
2-20 .
ல்
T
5
ELECTRICALLY LOWER LAUNCHER PLATFORM - Continued
Set engagement control handle to ELEV.
[
ROADSIDE
ELEV
ROTATE
ROADMARCH
On LCU Display Panel A1A14, check that AZIMUTH READY light is off.
0
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
AZIMUTH READY
BITE
PLATFORM
Ο
O
-LAUNCHERLOCAL
POWER SUPPLIES OOO MISSILE UPPER& UPPERR
O
6
0 |0 |0 |0 O
PLATFORM AZMUTH ööö
0101010 STOP
O
101
LAURICHINGSTA
START O
e
. PLATOON
2
STATUS ©
O!
O
STATUS LAMPTEST
оо
CONTINUED
2-1
2-192
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-20 .
ELECTRICALLY LOWER LAUNCHER PLATFORM - Continued
DO NOT OPERATE
ELEVATION ACTUATORS MORE THAN
FOUR CYCLES IN 1
HOUR . ONE CYCLE IS : FULL EXTEN-
SION; 3- MINUTE WAIT; FULL RETRACTION . WAIT AT LEAST 3 MINUTES BETWEEN CYCLES .
CAUTIONS
MAKE
SURE
THAT
GUARD
RAIL IS
NOT
INSTALLED
AROUND GENERATOR SET BEFORE LOWERING LAUNCHER PLATFORM OR EQUIPMENT DAMAGE MAY OCCUR .
Launcher platform may be stopped at any position between limits by setting RAISE - STOP-LWR switch to STOP.
NOTE
On LCU Display Panel A1A14 , set RAISE - STOP - LWR switch to LWR.
10
7
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT BITE
POWER SUPPLIES
Hold START switch up momentarily . LAUNCHERLOCAL
PLATFORM-
O
O
Platform will lower to steadyrest and
VDC MISSILE UPPERL UPPERR
stop .
O
RAISE
# 0000
e
STOP
READY 0000 LCH PLATFORM RAISED AZMUTH READY MADY
LAUNCHING STA
BAISE
STOP
START
LWR
O
e
START
RINGPLATOON
O
STATUSLAMPS NORMAL FANELLAMPS DMM
O
O
STATUS LAMPTEST
8
PLATFORM RAISED light will go off when lowering begins .
9
Set RAISE - STOP - LWR STOP.
switch to
PLATFORM RAISED
O
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-193
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-20 .
10
ELECTRICALLY LOWER LAUNCHER PLATFORM - Continued
Set
engagement
control
handle to ROTATE
performed .
ELEV
ROAD MARCH if road march is to be
ROADMARCH
11
If launcher platform is to remain lowered , remove travel lockpins from bracket and install in roadside and curbside steadyrest.
ROADSIDE
TYPICAL BOTH SIDES
2-194
stowage
TM 9-1440-600-10
ELEVATION HANDCRANK OPERATIONS
2-21 .
Handcrank operations are to be used when electrical drive is inoperative or when positioning platform for maintenance.
On LCU Display Panel A1A14 , check that RAISE-STOP - LWR switch is set
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT POWER SUPPLIES
to STOP.
O
C PLATFORM
MISSILE GOVER UPPERR
O
о
Ø
HAZARD
RAISE
MISSALLE READY 0 | 0 |0 |0 O
STOP
READY PLATFORM AZMUTH READY ölöö
NECTED 0101010 LAUNCHING STA
STOP
LWR
0
1.1
BLOWER OPE ㅎㅇ
DITETEST STATUR LAMPS O STATUM LAMPTEST
O
оо
O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O
O
START
10
• " RINGPLATOON
BLOWER
O
00 LAUNCHER-
O
BITE
O
1
On LEM - PDU A1A2 , set MOT CONT UNIT AC circuit breaker to OFF .
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC. MAIN A
MISSILE HEATER AC ON ON
MAIN S
ཌ་ OFF
LOANELEX
CVC OUT APMETERHT
TWY
PAFURTL FARSPLY
MOT CONT UNIT AC Ꮎ
MOTCONT UNITAC ON OFF
GYRO-CLOCK PWRSPLY O
OFF
ON Ꮳ
O
O
O
OFF
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-195
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-21 . 2
ELEVATION HANDCRANK OPERATIONS
Continued
Remove roadside and curbside travel lockpins .
a.
Press and hold lockpin pushbutton .
ROADSIDE
TYPICAL BOTH SIDES
3
b.
Pull lockpin out of steadyrest .
C.
Install lockpin in stowage bracket.
Set engagement control handle to ELEV
ROADSIDE
ELEV
ROTATE
ROADMARCH
CONTINUED
2-196
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-21 .
ELEVATION HANDCRANK OPERATIONS - Continued
4
Remove access
covers from
curbside
and
roadside
elevation
actuators
manual
crank extensions.
a.
Loosen three captive screws that secure each access cover.
b.
Remove cover from each manual crank extension .
C.
Check that handcrank safety switch plunger is extended on both actuators .
TYPICAL BOTH SIDES
HANDCRANK SAFETY SWITCH PLUNGER
ROADSIDE
1
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-196.1 /(2-196.2 blank)
TI
2-
[
2-
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-21 .
5
ELEVATION HANDCRANK OPERATIONS - Continued
On each elevation drive motor , set manual BRAKE to RELEASE .
BRAKE
TYPICAL BOTH SIDES
ROADSIDE
TO PREVENT INJURY, VERIFY THAT MOT CONT UNIT AC CIRCUIT BREAKER IS SET TO OFF AND BOTH ELEVATION La
>
WARNING
ACTUATOR MANUAL CRANK EXTENSION COVERS ARE REMOVED BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO INSTALL ELEVATION ACTUATOR HANDCRANKS .
6
Install handcrank on each elevation actuator manual crank extension .
a.
Get two
handcranks
from
roadside stowage box. b.
Aline handcrank with keyway on extension .
C.
Install handcrank on elevation actuator manual crank extension .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-197
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-21 .
7
ELEVATION HANDCRANK OPERATIONS- Continued
Raise or lower platform .
Use one crewmember on each handcrank.
NOTE
a.
Observe
directional
arrows on
each manual crank extension . b.
Each crewmember rotate
hand-
crank at same speed to raise or lower platform to desired position .
8
Set manual
BRAKE on
each
drive
motor to LOCK.
BRAKE
TYPICAL BOTH SIDES
9
Remove handcrank from curbside and roadside manual crank extensions .
10
Install access cover on each manual crank extension . Tighten screws on each cover.
3 captive
TYPICAL 2 PLACES
CONTINUED
2-198
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-21 .
11
ELEVATION HANDCRANK OPERATIONS - Continued
Verify that manual BRAKE drive motor is set to LOCK
on
each
BRAKE
TYPICAL BOTH SIDES
O O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT Θ C LOWER
12
On LEM - PDU A1A2, set MOT CONT UNIT AC circuit breaker to ON
9
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAI A
MAINB
MISSILE HEATER AC, UPALAS UPRA MOL ON O
• རྞ་ ELEX
OUT
MOTCONT UNITAC
O
BASISVOC PAR SPLY
GYROCLOCK
PAPURTL TEST
MOT CONT UNIT AC → ON →
O
OFF
[ ]
13
Stow both handcranks in roadside stowage box.
Change 1
2-198.1 /(2-198.2 blank)
L 2
2
TM 9-1440-600-10
On LCU Display Panel A1A14 , check that PLATFORM RAISED light is on.
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT BITE
If off,
O
1
ELECTRICALLY ROTATE LAUNCHER MECHANICS
POWER SUPPLIES
raise platform to launch angle
O
per para 2-19.
LAUNCHER-
O
2-22.
MISSILE UPPER UPPERR
PLATFORM
O
RAMED AZMUTH READY PLATPORN OO
PLATFORM RAISED
0101010 O
0101010 LAURICHINGSTA 2
STOP O
101
START
O
e STATUSLAMPS O
оо
O STATUS LAMPTEST
e Omit step 2 if guided missiles (GMs) are not to be unlocked . NOTE
2
Unlock
GM torque tube
handle on
each canister in the following order:
о DESSICANT HOLDER
upper right ( UR) ; lower right ( LR) ; up-
RECORDS
per left (UL); lower left (LL).
J2
b.
Remove quick- release pin by GM torque tube handle .
Pull out and
hold
DONOT LATON OR UNLATCH UNLESS OM ELEVATED
UNLOCK
a.
RELIEF VALVE PUSH TO RELEASE PRESSURE
spring-loaded
plunger. Rotate torque tube handle ccw to UNLOCK position .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-199
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-22 .
ELECTRICALLY ROTATE LAUNCHER MECHANICS - Continued -
Continued .
C.
Release
2
plunger .
O O DESSICANT HOLDER
Check that
о RECORDS
plunger seats in right detent hole to secure torque tube handle.
LOCK
OCK
DO NOT LATCH OR UNLATCH UNLESS GM ELEVATED
Check that red paint shows to left of torque tube handle .
UNL
d.
J2
PULL
e.
Insert quick- release pin in hole to left of torque tube handle .
f.
Repeat steps a thru e above for lower right (LR) ,
RELIEF VALVE PUSH TO RELEASE PRESSURE
upper left (UL) and lower
left ( LL) GMs.
3
Set engagement control handle to ROTATE.
MD WoolnỤ teinso
S
ross
don neqqu U) ttel neq
ROTATE
-
ELEV
ROADMARCH
ROADSIDE
CONTINUED
2-200
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-22 .
4
ELECTRICALLY ROTATE LAUNCHER MECHANICS - Continued On LCU Display Panel A1A14 , check
O
that AZIMUTH READY light is on .
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
BITE
POWER SUPPLIES
PLATFORM
MISSILE UPPERL UPPER
O
AZIMUTH READY
O
AUNCHER. LOCAL
= 0 | 0 |0 |0
O
PLATFORM RAISED AZMUTH öö
이이 이이
or CW as required to rotate turntable to desired position .
RAISE
STOP
O
Hold CCW-STOP - CW switch to CCW · " PLATOON
L START O
e
5
LAURICHING STA
კი
ჰიი
O
W
JO
e
STOP C
Fol
оо
NORMAL PAREL LAMPS BITE TEST STATUSLAMP OFF STATUS LAMPTEST
C W
6
Release CCW - STOP- CW switch to stop platform rotation .
7
Turntable is at the 180° position when the 180° position pointer is alined between the alinement strip gage marks .
∞
∞
100 TOM DA TIMU
2-201
TM 9-1440-600-10 TI
22-23.
AZIMUTH MANUAL OPERATIONS
Azimuth [
manual
operations
are to be used when
electrical
drive is inoperative or
when positioning turntable for maintenance .
1
On LCU Display Panel A1A14, check that PLATFORM If off,
RAISED light is on .
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
raise platform to launch angle
@ POWER SUPPLIES
BITE
O
per para 2-19.
PLATFORM
MISSILE
LOCAL O
O PLATFORM ATMOUTH READY = 0 | 0 | 0 | 0
о 0101010 이
e
LAUNCHING STA O
PLATFORM RAISED
O
e
PUNGPLATOON
10
O
Foll
HITE TEST STATUS LAN LANDSTATUOTEET
% 10
O
10 10 START
O
•
о
1.1
კიი
STOP Check that CCW- STOP - CW switch is set to STOP .
O
O O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT 0 G
BLOWER OFR
1.2
BLOWER ON OFF 0
LCHRELEX PWR·VDCSPLY
о
CRIVE OUTHTR CANISTER
OIFF
c W
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC MAIN & ON OFF
OIFF
LCHRELEX 20 VDC PWR SPLY ON OFF
MOT CONT UNITAC
On LEM - PDU A1A2 , set MOT CONT UNIT AC circuit breaker to
MAIN 8 OFF . OFF
MSHS VOC PWR SPLY ON OFF
GYROCLOCK PWR SPLY
MS PAFUTTL PWR SPLY ON OFF
TWITARSLSPLY FR PWR
OFF
OFF
OFF
MOT CONT UNIT AC ON
+
TEST
OFF
→
Θ
OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC
O
O
OFF O
O
O
CONTINUED
2-
2-202
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-23.
2
AZIMUTH MANUAL OPERATIONS - Continued
Set engagement control handle to ROTATE.
ELEV
ROTATE
ROADMARCH
ROADSIDE
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-202.1 /(2-202.2 blank)
T
2-
[
2-
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-23.
AZIMUTH MANUAL OPERATIONS - Continued
TO PREVENT INJURY, VERIFY THAT MOT CONT UNIT AC Le WARNING
CIRCUIT BREAKER IS SET TO OFF AND BOTH AZIMUTH ACTUATOR MANUAL CRANK EXTENSION COVERS ARE REMOVED BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO INSTALL AZIMUTH ACTUATOR HANDCRANKS .
INSURE THAT PLATFORM IS ELEVATED TO LAUNCH ANGLE BEFORE ROTATING LS TURNTABLE OR LS WILL BE DAMAGED .
CAUTION
NOTE
CW manual drive rotation causes turntable to turn ccw. CCW rotation causes turntable to turn cw.
3
Install 1 /2-inch drive brace handle (speed handle) in manual drive on azimuth actuator.
ROADSIDE
4
Observe directional arrow on azimuth actuator. Rotate speed handle cw or ccw to position turntable at desired azimuth position .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-203
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-23.
AZIMUTH MANUAL OPERATIONS- Continued
Speed handle should be removed from azimuth actuator before using electrical drive.
NOTE
5
When manual azimuth operations are completed , remove speed handle from azimuth actuator.
O
O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O BLOWER OPE
O
O
→
0
6
On LEM - PDU A1A2 , set MOT CONT UNIT AC circuit breaker to ON.
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC MAIN A
MAIN
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
LORS VOCFLEX PAR SPLY
LCH ELEX PWR SPLY
GYROCLOCK FWR SPLY ON OFF
OFF
BLOWER
O
ASH 5 VDC OFF
CRVC OUTH CAMSTER
MOT UNITCONT AC
PAFUSTL SPLY PWR ON
OFF
OFF
OFF
MOT CONT UNIT AC → ON
LAMPS →
OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC י LIPA A ARSI
OFF
OFF O O
2-204
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-24.
DATA LINK TERMINAL TURN ON
Use this procedure when the data link terminal complete shutdown .
( DLT) is to be turned on from
a
POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT A2A4
88
18
RADIO FREQUENCY TUNER A2A5
KEY GENERATOR KG-30 A2A1
COMPUTER-TO-COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE PROCESSOR A2A2
DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2
Personnel Required . Two Tools and Equipment Required . Screwdriver, Flat Tip , 1 /4- In .
Ignore all light emitting diode ( LED) cedure .
NOTE
At Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5 , rotate MANUAL control fully counterclockwise .
OJ
1
indicators during this pro-
FORWARDPOWER REVERSEPOWER
POWERCONTROL
POWER CONTROL
TEST
AUTO
Θ PRIDO
MANUAL
MODE
AUTO
0.DELAY TUNE
CONTINUED
2-205
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-24.
2
DATA LINK TERMINAL TURN ON - Continued
At Computer-To-Communications Interface Processor (CCIP) A2A2 set following switches to OFF: LOAD NET, OPERATE, ALTERNATE MASTER and AUTO SYNC.
AUTO SYNC
OLY TEST PROCESSORCONTROL-
ALTERNATE MASTER
DELAYREQUEST MODE CISC CAL 8 88 89 AUTO SYNC TIME CONTROL
O OFF
RADNO O
OFF
TIME CONTROL LOAD NET OPERATE ด OFF
3
OFF
Set PROCESSOR CONTROL switch to NORM.
PROCESSOR CONTROL DLTN
TRBY NORM
KGBY
DLT TEST 4 TEST
Set DLT TEST switch to TEST.
NORMAL
BLOWER CPR LAMP ON POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT (PDU) A2A4 MUST BE ON BEFORE ANY OTHER CIRCUIT BREAK-
CAUTION
ERS ARE TURNED
ON .
CONTINUED
OPERATION
WITHOUT PROPER
AIR
FLOW WILL
RESULT IN
OF DLT DAMAGE
TO DLT SUBASSEMBLIES .
CONTINUED
2-206
TM 9-1440-600-10
DATA LINK TERMINAL TURN ON - Continued
2-24.
TIME OF DAY indicator on CCIP A2A2 indicates 377 until 28 vdc power is on. NOTE
5
Energize Data Link Terminal Module ( DLTM ) A2 per para 2-13.
6
At Key Generator KG 30 A2A1 , loosen 16 captive screws and open panel .
7
Set POWER switch to OFF. Initialize Key Generator KG -30 A2A1 . Refer to manual KAO- 137E/TSEC .
7.1
Close panel and secure with 16 captive screws .
XMTR ALMLYOFFON ALMLY BOTH OFF BOTHON
WARNING
POWER
WARNING RCVR POWER
0
O
0 PUSH TO ZERO
PUSH TO ZERO
ON
OFF
8
Wait approximately 30 minutes for proper warm up of master oscillator in CCIP A2A2.
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-207
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-24.
9
DATA LINK TERMINAL TURN ON - Continued At CCIP A2A2 , set DLT TEST switch to NORMAL.
DLT TEST
PROPAGATION
S TEST PROCESSORCONTROL-
AUTOSYNC 8 TM 98 CONTROL99
RADD O NORMAL
w ne
2-208
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-25 .
DATA LINK TERMINAL QUICK START
Use this procedure when data link terminal (DLT) is to be turned on after fault isolation .
RADIO FREQUENCY TUNER A2A5
8
18
00
000
KEY GENERATOR KG-30 A2A1
COMPUTER-TO- COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE PROCESSOR A2A2
DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2
Personnel Required . Two Tools and Equipment Required . Screwdriver, Flat Tip , 1 /4- In .
1
At Computer-To- Communications Interface Processor (CCIP) A2A2 , set OPERATE switch to OFF .
TIME CONTROL LOAD NET OPERATE
PROCESSORCONTROL
ร OFF
OFF
DELAYREQUES
TEST MODE OSC CAL
AUTOSYNC TIME CONTROL
RADIO 5.
S
2
Energize Data Link Terminal Module ( DLTM) A2 per para 2-13 .
CONTINUED
2-209
T
TM 9-1440-600-10
2
2-25 . 3
DATA LINK TERMINAL QUICK START - Continued At Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5 , rotate MANUAL control fully counterclockwise .
[
POWERCONTROL MANUAL AUTO
POWER CONTROL
MANUAL
MODE
AUTO DELAY
-O
4
Set MODE switch to MANUAL .
5
At CCIP A2A2, set DLT TEST switch to TEST.
DLT TEST DELAYREQUEST TEST
AUTOSYNC
BADO D
NORMAL
10 TE 00 CONTROL00
6
Set
DAY,
HOUR
and
MIN
switches
to any convenient net start time.
DAY
TIME SET HOUR
MIN
88888
-TIME CONTROL LOAD NET OPERATE 7
Set LOAD NET- OFF switch to LOAD NET and then to OFF. OFF
( ) 3 OFF
CONTINUED
2-
2-210
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-25.
DATA LINK TERMINAL QUICK START - Continued
8
At Key Generator KG -30 A2A1 , loosen 16 captive screws and open panel .
9
Set POWER switch to OFF . Initialize Key Generator KG -30 . ( Refer to manual KAO137E/TSEC . )
10 XMTR ALMLTON
S 10 ° POWER
WARNING
WARNING
RCVR 10
10
10 10
10 10
PUSH TO ZERO
O
PUSH TO ZERO
ON
OFF
10
Close panel and secure with 16 captive screws.
CONTINUED
2-211
T
TM 9-1440-600-10
2 2-25 .
11
DATA LINK TERMINAL QUICK START - Continued
At CCIP A2A2 , set OPERATE -OFF switch to OPERATE . Wait 45 seconds.
PROPAGATION DELAYREQUEST
DLT TEST
OPERATE PROCESSORCONTRO
OSCCAL 888 88 AUTOSYNC CONTROL
5.
OFF
w
12
At Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5, set MODE switch to AUTO .
-POWERCONTROL MANUAL MODE AUTO
POWER CONTROL
MANUAL
MODE
AUTO
FREO
0-DELAY TUNE
13
Observe that AUTO LED is on .
14
At CCIP A2A2, hold RESET switch to RESET momentarily then release switch .
PROPAGATION DELAYREQUEST
YEST
RESET PROCESSORCONTROL
2-
2-212
MODE OSCCAL 8 88 89 AUTOSYRK CONTROL
RADIO O
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-26 .
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING
Use this procedure to adjust the data link terminal (DLT) to the correct operating frequency.
RADIO FREQUENCY TUNER A2A5
88
KEY GENERATOR KG-30 A2A1 RECEIVER -TRANSMITTER A2A3 COMPUTER-TO-COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE PROCESSOR A2A2
DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2
Personnel Required . Two Tools and Equipment Required . Screwdriver, Flat Tip , 1 /4-In .
1.
This procedure is critical and must be followed exactly.
2.
If DLT is completely shut down , perform 2-24.
3.
Ignore alllight emitting diode ( LED ) indicators until Radio Fre-
NOTES
DLT turn on per para
quency Tuner A2A5 is properly tuned.
CONTINUED
2-213
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-26 .
1
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING - Continued At Computer-To-Communications Interface Processor (CCIP) A2A2, set OPERATE switch to OFF .
PROPAGA! DELAYREQUEST OPERATE
PROCESSORCONTRO
O OFF
2
RADNO OSC CAL 8 88 88 AUTOSYNC TIME CONTROL
At Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5, set MODE switch to MANUAL and rotate MANUAL control fully ccw.
POWER CONTROL
FORWARDPOWER REVERSEPOWER
POWERCONTROLMANUAL MODE AUTO
RESET
TEST
MANUAL FREQ
MODE
AUTO
DELAY TUNE
Θ
3
Adjust FREQ control to desired operating frequency.
FREQ
Co
CONTINUED) (
2-214
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-23.
4
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING - Continued
At Receiver-Transmitter A2A3, set FREQUENCY SELECT switches to desired operating frequency .
FREQUENCY SELECT
FREQUENCYSELECT
RECEIVER
FAULT TRANSMITTER AD 411 412 413
8888
8888 قلة ة FAULT RESET
5
ة
At CCIP A2A2 , set LOAD NET switch to OFF.
--
TEST LOAD NET
Q
PROCESSOR CONTROL
OSCA
O
88 88
OFF
6
Set AUTO SYNC switch to OFF.
AUTO SYNC=
OFF
CONTINUND
2-215
TM 9-1440-600-10 T 2-26.
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING - Continued
2. 7
Set PROCESSOR CONTROL to DLTN .
PROCESSOR CONTROL PROPAGATION REQUEST
DUTN TRBY
NORM KGBY PROCESSORCONTROLOSC CAL
88 88
5.
w
8
Set DLT TEST switch to TEST. DLT TEST TEST
NORMAL
9
Set ALTERNATE MASTER switch to ALTERNATE MASTER .
ALTERNATE MASTER
OFF
10
At Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5 , check that TUNE lamp is on.
TUNE
FORWARDPOWER REVERSEPOWER
ANT O
FRED O
DELAY TUNE(
G
! O
10
POWERCONTROL MANIAL
CONTINUED
2-216
2-
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-25.
11
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING - Continued
At CCIP A2A2, hold RESET switch to RESET momentarily.
PHOPAGATION DELAYREQUEST
RESET PROCESSORCONTRO
12
OSCCAL 10 00 00 AUTOSYNC CONTROL
RADIO
Set TIME SET switches to 0 DAY, 00
DAY
HOUR, 10 MIN.
8
13
TIME SET HOUR
88
MIN
88
Set LOAD NET switch to LOAD NET then back to OFF .
LOAD NET OFF
14
IME T TIME
OF DAY
indicator displays 0
TIME OF DAY
DAY, 00 HOUR, 10 MIN , 00 SEC . DAY
15
HOUR
MIN
SEC
At Key Generator KG -30 A2A1 , loosen 16 captive screws and open panel .
CONTINUED
2-217
T
TM 9-1440-600-10
2
2-26.
16
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING — Continued Set POWER switch to OFF . Initialize Key Generator KG -30 A2A1 . ( Refer to manual KAO - 137E/TSEC . )
[
O 01 7° XMTR LYOFF ALM ON ALMLYONOFF BOTH OFF BOTHON
WARNING
WARNING
POWER RCVR POWER O
PUSH TO ZERO
PUSH TO ZERO
ON
OFF
17
18
Close panel and secure with 16 captive screws.
At CCIP A2A2 , set OPERATE switch to OPERATE .
MOPAGATION REQUEST DELAY
TEST OPERATE
PROCESSORCONTROL OSCCAL OFF
AUTOSYNC 8888 CONTROL
RADIO Θ
CONTINUED
2-
2-218
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-26 .
19
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING - Continued Verify TIME OF DAY display is activated and SYNC light comes on .
TIME OF DAY .
HOUR
DAY
MIN
SEC
MC
DAY
Θ
PROCESSORCONTRO
MODE DSCCAL 8 98 99 AUTOSYNCE
BACK
SYNC
1221 L O AUTO SYNC
RESET 20
Hold
RESET switch to
RESET,
mo-
(3) mentarily.
If FORWARD POWER meter on Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5 suddenly goes to zero, Receiver-Transmitter A2A3 has shut down.
NOTE If it shuts down ,
do steps 45 thru 47 and
return to the step
you were on .
At Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5 , slowly adjust MANUAL control cw until either the
CREARDPOWER REVERSEPOWER MANUAL
FORWARD POWER meter
indicates at top of TUNE zone on upDELAY TUME
THEO O
per meter scale or REVERSE POWER meter indicates at top of green area.
FORWARD POWER
POWER CONTROL
MANUAL
MODE
REVERSE POWER
AUTO
© ༔ ]
21
& CONTINUED
2-219
TM 9-1440-600-10 T 2-26 .
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING - Continued
2. 22
Adjust FREQ control for a minimum REVERSE POWER meter indication.
FORMARD PONIED REVERSE POWER TRIST
O
[
DELAY
REVERSE POWER
FREQ
23
Adjust MANUAL control until FORWARD POWER meter indicates at top of TUNE zone on upper meter scale .
FORWARD POWER
POWER CONTROL
MANUAL
MODE
AUTO
24
Observe FREQ dial indication .
25
Slowly adjust FREQ control cw from FREQ dial indication observed in step
FREQ 24 until REVERSE POWER meter indicates 30 to 70 on scale.
REVERSE POWER
CONTINUED &
2-220 2-
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-26.
26
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING - Continued
Observe FREQ dial . POWER CONTACE MODE BUTO ANT
27
FORWARD POWER REVERSE POWER RESET
TEST
Slowly adjust FREQ control ccw from FREQ dial indication observed in step FREO
DELAI FUNE
26, until REVERSE POWER meter indicates 30 to 70 on scale .
REVERSE POWER
FREQ &
во
28
Observe FREQ dial indication .
29
Adjust FREQ 24 and 26.
30
Slowly adjust MANUAL control cw until FORWARD POWER meter indicates
control
midway between
in middle of green area, and at same time , adjust FREQ control so REVERSE POWER meter indication is at
FREQ
dial
indications observed in
steps
POWER CONTROL
MANUAL
MODE
AUTO
a minimum and below 30 on scale.
FORWARD POWER
REVERSE POWER
CONTINUED
2-221
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-26 .
31
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING- Continued
Repeat steps 20 thru 28 as often as required to obtain correct indications.
MAKE SURE THAT ALL PERSONNEL ARE CLEAR
OF AN-
TENNA BEFORE PERFORMING ANY STEP BELOW. TRANSWARNING
MITTER WILL BE RADIATING AND HAZARDOUS VOLTAGE WILL BE PRESENT AT ANTENNA.
32
At Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5, rotate MANUAL control fully ccw .
TUNY
→
FRED
DELAY TURE
POWER CONTROL
AUTO
MODE
O
MANUAL
TUNE
While holding ANT switch to ANT, adjust MANUAL control cw until either FORWARD POWER meter indicates
J
33
ANT
FORWARD POWER
O
at top of TUNE zone on upper meter scale , or REVERSE POWER meter indicates at top of green area.
REVERSE POWER
CONTINUE D
T
2-222
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-26.
34
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING - Continued
-PERVER CONTROL MARIAL O AUTO ART
Continue to hold ANT switch to ANT. Unlock TUNE control and adjust TUNE and DELAY controls for a minimum indication on REVERSE POW-
REVERSE POWER TUOT
Θ DELAY TUME во
ER meter.
REVERSE POWER
TUNE
ANT DELAY
35
TUNE
While holding ANT switch to ANT, adjust MANUAL control until FORWARD POWER meter indicates at top of TUNE zone on upper meter scale.
FORWARD POWER POWER CONTROL
MANUAL
MODE
AUTO
Several minimum REVERSE POWER
meter indications may be
observed . Select TUNE and DELAY control adjustments that pro-
NOTE duce the lowest minimum .
CONTINUED
T
2-223
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-26.
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING - Continued
36
Continue to hold ANT switch to ANT and adjust TUNE and DELAY controls to obtain lowest minimum REVERSE POWER meter indication .
O
DELAY TUNE
Co
REVERSE POWER
ANT
J
TUNE
DELAY
37
TUNE
Continue to hold ANT switch to ANT and adjust MANUAL control cw until FORWARD POWER meter indicates in middle of green area. REVERSE POWER meter must indicate below 30 on scale.
FORWARD POWER
REVERSE POWER
POWER CONTROL
MANUAL
MODE
AUTO
G
38
At DLT Tuner A2A5 , release ANT switch .
39
LOCK TUNE control knob.
40
Set MODE switch to AUTO .
CONTINUED
2-224
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-26.
41
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING - Continued
At CCIP A2A2, hold RESET switch to
RESET momentarily. OPROCESSORCONTRO
AUTOSYNC 8 98 CONTROX98
RESET
42
O
FAULT KEY GEN SUMMARY FAULT FAULT
Check that SUMMARY FAULT and KEY GEN FAULT LEDs are off.
TIME CONTROL LOAD NET OPERATE 43
Set OPERATE - OFF switch to OFF. OFF
OFF
44
ALTERNATE MASTER
Set ALTERNATE MASTER switch to OFF.
OFF PROCESSOR CONTROL
ר DUTN TROY
45
Set
PROCESSOR
CONTROL to
NORM
KGBY
NORM
DLT TEST TEST
46
Set DLT TEST switch to NORMAL.
NORMAL
CONTINUED
2-225
TM 9-1440-600-10 T 2-26 .
DATA LINK TERMINAL TUNING - Continued
2.
NOTE
The following steps are used only if Receiver-Transmitter A2A3 shuts down .
[
47
At Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5 , rotate MANUAL control fully ccw.
POWER CONTROL
MANUAL
MODE
AUTO
FRED
DELAY TURE
อ
O
48
At CCIP A2A2 , hold RESET switch to RESET momentarily.
FAULT SUMMARY KEY GEN FAULT FAULT
Θ
PROCESSORCONTROL OSC CAL
O RESET
49
At Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5 , adjust MANUAL control cw to obtain the required indication on the FORWARD
Ꮎ
POWER or REVERSE POWER meter.
Θ
FORWARD POWER
FREO O
BBLAY TUME
во
REVERSE POWER POWER CONTROL
MANUAL
2-226
2-
MODE
AUTO
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-27.
DATA LINK TERMINAL LOOPBACK
Use this procedure to verify operating status of the data link terminal ( DLT) . It should always be performed before operating the DLT in a net.
RADIO FREQUENCY TUNER A2A5
POWER SUPPLY A2A6 00
000
KEY GENERATOR KG-30 A2A1 RECEIVER -TRANSMITTER A2A3
COMPUTER-TO-COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE PROCESSOR A2A2
DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2A2
Personnel Required . Two Tools and Equipment Required . Screwdriver, Flat Tip , 1 /4- In .
NOTE
1
Ignore all light emitting diode (LED) indicators unless otherwise directed .
Turn on data link terminal ( DLT) per para 2-24.
CONTINUED
2-227
TM 9-1440-600-10
T
2-27.
DATA LINK TERMINAL LOOPBACK - Continued
2 2
At Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5 , set MODE switch to MANUAL and rotate
MANUAL
AUTO
MANUAL control fully ccw. TUNE
G
FRAG POWER CONTROL
MANUAL
3
MODE
AUTO
At Computer - To - Communications Interface Processor (CCIP) A2A2, per-
TEST
form the following :
PROCESSORCONTROL
NASIO
8888 TECONTROL
a.
Set DLT TEST switch to TEST.
DLT TEST TEST NORMAL
b.
Set
LOAD
NET and
OPERATE
switches to OFF.
C.
Set AUTO SYNC switch to OFF.
TIME CONTROL LOAD NET OPERATE OFF
OFF
AUTO SYNC
OFF
OFF
CONTINUED
2-228
2-
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-27.
DATA LINK TERMINAL LOOPBACK- Continued -
3
d.
Continued .
Set
PROCESSOR CONTROL to DELARREQUEST
NORM. PROCESSORCONTROL
888 CONTROL88 PROCESSOR CONTROL
DUTN TROY
NORM
KGBY
8
e.
ALTERNATE MASTER
Set ALTERNATE MASTER switch to ALTERNATE MASTER,
OFF
f.
RESET
Hold
RESET switch to
RESET
momentarily .
g.
DAY
Set TIME SET switches to 0 DAY,
TIME SET HOUR
MIN
00 HOUR, 10 MIN. 8
h. TIME CONTROL OPERATE LOAD NET OFF
88
Set LOAD
88
NET switch to
LOAD
NET, then back to OFF.
OFF
CONTINUED
2-229
TM 9-1440-600-10
1
2-27.
DATA LINK TERMINAL LOOPBACK- Continued
2 —
3
Continued .
Check that TIME
i.
OF
DAY indi-
cator displays 0 DAY, 00 HOUR , 10 MIN, 00 SEC. PROCESSORCONTROL
SYNC MODE OSC CAL 8 88 89 AUTOSTINC
RADIO
TIME OF DAY
DAY
MIN
HOUR
SEC
4
At Key Generator KG-30 A2A1 , loosen 16 captive screws and open panel .
5
Set POWER switch to OFF . Initialize Key Generator KG -30 A2A1 . ( Refer to manual KAO- 137E/TSEC . )
70 01 XMTR LTOFF ALM ON ALMLTONOFF BOTH BOTH OFF
10 of WARNING
WARNING
POWER RCVR O
10
PUSH TO ZERO
PUSH TO ZERO
ON
OFF
CONTINUED 6
2-
2-230
Close panel and secure with 16 captive screws.
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-27.
7
DATA LINK TERMINAL LOOPBACK - Continued
At CCIP A2A2 , set switch to OPERATE .
OPERATE- OFF
PROCESSORCONTROL TIME OF DAY
DAY
MIN
HOUR
PROPAGATION SHELAYREQUEST
TEST
DSCCAL 8 88 88 AUTO BYNCK TIME CONTROL
RADIO
SEC
TIME CONTROL LOAD NET OPERATE OFF
OFF
8
Check that TIME- OF- DAY indicator is activated and SEC indicator is counting .
9
At Radio
POWERCONTROL MANUAL MODE AUTO ANT
Frequency Tuner A2A5 ,
FORWARD POWER REVERSE POWER TEST
slowly adjust MANUAL control cw until FORWARD POWER meter indicates in middle of green area and REVERSE POWER meter does not ex-
FREQ
CELAY TUNE
ceed upper limit of green area.
FORWARD POWER
REVERSE POWER
POWER CONTROL
MANUAL
MODE
AUTO
O 10
Rotate MANUAL control fully ccw and set MODE switch to AUTO .
FORWARD POWER 11
REVERSE POWER
Check that AUTO light comes on and both FORWARD and REVERSE POWER meters indicate in green area .
CONTINUED
2-231
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-27.
12
DATA LINK TERMINAL LOOPBACK- Continued
At CCIP A2A2, set ALTERNATE MASPROFAGAT
TER switch to OFF. RADNO
PROCESSORCONTROL OSC CAL 8 88 88
O ALTERNATE MASTER
OFF
13
Hold
RESET switch to
FAULT KEY GEN SUMMARY FAULT FAULT
RESET mo-
mentarily. O RESET
14
Check that the fault indicators at the following locations are off.
a.
POWER SUPPLY FAULT.
At DLT Power Supply A2A6 :
O PS2
NON-INTERRUPT
b.
O Of
O PS1
O PS4
O PS3
PS6
LAMP TEST
At Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5:
ARDPOWER REVERSE POWER 10
POWERCONTROL MANUAL MODE
FAULT
TEST
RESET Ꮎ
TUNE
+
CONTINUED
2-232
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-27.
14
DATA LINK TERMINAL LOOPBACK- Continued
-
C.
Continued .
At Receiver-Transmitter A2A3 :
FREQUENCYSELECT
FAULT TRANSMITTER
8888 Θ Ꮎ RECEIVER A1
A4
A2
TRANSMITTER A3
A11 A12
A13
ooooo A7 A14 A10
At CCIP A2A2:
1019
d.
قلة ة FAULY
FAULT
PROPAGATION DELAYREQUEST
OLT TEST
PROCESSORCONTROL FAULT KEY GEN SUMMARY FAULT FAULT
OSC CAL 8 88 89 CONTROL
RADIOID 5.
RESET
15
At Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5, hold TEST switch to TEST . Check that FORWARD POWER meter indicates in L zone on upper meter scale. Release TEST switch .
CONTINUED
2-233
TM 9-1440-600-10
T
2-27.
DATA LINK TERMINAL LOOPBACK- Continued
2 16
At CCIP A2A2 , set DLT TEST switch to NORMAL.
DLT TEST
TEST
RACHO C
PROCESSORCONTROL SCCAL 8 88 88
NORMAL
17
Set OPERATE switch to OFF .
TIME CONTROL LOAD NET OPERATE OFF
2-234 2.
OFF
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-28.
DATA LINK TERMINAL SLAVE SYNCHRONIZING
RADIO FREQUENCY TUNER A2A5
b to emit
POWER SUPPLY A2A6 00
000
KEY GENERATOR KG-30 A2A1 RECEIVER -TRANSMITTER A2A3 COMPUTER-TO-COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE PROCESSOR A2A2
DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2A2
LCU DISPLAY 'PANEL A1A14
LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE A1
Personnel Required . Two Tools and Equipment Required . Screwdriver, Flat Tip, 1 /4-In .
NOTE
ECS master identification must be sent to the LS from the ECS.
CONTINUED
2-235
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-28.
1
DATA LINK TERMINAL SLAVE SYNCHRONIZING - Continued The following must be performed before doing this procedure :
a.
Verify net start time and true time of day.
b.
Verify with Organizational Maintenance that Computer-To-Communications Interface Processor (CCIP) A2A2 master oscillator has been alined .
2
C.
Turn the DLT on per para 2-24.
d.
Tune the DLT per para 2-26 .
e.
Perform DLT loopback per para 2-27.
On CCIP A2A2, set MODE switch to 1. RADN
PROCESSORCONTROL OSCCAL 8 88 88 THE CONTROL MODE
3
Set
RADIO ID switch to
correct LS
identification .
6 RADIO ID LS/B ECS-C ECS-B LS/A
DISC LS/C
ECS-A
CONTINUED
2-236
TM 9-1440-600-10
On LCU Display Panel A1A4, set LAUNCHING STA and FIRING PLATOON switches to correct addresses.
LAUNCHING STA
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT BITE
2
POWER SUPPLIES Ο
3
LAUNCHER- PLATFORM
MISSILE LIPPERL UPPER 8
10!
2
O
MEADY LOR PLATFORM 이이 이이 READY READY RAD AUTH OOO 이이 이이 LAUNCHING STA STOP
FIRING PLATOON 1
6
O
e
5
O
4
DATA LINK TERMINAL SLAVE SYNCHRONIZING - Continued
O
2-28 .
10:
START ·
O
3
PRINGPLATOON STATUSLAMP
O
LANSTATUS TEST
10
оо
5
On
CCIP A2A2 set
OPERATE and
LOAD NET switches to OFF.
៦ ០០ CONTROL០០៩ TIME CONTROL LOAD NET OPERATE
OFF
Set AUTO SYNC switch to OFF.
SYNC O AUTO SYNC
O
6
OFF
OFF CONTINUED
2-237
TM 9-1440-600-10
1
CV
2-28.
2
7
DATA LINK TERMINAL SLAVE SYNCHRONIZING - Continued Set ALTERNATE MASTER switch to
708
OFF.
PROCESSOR CONTROL
DSCCAL 10 00 00 AUTO SYRNCY TIME CONTROL
RADNO
ALTERNATE MASTER
OFF
8
PROCESSOR CONTROL
Set PROCESSOR
CONTROL switch
to NORM .
DLTN TRBY NORM
KGBY
DLT TEST
9
Set DLT TEST switch to NORMAL.
TEST NORMAL
DAY
TIME SET HOUR
MIN 10
8
88
88
Using TIME SET switches , enter the net start time ( ECS DLT net entry time) .
-TIME CONTROL LOAD NET OPERATE
11
Set LOAD NET switch to LOAD NET and back to OFF . OFF
OFF
TIME OF DAY
12 DAY
HOUR
MIN
SEC
Check that net start time appears at TIME OF DAY display.
CONTINUED
2-238 2-
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-28.
DATA LINK TERMINAL SLAVE SYNCHRONIZING - Continued
13
At Key Generator KG-30 A2A1 , loosen 16 captive screws and open panel .
14
Set POWER switch to OFF . Initialize Key Generator KG -30 A2A1 . ( Refer to manual KAO- 137E /TSEC . )
no or XMTR &TOFF AUR ON ALM OFF BOTHOFF BOTHON
WARNING
WARNING
POWER
RCVR POWER
PUSH TO ZERO
PUSH TO ZERO
ON
OFF
15
Close panel and secure with 16 captive screws .
16
At CCIP A2A2, set TIME SET switches to desired DLT net entry time per tactical SOP.
DAY
8
TIME SET HOUR
88
PROPAGATION DELAYREQUEST.
TEST PROCESSORCONTROL
O
OSCCA 10 00 00 AUTOSYNC TIME CONTRO
MIN
88
TIME CONTROL LOAD NET OPERATE 17
Set OPERATE switch to OPERATE .
OFF
OFF CONTINUED
2-239
TM-9-1440-600-10
ו LV
2-28.
2
18
DATA LINK TERMINAL SLAVE SYNCHRONIZING - Continued
Verify that TIME OF DAY display counts up to net entry time and stops.
TIME OF DAY QUEST DAY
MIN
HOUR
SEC
PROCESSORCONTRO
RADN OBC CAL 8 88 88 CONTROL
5.
--8--
Net entry time must be ahead of true time of day when displays stops . When OPERATE switch is set to OPERATE , DLT clock
NOTE
advances 128 times faster than real time, then stops.
a.
When true time of day equals net entry time ,
DLT clock will start and TIME
OF DAY display will advance .
If true time of day has passed and TIME OF
DAY has not advanced ,
go to step 19.
b.
Synchronization is complete when SYNC light comes on . If SYNC light comes on , go to step 22.1 .
If SYNC light does not come on , go to step 20.
19
Set OPERATE switch to OFF and reTIME CONTROL LOAD NET OPERATE
peat steps 11 through 18. If not synchronized after three tries , call Intermediate Maintenance.
OFF
OFF
SYNC O AUTO SYNC
20
At CCIP
A2A2 ,
set AUTO
SYNC
O
switch to AUTO SYNC
OFF
CONTINUED
2-
2-240
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
DATA LINK TERMINAL SLAVE SYNCHRONIZING - Continued
2-28.
After 1
21
second TIME OF DAY display will advance
9 seconds and
stop .
This
cycle may be repeated up to six times in a 3 minute time period .
TIME OF DAY DELAYREQUEST
TEST DAY DAY
MIN
HOUR
HOUR
田
SEC PROCESSORCONTROL
MODE OBC CAL
88 TIMECONTROL8
AUTOSYNC
RADIOIN D
w
CCIP A2A2 now controls synchronization. NOTE
22
Within 3 minutes SYNC light or AUTO SYNC light will come on.
a.
If SYNC light comes on , synchroSYNC
nization is complete . 22.1 .
Go to step
b.
OO
AUTO SYNC
If AUTO SYNC light comes on, set OPERATE and AUTO SYNC switches to OFF Repeat steps 11 OFF
through 18.
TIME CONTROL LOAD NET OPERATE OFF
22.1
RESET
OFF
Verify that ECS and LS DLT TIME OF DAY clocks indicate clocks do not indicate same time , repeat steps 5 through 22.
22
23
Hold RESET switch to RESET momentarily .
24
Set AUTO SYNC switch to OFF , if on .
same time . If
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-241
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-28.
25
DATA LINK TERMINAL SLAVE SYNCHRONIZING - Continued
Check that the fault indicators at the following locations are off.
a.
At Radio Frequency Tuner A2A5 :
FAULT
RESET
⚫
RESET DELAY TURE
FREO O
O
b.
At Receiver-Transmitter A2A3:
Θ FAULT
TRANSMITTER
RECEIVER A1
A2
A3
A11 A12
FAULT RECEIVER AJ 43 491 412 413
FREQUENCYSELECT
A13
0000 FRULY
Ꮎ
OO A7 A4
A10
A14
O
C.
At CCIP A2A2 :
FAULT KEY GEN SUMMARY FAULT FAULT
FAIL
PROFAGATION DELAYREQUEST
DLF TEST
MODE OSC CAL
PROCESSORCONTRO
RESET
Θ
AUTOSYNC 8888 TIME CONTROL
w
d.
At DLT Power Supply A2A6:
POWER SUPPLY FAULT-
O PS1
O PS2
NON-INTERRUPT
O PS3 LAMP TEST
O PS4
O PS5 PS6 O
2-242
CONTINUED
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-29 .
DATA LINK TERMINAL AUTO SYNCHRONIZING
Use this procedure to resynchronize the launching station (LS) data link terminal (DLT) to the engagement control station ( ECS) DLT during power- up.
abnoose a
vietamix
SA
RECEIVER-TRANSMITTER A2A3
DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2
COMPUTER-TO-COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE PROCESSOR A2A2
1
Following conditions are required for this procedure to work:
a.
DLT has been synchronized .
b.
Noninterrupt power has not been lost.
C.
DLT Power Distribution
Unit
( PDU) A2A4 and
Launcher Electronics
Module
(LEM ) Power Distribution Unit (PDU) A1A2 are energized .
STINU! CONTINUED
2-243
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-29.
2
DATA LINK TERMINAL AUTO SYNCHRONIZING - Continued
At Computer-To- Communications Interface Processor (CCIP) A2A2 , check that TIME OF DAY display is counting .
TIME OF DAY
DAY
MIN
HOUR
SEC PROCESSORCONTROL
- DSC CAL 8 88 88 CONTROL
1.
RADIO
5.
Wait approximately 45 seconds after DLTM - PDU A2A4 is ener-
NOTES
gized for Receiver-Transmitter A2A3 to obtain lock . 2.
3
BYNC
Receiver-Transmitter A2A3 FAULT- RECEIVER -A1 on.
LED may be
RESET
At CCIP A2A2, hold RESET switch to RESET momentarily .
4
At Receiver-Transmitter A2A3, check that FAULT- RECEIVER - A1 LED goes off.
O FAULT RECEIVER
A1
A2
TRANSMITTER
A3
A11 A12
A13
A7
A14
A10
FREQUENCYSELECT OD GILD
FAULT RECEIVER AD 43 411 412
G
OBEC στο
A4
Ö Öö Ö FAIT อ e
FAULT RESET
Θ
CONTINUED
2-244
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-29.
DATA LINK TERMINAL AUTO SYNCHRONIZING- Continued
5
At CCIP A2A2, set PROCESSOR CONTROL switch to NORM
PROCESSOR CONTROL
DL TN ⚫
TRBY NORM
KGBY PROCESSORCONTROL
6
OBC CAL 8 88 88 AUTOSYNC ECONTRO
AUTO SYNC switch to AUTO SYNC
SYNC ୮ O AUTO SYNC
OFF
7
After 1 second , TIME OF DAY display
TIME OF DAY
will advance 9 seconds and stop . This cycle may be repeated up to six times in a 3 minute period.
DAY
HOUR
MIN
SEC
CONTINUED
2-245
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-29.
DATA LINK TERMINAL AUTO SYNCHRONIZING - Continued
CCIP A2A2 now controls resynchronization .
NOTE
8
Within 3 minutes, SYNC light or AUTO SYNC light will come on .
SYNC O AUTO SYNC
PROCESSORCONTROLAUTO SYNC 8 88 TIMECONTROL88
RADIOB
OFF
a.
If SYNC light comes on , synchronization is complete :
(1 )
Set AUTO OFF .
SYNC
switch to
(2)
Verify that ECS and LS TIME OF DAY clocks indicate same time . If clocks do not indicate same time, perform DLT slave
b.
synchronization per para 2-28.
OPERATE
If AUTO SYNC light comes on , set OPERATE and AUTO SYNC
OFF
switches to OFF and perform DLT slave synchronization per para 2-28.
RESET C.
Hold
RESET switch to
RESET
momentarily.
CONTINUED
2-246
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30
MARCH ORDER
The instructions in this paragraph prepare a properly emplaced launching station (LS) for road march . The procedure should be performed after a march order has been received and acknowledged . If you do not know the launching road march , refer to Equipment Data para 1-8.
station
dimensions important to
March order is essentially the same during daylight, nighttime , and blackout conditions . Nighttime does not always mean blackout. When blackout conditions are in effect blackout flashlights must be used . At night when blackout conditions are not in effect regular lights may be used . The following blackout conditions .
general precautions must be observed
under nighttime or
Use signals per FM 21-60. Use flashlights to see with. Be aware of each crewmember's position . Get help when tasks cannot be easily performed in the dark. Put tools and equipment away after using them . Make all movements sure and deliberate . Do not climb on the LS unless required .
Crewmembers on the LS must be
watched by another crewmember and warned of unsafe conditions . •
Do not move vehicles without a guide . Observe all cautions and warnings called out in the procedure and
marked
on equipment.
IF THE OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE
HAS BEEN BELOW 32°F
(0°C) AND HAS RISEN ABOVE 32°F (0°C) , TORQUE THE CANISTER TIEDOWN BOLTS PER CHANGING WEATHER
CAU
PARAGRAPH 2-38 BEFORE ROAD MARCH .
CONTINUED
2-247
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
MARCH ORDER- Continued
DATA LINK MAST ASSEMBLY
DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2
OUTRIGGER CONTROL PANEL GUIDED MISSILES
GENERATOR SET A6
LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE A1
ROADSIDE
Personnel Required . Three Tools and Equipment Required . Pliers, Slip Joint, 12- In . Long
CONTINUED
2-248
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-30 .
MARCH ORDER - Continued
CONFIRM WITH ECS OPERATOR THAT THE LS IS IN LOCAL Le
WARNING
MODE BEFORE GOING TO LS. YOU COULD BE SEVERELY INJURED OR KILLED IF LAUNCHER MECHANICS (LM ) ROTATES OR MISSILE FIRES .
STAY CLEAR OF LAUNCHER MECHANICS PLANE OF ROTA-
Le TION UNTIL KEYSWITCH IS SET TO LOCAL, LOCAL LIGHT
WARNING
IS ON, AND KEY IS REMOVED . WHEN KEYSWITCH IS SET TO RMT, TURNTABLE CAN BE ROTATED REMOTELY , CAUSING INJURY TO PERSONNEL WITHIN PLANE OF ROTATION .
MISSILES DROPPED ACCIDENTALLY MAY BE DANGEROUS .
Le REPORT ANY DROP OF 12 INCHES OR MORE IMMEDIATELY
WARNING
AND PROCEED AS FOLLOWS : IF MISSILE IS STILL IN CANISTER , CONSIDER MISSILE TO BE UNARMED . DO NOT MOVE MISSILE FOR 1 HOUR AFTER INCIDENT. AFTER 1 HOUR , UNIT COMMANDER MAY DIRECT MISSILE TO BE REMOVED TO DEPOT. IF
MISSILE
IS
PARTLY OR
COMPLETELY OUT
OF
CANISTER , CONSIDER MISSILE TO BE ARMED . TELL YOUR UNIT COMMANDER AND EVACUATE AREA.
DEATH MAY RESULT FROM EXPLOSION .
MISSILE
MISFIRE
MAY RELEASE
EXPLOSIVE
HYDROGEN
Le GAS INTO CANISTER . AFTER A MISFIRE , DO NOT GO NEAR
WARNING
CANISTER FOR 1 HOUR . DEATH MAY RESULT.
CONTINUED
2-249
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-30 .
MARCH ORDER - Continued
MISSILE MISFIRE MAY RELEASE CORROSIVE Le WARNING
UID CAN BURN YOU . HANDLE CANISTERS WITH CARE .
CREWMEMBERS Le WARNING
Le WARNING
POTASSIUM
HYDROXIDE FROM BATTERIES INTO CANISTER . THIS LIQ-
ON
LS
MUST BE WATCHED
CREWMEMBERS AND WARNED OF ANY
BY OTHER
UNSAFE CONDI-
TIONS TO PREVENT INJURY.
DATA LINK TERMINAL ( DLT) TIME OF DAY CLOCK MUST BE COUNTING BEFORE PROPER INDICATION CAN BE OBTAINED ON NIGSHE HAZARD LIGHTS. A SHE HAZAD LIGHT ON LCU DISPLAY PANEL A1A14 INDICATES A HAZARDOUS CONDITION FOR POSITIONS HAVING A LIVE MISSILE WITH UMBILICAL CONNECTED ONLY. ! .. LIGHTS WILL BE ON FOR ALL POSITIONS HAVING A DUMMY MISSILE , EMPTY CANISTER , EMPTY LOCATION , OR A LIVE MISSILE WITH UMBILICAL DISCONNECTED , BUT THESE CONDITIONS DO NOT CONSTITUTE A HAZARD. IF ANY ONE OF THE MISSILE HAZARO LIGHTS IS ON, VISUALLY CHECK THAT A MISSILE IS PRESENT AT THAT POSITION WITH UMBILICAL CONNECTED.
WHEN
IT IS DETERMINED THAT A
LIVE MISSILE IS PRESENT WITH UMBILICAL CONNECTED , IMMEDIATELY
NOTIFY
(ECS) OF CONDITION WILL REMAIN LEAVE
AREA
IN
ENGAGEMENT CONTROL STATION INDICATED,
LOCAL
MODE.
AND ADVISE THAT AFTER
AND AWAIT FURTHER
NOTIFYING
INSTRUCTIONS .
LS
ECS, AC-
CIDENTAL FIRING COULD SEVERELY INJURE OR KILL YOU .
A DAMAGED CANISTER CAN INDICATE AN UNUSABLE MISSILE . REPORT ANY CANISTER DAMAGE IMMEDIATELY. UNIT COMMANDER WILL DECIDE IF MISSILE IS TO BE REPLACED OR USED . CAUTION
CONTA
2-250
ΕΙ
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-30 .
MARCH ORDER - Continued
DO NOT MOVE GUIDED MISSILE (GM) WITHIN 50 FEET OF AN RF SOURCE THAT RADIATES 50 WATTS OR MORE .
CAUTION
1
SELECT LOCAL MODE .
LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT (LEM - PDU ) A1A2 ACCESS DOOR MUST REMAIN CLOSED DURING SYSTEM OPERATION TO PREVENT DEGRADING EMI SHIELDING.
CAUTION
a.
Open LEM A1
right- hand door . If wind is over 45 knots ,
insert locking pin
in hole at top of door.
CONTINUED
2-251
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-30 .
MARCH ORDER - Continued
— 1
b.
Continued .
On LCU Display Panel A1A14 , set LOCAL- RMT switch to LOCAL
O
BITE
LAUNCHER LOCAL
LO
POWER SUPPLIES O MISSILE UPPER
PLATFORM
O
O
CA
O
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
L
이이 이이 O
RM
T
O
101
0101010
LAURICHINGSTA
START
C.
Verify that LOCAL light comes on .
d.
Remove key from LOCAL- RMT switch . Commander retain key.
STATUS LANDFEET
O
O
le
O
Ô LAFSON
Crewmember designated by Battery
STATUS LAMPS NORMAL
e.
Set STATUS
LAMPS switch to
NORMAL or DIM as desired .
DIM
2
ROTATE TURNTABLE TO TRAVEL POSITION .
a.
∞
Check travel position pointer. If alined between alinement strip gage marks , go to step 3.
CONTINUED
2-252
TM 9-1440-600-10 MARCH ORDER - Continued 2
b.
Continued .
Verify that engagement control handle is set to ROTATE
ROTATE
ELEV
ROADMARCH ROADSIDE
0
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
O
On LCU Display Panel A1A14, hold CCW- STOP - CW switch to
LAUNCHERLOCAL CRAFT
O 0
O
კიი
O
C W
!09
e
STOP
O
Ο
READY LC PLATFORM 이이 이이 MADY RAISED ATRUTH READY O DISCON MISSILE MECTED 0101010 Θ RAISE STOP CONNECT CONNECT Ο Ο [NSC CXSC DISC START 0 3 ODO FIRINGPLATOON BITETEST STATUSLA NORMAL OO OFF STATUS eOO LAMPTEST
O
correct position to rotate turntable to travel position .
O
POWER SUPPLIES OOOO O VDC 20 MISSILE PLATFORM LIPPER UPPERA HAZARD 0000
O
BITE
C.
101
2-30 .
d.
Release CCW- STOP - CW switch when travel position alinement strip gage marks .
pointer alines between
CONTINUED
2-253
TM 9-1440-600-10
MARCH ORDER- Continued
2-30 .
MISSILE IS FREE TO MOVE IN CANISTER IF TORQUE TUBE HANDLE IS NOT PROPERLY LOCKED . SUDDEN STOPS ON ROAD
WARNING
MARCH
COULD CAUSE
MISSILE TO
PENETRATE
TRACTOR CAB, RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
1.
Be very alert at night. Insure that working area is clear before starting . Make all movements sure and deliberate . Do not rush .
NOTES
2.
Check GM torque tube handles . If they are locked , go to step 3 h.
3.
Have a crewmember at LCU Display Panel A1A14 verify that MISSILE READY light at the correct GM position goes out as that GM torque tube handle is locked.
4.
Lock GM torque tube UL, LL.
handles in the following order : UR ,
LR ,
LOCK GM TORQUE TUBE HANDLES AND DISCONNECT GMs.
3
a.
Remove quick- release torque tube handle .
b.
Pull out and plunger.
hold
pin
by
memb
spring-loaded
Rotate torque tube han-
dle cw to LOCK position . C.
Release plunger . Check that plunger seats in left detent hole
d.
O O DESSICANTHOLDER
O
to secure torque tube handle . Check that no red paint shows to
CK
PUBL
O GESSICANTHOLDER
DONOT LATCHOR UNLATCH UNLESSGM ELEVATED
O RECORDS
RELIEFVALVE PUSHTO RELEASE O
CONTINUED
Change 1
PUSHTO RELEASE
Jill
LATCHOR ULATCH UNLESSCM ELEVATED
handle .
UNLO
left of torque tube
2-254
O
TM 9-1440-600-10
e.
Insert quick- release pin into hole to right of torque tube handle.
f.
Check with crewmember at LCU
O
Continued .
BITE
PLATFORM
LAUNCHER-
correct GM position went out.
POWER SUPPLIES O
O
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
Display Panel A1A14 and verify that MISSILE READY light for the
O
O
-
MISSILE
=0 | 0 |0 |0
이이 이이
RAISE
O
O 0|0|0|0
CHING STA
о
O
RLARY PLATFOR MAD RAISED ASMOUTH ööö
MISSILE READY STOP
O
START
O
3
MARCH ORDER - Continued
oooo
2-30 .
·
FING PLATOON
O
O! Ho
CITE TENT STATUR LAN FEST
Ο
g.
Repeat steps a thru f for LR , UL, and LL positions.
h.
Verify that all MISSILE READY lights are off.
i.
On
LCU
Display
Panel A1A14 ,
UPPER L
verify that MISSILE HAZARD light is off at each position that has a live GM with umbilical connect-
MISSILE UPPER R LWR L
LWR R
MISSILE HAZARD
ed.
j.
Raise cover and hold CONNECTDISC switches to
DISC
at all
positions until corresponding lights MISSILE - DISCONNECTED
MISSILE DISCONNECTED 0101010
go on.
CONNECT CONNECT
DISC
DISC
CONNECT CONNECT
DISC
DISC
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-255
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
4
MARCH ORDER - Continued
POSITION TRACTOR FOR COUPLING TO SEMITRAILER .
Le
TO PREVENT INJURIES, INSURE THAT ALL ARE CLEAR BEFORE MOVING TRACTOR .
WARNING
1.
PERSONNEL
Tractor should be positioned no more than 4 feet ( 1.22 meters) from semitrailer so that 28-volt power cable does not get grease on it.
NOTES 2.
This is a two crewmember task . One crewmember drives truck. One crewmember is beside front of semitrailer to assist in coupling .
a.
Pull out fifth wheel secondary lock release handle all the way and hook in out position .
SECONDARY LOCK
RELEASE
FIFTH WHEEL TAIL RAMPS GUIDE RAMP
PRIMARY LOCK RELEASE
ROADSIDE
b. C.
Pull out fifth wheel primary release handle all the way. Push down fifth wheel tail ramps so that ramps are level with or below guide ramps.
CONTINUED
2-256
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 . 4
MARCH ORDER - Continued —
Continued .
d.
Remove chock blocks from stowage and chock semitrailer wheels as follows :
(1 )
If LS is facing uphill , place chock blocks behind rear wheels , both roadside .
curbside
CHOCK BLOCK STOWAGE
and
CHOCK BOTH SIDES
ROADSIDE CHOCK BOTH SIDES
(2)
If LS is facing downhill, place chock blocks in front of rear wheels ,
both
curbside
and
roadside .
ROADSIDE
(3)
If LS is on level , place one chock block in front of curbside rear wheel and one chock block in back of roadside rear wheel. CURBSIDE ONLY
ROADSIDE ONLY
ROADSIDE
NOTE
Through remainder of this procedure , chock block will be shown for LS in level position only . Chock as described in step d.
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-256.1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30.
MARCH ORDER - Continued -
4
Continued.
INSURE THAT ALL PERSONNEL ARE CLEAR BEFORE MOVING TRACTOR. DEATH OR SERIOUS INJURY CAN RESULT WARNING
IF STRUCK BY TRACTOR .
BE CAREFUL NOT TO RUN KINGPIN UP GUIDE RAMPS OR DAMAGE TO KINGPIN , GUIDE RAMPS OR FIFTH WHEEL MAY RESULT.
CAUTION
e. f.
Remove chock blocks from tractor rear wheels. Drive tractor to emplaced site . One crewmember guide driver in backing tractor slowly to front of semitrailer.
CURBSIDE
g.
With crewmember guiding , tractor fifth wheel jaws.
maneuver tractor to aline semitrailer kingpin with
TRACTOR WHEELS MUST BE CHOCKED
BEFORE
DRIVER
La LEAVES CAB .
DEATH
OR
SERIOUS
INJURY
CAN
BE
WARNING CAUSED BY RUNAWAY TRACTOR .
CONTINUED)
2-256.2
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30.
MARCH ORDER - Continued -
4
h.
Continued .
Pull out tractor PARKING
BRAKE control ,
place transmission range selector
lever in neutral ( N) , and leave engine running . i.
Remove chock blocks from stowage in tractor roadside stowage box and chock tractor rear wheels as follows:
(1 )
STOWAGE
If tractor is facing uphill , place chock blocks behind tractor rear wheels , both curbside and
CHOCK BOTH SIDES
roadside .
ROADSIDE
CHOCK BOTH SIDES (2)
If tractor is facing downhill , place chock blocks in front of rear wheels, both curbside and roadside .
ROADSIDE
ROADSIDE ONLY
(3)
If tractor is level , place chock block in front of rear wheel on curbside and behind rear wheel
CURBSIDE ONLY
on roadside .
ROADSIDE
Through remainder of this procedure , chock blocks will be shown for tractor as
in
level
position
above
unless grade
is shown.
NOTE
Chock as described in step i .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-257
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
MARCH ORDER - Continued
5
PREPARE DLTM A2 FOR ROADMARCH .
a.
Remove padlock and open DLTM A2 doors . If wind is over 45 knots , insert locking pin in hole at top of door.
B 788 00 000
b.
On Computer-To -Communications Interface Processor (CCIP) A2A2, TEST switch to TEST
DLT TEST
set DLT
Θ
TEST
TEST MODE
PROCESSORCONTROL
(3) NORMAL
WARNING
8 88 89
TO PREVENT INJURY, MAKE SURE AREA IS CLEAR BEFORE LOWERING PLATFORM .
MAKE
SURE
THAT
GUARD
RAIL
IS
NOT
INSTALLED
AROUND GENERATOR SET BEFORE LOWERING LAUNCHER PLATFORM OR EQUIPMENT DAMAGE MAY OCCUR .
CAUTION
2-258
Change 1
CONTINUED
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
6
MARCH ORDER - Continued
LOWER LAUNCHER PLATFORM .
a.
Set engagement control handle to ELEV.
ROADSIDE
ELEV
ROTATE
ROADMARCH
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-258.1 /(2-258.2 blank)
TM 9-1440-600-10
MARCH ORDER- Continued
6
b.
Continued . PLATFORM RAISED
AZIMUTH READY
O
O
Verify that AZIMUTH READY light Panel
on LCU Display goes out.
A1A14
RAISE STOP
LWR START
NOTE
RAISE- STOP - LWR
Launcher platform can be stopped by setting switch to STOP.
10
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT BITE
momen-
steadyrest and stop.
PLATFORM
O
LAUNCHING STA
RAISED
light is off.
STOP
START
RASE- STOP - LWR switch to STOP.
Set
O DISC
DASC O
f.
RAISE
0| 0 | 0 |0 MISSA BASCOM NECTED 이이 이이
O
Verify that
101
Ø
e.
ASSA! MADY
O
LCNR PLATFORSA RAISED AZARUTH READY READY
lower to
O
up
will
Ο
tarily .
Platform
! O
START switch
VEX VEXC UPPER MISSILE NAZARD
O
Hold
PLATFORM
O
-LAUNCHER LOCAL
LWR d.
POWER SUPPLIES
RAISE- STOP - LWR switch to
! O
Set
O
C.
e
2-30.
FIRINGPLATOON BITETEST STATUS DEF STATUS
O OFF
AZIMUTH GEAR TRAIN MAY BE DAMAGED IF ENGAGEMENT
CANTI
CONTROL HANDLE IS WHILE TRAVELING .
NOT IN
ROAD
MARCH POSITION
CONTINUED
T
2-259
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-30 .
MARCH ORDER- Continued -
6
Continued . ELEV
ROTATE
g.
Set engagement control handle to ROADMARCH ROADMARCH
CONNECT TRACTOR AIR LINES AND ELECTRICAL CABLES TO SEMITRAILER. 7
a.
Remove dummy coupling from
semitrailer
SERVICE
and
EMERGENCY air
brake line connectors.
b.
Remove captive dust cover from Semitrailer Connector 42W2P1
192
A
AWJ
dr ythe Bid ei tripil
BIAR
CURBSIDE
CONTINUED
2-260
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30.
MARCH ORDER - Continued
7
C.
Continued .
Remove outrigger cable and inter-
BATTERY
vehicular light cable from tractor
BOX
roadside stowage box .
d.
Connect outrigger cable to tractor slave connector .
SLAVE CONNECTOR
OUTRIGGER CABLE
CURBSIDE
c
c
e
L
c
c
ec
c
c
c
c
e.
s
s
e
c
c
f.
Route outrigger cable across rear of tractor to connector tree. Connect intervehicular light cable to receptacle on base of connector tree .
g.
Fasten
both
electrical
cables to
top of connector tree.
ny
an
an n
INTERVEHICULAR LIGHT CABLE
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-261
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
MARCH ORDER - Continued —
7
Disconnect air
c c c c c c c c e c c e e c c e e c c o a)
h.
Continued .
brake lines from
dummy glad hand connector tree.
couplings on
) )) )
DUMMY COUPLING SEMITRA
VERGENC
CURBSIDE
i.
Carefully route cables and air brake lines from tractor to semitrailer .
Be
careful
not to
get
grease from fifth wheel on lines or cables . j.
Connect blue air brake line to SERVICE coupling on semitrailer. Connect red air brake line to EMERGENCY coupling on semitrailer.
CONTINUED
2-262
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
MARCH ORDER - Continued
— 7
k.
Continued .
Connect intervehicular light cable from tractor to Semitrailer Connector 42W2P1 .
I.
Connect outrigger service cable to its semitrailer connector, and lock in place with spring retainer.
m.
In tractor cab, push in TRACTOR AIR SUPPLY control.
n.
Make sure air lines and electrical cables are supported and will not catch or chafe .
8
MAIN POWER DC AC
RUN TIME
At Power Control Panel (PCP) A1A3, raise cover and set MAIN POWER DC CB2 to ON .
M1
• CREWMEMBERS
ON
LS
MUST
Θ
CB2 CB1 O →
BE WATCHED
BY OTHER
Le CREWMEMBERS
AND WARNED OF ANY
UNSAFE
CONDI-
WARNINGS TIONS TO PREVENT INJURY.
• DATA LINK MAST ASSEMBLY MAY BE HOT. USE PROTECTIVE
GLOVES
IF
NECESSARY TO PREVENT INJURY TO
HANDS.
HANDLE ANTENNA CAREFULLY TO PREVENT DAMAGE .
CAUTION
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-263
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
MARCH ORDER - Continued -
Continued .
8
Be alert at night . Insure that working area is clear before starting . Make all movements sure and deliberate . Do not rush .
NOTE
9
STOW DATA LINK MAST ASSEMBLY.
Two crewmembers are needed to perform this procedure , one NOTE
a.
on roadside work platform front roadside outrigger.
by Generator Set A6 and one on
Remove dust cap from dummy connector on flange of Upper Mast A7A12.
LOWER MAST
UPPER MAST
ROADSIDE
CONTINUED
2-264
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 . 9
MARCH ORDER - Continued -
Continued . LOWER MAST-
b.
Disconnect Cable A7A12W1P2 UPPER MAST
from RF Adapter A7A11J1 .
C.
Connect Cable
A7A12W1P2 to
Dummy connector on flange of LOWER MAST-
Upper Mast A7A12. d.
Install dust cap on
RF Adapter
A7A11J1 .
UPPER MAST
LOWER MAST SPRING CLIP
e.
Disconnect
Ground
Cable
A7A12W2 from Ground Connector A7A11J2 .
UPPER MAST f.
Stow Ground Cable A7A12W2 in spring clip on upper mast .
CONTINUED
2-265
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30.
MARCH ORDER - Continued -
9
g.
Continued .
Both crewmembers together , slide Upper Mast Assembly A7A12 out of Lower Mast Assembly A7A11 .
LOWER MAST-
UPPER MAST
h.
Rest upper mast in front cradle .
Crewmember on work platform hold upper
mast in place. Crewmember on outrigger climb to work platform over wheels.
ROADSIDE
CONTINUED
2-266
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
MARCH ORDER - Continued
-
Continued .
9
Release two hood latches and open front and rear cradle clamps.
i.
CLAMP UPPER MAST
HOOD LATCH CRADLE LOWER MAST
ROADSIDE
3
j.
Both crewmembers together, move upper mast to stow position . Place upper mast in cradle clamps .
k.
Close clamps on front and rear cradles and secure with hood latches.
CONTINUED
2-267
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-30. 10
MARCH ORDER - Continued SECURE TRAVEL LOCKPINS AND ROADSIDE WORK PLATFORMS .
Remove travel lockpin from bracket on roadside steadyrest .
a.
AJO
H BJOARD
ROADSIDE TEAM RBWOJ
ف ة ن
b.
Press and hold lockpin pushbutton .
C.
Insert lockpin through hole in platform and steadyrest .
d.
Release lockpin pushbutton .
CONTINUED
2-268
TM 9-1440-600-10
MARCH ORDER - Continued
2-30 .
10
-
e.
Continued .
Raise and fold over roadside side work platform .
HOOD LATCH
SIDE WORK PLATFORM
TYPICAL 2 PLACES
FENDER WORK PLATFORM ROADSIDE
11
f.
Secure work platform with hood latch at front end .
g.
Raise and fold over fender work platform .
h.
Secure work platform with hood latch at rear end .
i.
Install curbside travel lockpin.
DEENERGIZE LEM - PDU A1A2 .
a.
Open
LEM
A1
left- hand
door.
If wind is over 45 knots ,
insert
locking
pin
in hole at top of door.
CONTINUED
2-269
TM 9-1440-600-10
MARCH ORDER - Continued
2-30 .
11
Continued .
b.
In sequence listed below,
set the following
controls
on
LEM - PDU A1A2 to
OFF.
1
3
4
UPR R MSL
UPR L MSL
5
( 2 LWR L MSL
LWR R MSL
ON
OFF
+
+
ON
OFF
OFF
O O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT Θ Θ
ON
BLOWER OFF
+
ON
OFF
O LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC, MAINA ON
9
MOT CONT UNIT AC
MSL GYRO/CLOCK PWR SPLY
(11):
10
+
7
6
LAMPS
Θ OFF
OFF
OFF
O Θ
ON
O
OFF
2 ON
OFF
O
ON
O
O
OFF
10
11
MSL 5 VDC PWR SPLY
OFF
9
OFF
58
OFF
3
OFF
13) (12) ON OFF OFF
ON
4
OFF
OFF
8
O Θ
MSL PAFUДITL PWR SPLY
BLOWER
→
ON
7
MSL TWT FIL PWR SPLY
+
+
ON
OFF
OFF
6
+
+
ON
Θ
CNVC OUT CANISTER HTR AC
+
13
12
LCHR ELEX 28 VDC PWR SPLY ON
OFF
+
ORD PWR SPLY
+
ON
OFF
+
LCHR ELEX 5 VDC PWR SPLY +
ON
OFF
CONTINUED
2-270
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30.
MARCH ORDER - Continued -
11
Continued.
15
14
O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT
MAIN B +
ON
Θ
+
MAIN A
BLOWER OFF
ON
LAUNC OFF
16
ORD PWRSPLY ON OFF
CNVCOUT CANISTERNTR
MOTCONT UNIT AC ON OFF
LAMPS
BLOWER
OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC, UPR & MOL UPRAMEL O ON V OFF
14
OFF
OFF
LOHRELEX SPLY PARSVDC ON OFF
17
RONCS AC. 15
16
OFF
OFF
LCHRELEX 28VDC FWR SPLY ON OFF
OFF
GYROCLOCK PWB SPLY ON OFF
PAFUSTL PWR SPLY
TWITFIL PWRSPLY
MBL&VOC PWRSPLY
CWN &MSL OFF
LWRRMSL ON OFF 17 ON OFF TEST
OFF
G
+
ON
+
ON + OFF
O OFF
C.
O
O
O
O
TEST
Close and secure both
LEM
A1
doors.
d.
Roll down and secure air exhaust cover on left side of LEM A1 . CONTINUED
2-271
TM 9-1440-600-10
MARCH ORDER - Continued
2-30 .
12
DEENERGIZE DLTM- PDU A2A4.
a.
In sequence listed below, set the following controls on DLTM -PDU A2A4 to
OFF
1
0 O NK TERM MDL POWER DISTR
CNVC OUT
OFF
O
+
O
CLK PWR ON
b.
PWR SPLY ON +
ON
3 OFF
O о
+
OFF
OFF
4
OFF
13
OFF
O
51
ON 6 TEST 5 OFF Θ O O
3
+
DGTL PROCESSOR
2 G
G
OFF
4
2
6
5
MAIN A ON +
Θ
OFF
LAMPS
BLOWER ON
ON OFF TEST
OFF
Close and secure both DLTM A2 doors . Lock left door with padlock .
AT PCP A1A3, RAISE COVER AND SET MAIN
MAIN POWER DC AC Θ
POWER - AC CB1 TO RUN TIME
OFF .
CB2
M1 Ꮎ
CONTINUED
2-272
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
14
MARCH ORDER- Continued
OPEN GENERATOR SET A6 CIRCUIT BREAKER .
a.
Open and latch Generator Set A6 control cubicle doors.
b.
Hold CKT BRK switch to open until CKT BRK light goes off.
O
O
ENGINE
O
FAULTINDICATOR
GENERATOR
O O CKT BRK CKT BRK CLOSE
Le WARNING
ED
OPEN
DCCONTROL BREAKER CIRCUIT PULLFOR EMERGENCY STOP
TO PREVENT INJURY, DO NOT STEP ON LS CABLES OR CABLE BUNDLES .
CONTINUED
2-273
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
MARCH ORDER - Continued
NOTE
15
Be alert at night. Insure that working area is clear before starting . Make all movements sure and deliberate . Do not rush .
SECURE LEM A1 AND DLTM A2 AIR INLET AND AIR EXHAUST COVERS.
a.
At rear of each module , untie each cover .
Secure each cover with six snap
fasteners at bottom and sides.
DIOFT
TYPICAL LEM A1 DLTM A2
b.
On right side of LEM A1
and on both sides of DLTM A2 , untie each cover.
Secure each cover with eight snap fasteners at bottom and sides .
CONTINUED
2-274
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
MARCH ORDER - Continued
1.
At night crewmembers must be very careful to coordinate work and signals while raising outriggers and coupling tractor to semitrailer.
Use lights to insure that area is clear before
starting .
Use lights as signals. Make all movements sure and deliberate . Do not rush .
NOTES 2.
One crewmember operate outriggers at
control panel .
Another
crewmember observe outrigger movements and semitrailer conditions . The observer signals operator when area is clear and keeps operator informed of outrigger position and semitrailer condition .
16
RAISE OUTRIGGERS.
KEEP FINGERS OUTSIDE OUTRIGGER CONTROL BOX COV-
Le ER UNTIL IT IS LOCKED OPEN . COVER SNAPS OPEN AND WARNING
a.
CAN INJURE FINGERS.
Remove locking
hook from
out-
rigger control box handle.
b.
Turn handle ccw and open cover with gentle pull on handle.
CURBSIDE
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-275
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30.
MARCH ORDER - Continued
— 16
Continued .
OUTRIGGERS C.
Lower cover until spring
loaded
plungers engage rods and cover is locked open .
d.
Set POWER switch to ON . Verify that leveling light comes on.
VERIFY THAT AREA IS CLEAR BEFORE OPERATING OUTLe RIGGERS . INJURY OR DEATH COULD RESULT IF STRUCK WARNING BY OUTRIGGER .
•TO PREVENT TWISTING SEMITRAILER FRAME, DO NOT OPERATE DIAGONAL PAIRS OF OUTRIGGERS AT SAME TIME . CAUTIONS
• VERIFY THAT
OUTRIGGER
LIMIT SWITCHES
ARE
FREE
FROM DEBRIS , MUD , OR OTHER SUBSTANCES THAT COULD PREVENT PROPER OPERATION OF SWITCHES.
For uneven sites , outriggers may have to be operated one at a time. NOTE
Use single control switch
if
required .
Upper switches
control roadside outriggers . Lower switches control curbside outriggers .
CONTINUED
2-276
Change 1
2-30 .
16
MARCH ORDER - Continued
-
Continued .
OFF
ON e.
POWER
Using two REAR rear outriggers
switches, raise until they clear
ground .
REAR OUTRIGGERS FRONT
f.
Verify that semitrailer rear wheels are chocked on both curbside and roadside .
CURBSIDE
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-277
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
MARCH ORDER - Continued
—
Continued.
16
g.
Using two FRONT outrigger switches, adjust height of semitrailer to aline kingpin with tractor fifth wheel ramp .
FIFTH WHEEL RAMP
0
KINGPIN CURBSIDE
17
COUPLE TRACTOR TO SEMITRAILER AND RAISE OUTRIGGERS .
DO
NOT
STAND
BETWEEN
TRACTOR
AND
SEMITRAILER
L WHEN GUIDING TRACTOR TO COUPLE WITH SEMITRAILER. WARNING YOU COULD BE SERIOUSLY INJURED OR KILLED .
One crewmember drive tractor. Another crewmember watch couNOTE pling and guide driver.
a.
Verify that:
(1 )
Tractor fifth wheel ramp is alined with LS kingpin plate .
(2)
Electrical cables and airlines are clear.
(3)
Working area is clear.
CONTINUED
2-278
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30. 17
MARCH ORDER - Continued —
Continued.
TO PREVENT WARNING
b.
INJURIES,
INSURE
THAT ALL
PERSONNEL
ARE CLEAR BEFORE MOVING TRACTOR .
Remove chock blocks from tractor rear wheels and
stow in tractor
STOWAGE
roadside stowage box.
ROADSIDE
C.
Slowly back tractor under semitrailer so that tractor fifth wheel jaws are alined with LS kingpin .
d.
Check that front of semitrailer is
1000
on the guide semitrailer
ramps and
height
as
adjust
needed
0
using forward outriggers .
Slowly continue to back tractor until fifth wheel jaws lock around kingpin . f.
Visually check that kingpin is locked in fifth wheel and that light cannot be seen between fifth wheel and bottom of semitrailer.
g.
Check coupling by inching tractor forward . If coupling is not secure , rock semitrailer slowly back and forth until kingpin is locked in fifth wheel .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-278.1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
17
MARCH ORDER - Continued
-
h.
Continued.
Push in primary lock release handle all the way.
SECONDARY LOCK
RELEASE
FIFTH WHEEL TAIL RAMPS GUIDE RAMP
PRIMARY LOCK RELEASE
ROADSIDE
i.
Unhook secondary lock release handle and push in all the way.
j.
In cab of tractor:
(1 )
Place transmission range selector lever in neutral ( N) .
(2)
Push trailer handbrake control all the way forward to OFF position .
(3)
Pull out PARKING BRAKE control ; leave engine running .
CONTINUED
2-278.2
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30 .
MARCH ORDER - Continued -
17
Continued .
Secure gooseneck curbside and roadside work platforms .
k.
(1 )
Raise and hold platform latch handle.
(2)
Raise platform .
(3)
Release latch handle.
ROADSIDE
k.1 .
Pick up and stow roadside and curbside semitrailer chock blocks .
k.2.
Insure that area is clear.
NOTE
Outrigger drive motors automatically stop when outriggers raised to travel position .
are
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-279
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-30.
MARCH ORDER - Continued -
17
1.
Continued .
At outrigger control
panel ,
hold
the two REAR outrigger switches
OFF until outriggers are in travel position . m.
Hold the two
FRONT outrigger
switches up until outriggers are in travel position .
n.
ON
POWER
REAR OUTRIGGERS FRONT
Set POWER switch to OFF.
La
KEEP
FINGERS
OUTSIDE
WHILE CLOSING COVER .
OUTRIGGER CONTROL BOX COVER SNAPS SHUT AND CAN
WARNING INJURE FINGERS .
Close and secure outrigger control panel cover.
p.
Connect safety chain snap hooks to all four outriggers .
T FOR RAVEL O TACTIL NCOACL K
O.
о о
CONTINUED
2-280
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-30.
18
MARCH ORDER - Continued
SHUT DOWN GENERATOR SET A6. START
a.
RUN
After 3 minutes operation with no load applied, set Generator Set A6 START- RUN - STOP switch to STOP.
b.
STOP
Verify that engine stops. FAULT INDICATOR ®
GENERATOR
ENGINE O
о
9 ㅎ
оо
OPERATION
お
BUTTLEGUY
O
Ο
C.
OCCONTROL CIRCUIT BREAKER PULLFOR EMERGENCY STOP
Close control cubicle and air vent doors.
GROUNDING CABLE 42W3 19
PREPARE FOR ROAD MARCH .
a.
Loosen ground rod clamp and disconnect Grounding from ground rod .
Cable 42W3
GROUND CLAMP
CONTINUED
2-281
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-30 . 19
MARCH ORDER - Continued
-
Continued .
b.
Disconnect Grounding Cable 42W3 from semitrailer Connector 42J3.
42J3
42W3
ROADSIDE
ROADSIDE STOWAGE BOX
20
Y
C.
Remove upper section of ground rod .
d.
Stow ground rod and Grounding Cable 42W3 in LS roadside stowage box .
PREPARE TRACTOR FOR ROAD MARCH . One crewmember enter cab and turn on lights . One crewmember verify that
a.
all tractor and semitrailer lights work.
b.
Check semitrailer brake operation :
Before moving tractor, insure that AIR
(1 )
PRESS gage indicates at least 100
psi (690 kPa). (2)
Pull trailer hand brake control all the way back to ON position .
(3)
Push in tractor PARKING BRAKE control .
(4)
Driver move tractor and trailer forward while crewmember observes semitrailer wheels to verify brakes are locked .
(5)
2-282
Stop tractor and semitrailer .
C.
Verify that semitrailer to tractor coupling is secure .
d.
All crewmembers enter tractor cab and await march order.
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD
Personnel Required . Five Tools and Equipment Required . Guided Missile Transporter (GMT) Wrecker, M819 Plug , Shorting (4) ( 10252731 ) Socket, Deep 12- point , 3/4- In . , 1 /2-In . Drive Head , Ratchet, 1 /2- In . Drive Handle, Torque Wrench , 30-150 Foot- Pound Extension , 1 /2- In . Drive , 30- In . Long Test Set, Missile Round Cable (MRCTS)
Tape, Measuring , 100 - Foot Gloves, Work (1 Pair For Each Crewmember) (JJ -G -451-1-1B) Cable, Ground 27W1 ( 10253338) Taglines (2) ( 10252950)
Usually each canister removed from the launching station ( LS) is empty. Under certain conditions , live rounds
may be unloaded from_the_LS. When live
from the LS , the sling must be used in the LOADED be grounded when
it is
positioned
rounds are
removed
position , and the live round must
on the GMT. Warnings
regarding
sling
use are in
the procedure . These precautions must be strictly observed to prevent serious injury or possible death to crewmembers .
Canisters removed from the
LS may or may not be loaded onto the GMT.
Steps
for loading the canisters onto the GMT are included if required .
Crewmembers must be especially alert to prevent injury during bad weather and darkness. Anti -skid compound is on most working surfaces.
However, all surfaces must be
considered slippery when wet. All crewmembers must follow the safety rules listed below, U.S. Army directives, and standard operating procedures (SOP) as a minimum .
CONTINUED
T
2-283
TM 9-1440-600-10
33
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
Stand well clear of hoisted loads.
When climbing up or down ,
insure solid footing and solid handholds before
transferring body weight.
•
Keep hands,
arms ,
and feet clear of loads .
Be
extra careful when
guided
missile (GM) is lowered onto alining pins.
Do not leave tools and equipment unattended . When not in use , stow them.
Know the location
of all
crewmembers when
moving
loads.
When
working
together, do not leave a task without the other crewmember's knowledge . Check that the load certification date on all hoisting equipment (slings, etc.) has not expired .
Check that grounding cables are properly connected and that grounding hardware is clean.
Check that the torque tube
handle on
each
loaded
canister is
locked and
the quick release pin is installed before moving the GM . The missile is free to move in the canister unless it is locked .
Install grounds on all live GMs at the earliest opportunity.
•
Verify that the crane hook has a safety retainer in good operating condition .
Insure that all hoisting hooks and tag lines are firmly connected to the load.
CONTINUED)
2-284
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
Do not try to do two- person jobs alone . Get help .
•
Signals to the crane operator must be given by one designated crewmember. This crewmember must always be visible to the crane operator. If the crane operator loses sight of the signalling crewmember, crane motion must be immediately stopped .
Use
signals
per FM
21-60 . All
signals
must
be
clearly
understood by the crane operator and the crewmembers before starting the reload.
•
Handling
GMs
in
high
and
gusty wind
requires
extra
precautions .
Empty
canisters are more difficult to handle in wind than loaded ones. During windy conditions use more than one crewmember on each tag line . • Observe all warnings the equipment .
•
and
cautions
in the
procedure
and those
marked on
Make all actions sure and deliberate .
Wear work gloves and protective helmets .
Reload procedures are the same under daylight ,
nighttime , and blackout conditions .
Nighttime does not always mean blackout . When blackout conditions are in effect blackout flashlights must be used . At night when blackout conditions are not in effect any approved light may be used .
Operating signals between the signal person and the crane operator must be performed with lights .
Crewmembers other than the signal
person
must be careful to insure that
their lights do not interfere with the signals . The following general rules must be observed when reloading under blackout or nighttime conditions .
•
Read, understand , and comply with safety rules listed above .
Use signals per FM 21-60.
CONTINUED
2-285
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
Use flashlights to see with .
•
Do not move vehicles without a guide .
When light is limited , guides must be used to direct the driver to position the reload vehicles. General rules for guides are:
•
Inspect the paths the vehicles must follow for soft spots, shoulders, and obstructions .
Describe the approach to the driver.
•
The guide's position
is left-front of the vehicle ,
at a safe distance from the
vehicle, in sight of the driver. If visibility is bad use two guides , one in front and one by the side of the driver.
Do not lose eye contact with the driver. If eye contact is lost the driver must stop the vehicle .
Various vehicle positions may be used to reload . The positions shown in the following three figures have been found to be the best for level ground and sloping ground . The vehicle positions shown are typical . The GMT and wrecker may be positioned on either side of the LS. so ,
Site conditions
may force vehicle
extend the wrecker outriggers and
positioning the wrecker,
positions other than those shown . If
attach the GMT sling to the crane hook before
or verify that these actions can be performed after positioning .
Exhaust fumes from the wrecker engine can be annoying and possibly dangerous . Fume annoyance may be eased by parking the wrecker with the exhaust downwind from the LS and GMT if possible .
LS crewmembers must select and mark off vehicle positions best suited for the reload before the wrecker and GMT arrive . Mark the positions well . Appoint a guide or guides for the wrecker driver and refer to the general rules for guides listed above .
CONTINUED
2-286
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
GUIDED MISSILE TRANSPORTER
口
CANISTER CENTER OF BALANCE
WRECKER
B 9'
A 34'-35' NOTE 1
LAUNCHING STATION
C 9'
| LINE X
CANISTER CENTER OF BALANCE
DIMENSIONS (NOTE 1 ) CONDITION
A
B
LEVEL GROUND
APPROX 34-35 FEET
8-9 FEET WRECKER TIRE TO TRAILER SIDE
UP OR DOWN SLOPE
APPROX 34-35 FEET
CROSS SLOPE
APPROX 34-35 FEET
8-9 FEET LAUNCHER WRECKER TIRE-TO-TIRE
(NOTES 2 AND 3) ( NOTES 2 AND 3)
NOTES: 1. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE FROM VEHICLE FRAMES AT APPROXIMATE CENTER LINE. 2. WRECKER AND GMT SHOULD BE POSITIONED DOWNHILL FROM LS WHEN ON A SLOPE IF POSSIBLE . 3. VEHICLE ON HIGH SIDE SHOULD BE 7-8 FEET FROM WRECKER . VEHICLE ON LOW SIDE SHOULD BE 9-10 FEET FROM WRECKER . CONTINUED
2-287
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
G
WRECKER
LAUNCHING STATION
1. OBSERVE FOLLOWING WHEN PLACING EMPTY CANISTERS ON GROUND : A. EXTEND WRECKER BOOM TO MAXIMUM LENGTH TO GET CANISTERS OUT OF WAY. B. PLACE CANISTERS OUT OF PATH LIVE GM'S WILL TRAVEL BETWEEN GMT AND LS. 2. IF POSSIBLE , DO NOT MOVE LIVE GM'S OVER EMPTY CANISTERS ON GROUND .
GUIDED MISSILE TRANSPORTER
CONTINUED
2-288
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
WRECKER LAUNCHING STATION
TWO-STACK OFFLOAD
GUIDED MISSILE TRANSPORTER
1. OBSERVE THE FOLLOWING WHEN PLACING EMPTY TWO-STACK ON THE GROUND : A. MAKE SURE WHEN SETTING A TWO-STACK ON A SLOPE THAT IT POINTS IN AN UPHILL/DOWNHILL DIRECTION. B. EXTEND WRECKER BOOM TO MAXIMUM LENGTH TO GET CANISTERS OUT OF THE WAY. C. PLACE CANISTERS OUT OF PATH THAT LIVE GM'S WILL TRAVEL BETWEEN GMT AND LS. 2. IF POSSIBLE , DO NOT MOVE LIVE GM'S OVER EMPTY CANISTERS ON THE GROUND.
CONTINUED
2-289
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
GENERATOR SET A6
MISSILE ROUND CABLE TEST SET A8
DATA LINK TERMINAL MODULE A2
LAUNCHER MECHANICS
CURBSIDE
LAUNCHER MISSILE ROUND DISTRIBUTOR A3
GUIDED MISSILE (ONE OF FOUR)
DATA LINK MAST ASSEMBLY
ROADSIDE
LAUNCHER ELECTRONICS MODULE A1 ENGAGEMENT CONTROL HANDLE
CONTINUED
2-290
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
The LS must be emplaced , outriggers extended , and the LS leveled to reload . Electrical power is not required after the platform is lowered until the MRCTS is used , unless the data link terminal ( DLT) clock has to remain synchronized .
DO NOT RELOAD GUIDED MISSILES DURING ELECTRICAL
WARNING
STORMS. DEATH MAY RESULT FROM LIGHTNING STRIKES.
MISSILES
DROPPED ACCIDENTLY
MAY
BE
DANGEROUS .
REPORT ANY DROP OF 12 INCHES OR MORE IMMEDIATELY AND PROCEED AS FOLLOWS. •
IF MISSILE IS STILL IN CANISTER, CONSIDER MISSILE TO BE UNARMED . DO NOT MOVE MISSILE FOR 1 HOUR AFTER INCIDENT. AFTER 1 HOUR, UNIT COMMANDER MAY DIRECT MISSILE TO BE RE-
WARNING
MOVED TO DEPOT. •
IF
MISSILE IS
PARTLY
OR
COMPLETELY OUT OF
CANISTER , CONSIDER MISSILE TO BE ARMED . TELL YOUR UNIT COMMANDER AND LEAVE AREA. DEATH MAY RESULT FROM EXPLOSION .
MISSILE WARNING
MISFIRE
MAY RELEASE
EXPLOSIVE
HYDROGEN
GAS INTO CANISTER . AFTER A MISFIRE , DO NOT GO NEAR CANISTER FOR 1 HOUR . DEATH MAY RESULT.
MISSILE
MISFIRE
MAY RELEASE CORROSIVE
POTASSIUM
HYDROXIDE FROM BATTERIES INTO CANISTER . THIS LIQ-
WARNING
UID CAN BURN YOU . HANDLE CANISTERS WITH CARE .
CONTINUED
2-291
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
STAY CLEAR OF LAUNCHER MECHANICS PLANE OF ROTATION UNTIL IS SET TO
KEYSWITCH ON LCU DISPLAY PANEL A1A14 LOCAL, LOCAL LIGHT IS ON, AND KEY IS RE-
MOVED. WHEN KEYSWITCH IS SET TO RMT, TURNTABLE CAN BE ROTATED REMOTELY CAUSING INJURY TO PER-
WARNING
SONNEL WITHIN PLANE OF ROTATION.
A DAMAGED CANISTER CAN INDICATE AN UNUSABLE MISSILE . REPORT ANY CANISTER DAMAGE IMMEDIATELY. UNIT COMMANDER WILL DECIDE IF MISSILE IS TO BE REPLACED OR USED. CAUTION
DO NOT MOVE GM WITHIN 50 FEET OF AN
RF SOURCE
THAT RADIATES 50 WATTS OR MORE .
CAUTION
LS crewmembers GMT arrive .
NOTE
1
perform steps
1
thru 4 before wrecker and
PREPARE LS FOR RELOAD .
a.
All crewmembers read and understand the above .
b.
general
information
Open Launcher Electronics Module
( LEM ) A1
doors .
If wind is
over 45 knots , insert locking pin in hole at top of door.
CONTINUED
2-292
TM 9-1440-600-10
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
On LCU Display Panel A1A14 , select local mode.
Set LOCAL - RMT switch to LOCAL.
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT
LAUNCHERLOCAL
0
Remove key from LOCAL - RMT switch .
PLATFORM
POWER SUPPLIES O O VDIC VDC MISSILE UPPERL UPPERA HAZARD 0000
о
(3)
Verify that LOCAL light comes on .
O
BITE (2)
O
(1 )
READY 0 | 0 |0 | 0 LOHR PLATFORM RAISED AZMUTH READY READY OOO DISCON NECTED 이이 이이
O
RAIST
STOP
O
101
LAUNCHING STA
O
C.
Continued
CONNECT CONNECT OOOO EPSC ODO O
START Ο
O
1
FIRINGPLATOON
LO
CA
L O
O
NORMALLAMPS PANEL LAN BITE TEST STATUS DIM OFF STATUS LAMPTEST
O
2-31 .
RM
O
T
GM IS FREE TO MOVE IN CANISTER IF TORQUE TUBE HANDLE IS NOT PROPERLY LOCKED . SUDDEN STOPS ON ROAD MARCH COULD CAUSE MISSILE TO PENETRATE TRACTOR WARNING CAB, RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
1.
Omit step d if there are no live GMs on LS.
2.
Lock GMs
NOTES in following order:
Upper Right
( UR) ,
Lower Right
(LR) , Upper Left ( UL) , Lower Left ( LL) .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-293
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
— 1
Continued .
d.
Lock GM torque tube handle on each live canister on LS.
Have a crewmember at LCU Display Panel A1A14 observe MISSILE READYlights while GM torque tube handles are being locked .
NOTE
(1 )
Remove quick release torque tube handle .
(2)
Pull out and hold spring - loaded plunger while
rotating
pin by
torque
tube handle cw to LOCK position . (3)
Release
plunger .
Check that
plunger seats in left detent hole to secure torque tube handle .
DESSICANT HOLDER
RECORDSH (4)
Check that no red paint shows
J2
to left of torque tube handle .
LOCK
OCK
UNL
DO NOT LATCH OR UNLATCH UNLESS GM ELEVATED
PULL
(5)
VALVE RELIEF PUSHTO RELEASE PRESSURE O о
Insert quick- release pin in hole to right of torque tube handle .
O DESSICANT HOLDER
RECORDS
J2
(6)
Check with
UNLOCK
DO NOT LATCH OR UNLATCH UNLESS GM ELEVATED
RELIEF VALVE PUSHTO RELEASE PRESSURE
crewmember at
LCU Display Panel A1A14 that MISSILE READY light at correct GM position went out.
CONTINUED
2-294
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
Continued .
1
(7)
Repeat steps ( 1 ) thru (6) for each remaining live GM on LS.
VERIFY THAT AREA IS CLEAR BEFORE ROTATING TURNTABLE AND LOWERING PLATFORM . INJURY OR DEATH CAN WARNING RESULT IF STRUCK BY MOVING MASS.
e.
If it is not already in
180° position ,
electrically rotate launcher mechanics to
180° position per para 2-22.
VERIFY THAT GUARD RAIL IS GENERATOR
SET BEFORE
NOT INSTALLED
LOWERING
AROUND
LAUNCHER
PLAT-
FORM OR EQUIPMENT DAMAGE MAY RESULT. CAUTION
f.
If it is not already lowered to steadyrest position ,
electrically lower launcher
platform to steadyrest per para 2-20.
CURBSIDE CONTINUED
Change 1
2-295
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
1
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
Continued .
If
g.
electrical
power
is
required
and
Generator Set A6 is to be shut down ,
power-down the LS per para 2-11 . If electrical power is not required , deenergize LEM A1 per para 2-15 , Data Link Terminal Module ( DLTM) A2 per para 2-16, and Generator Set A6 per para 2-17.
2
STOW DATA LINK MAST ASSEMBLY.
Two crewmembers are needed to perform this procedure ,
NOTE
a.
on roadside work platform by Generator Set A6, front roadside outrigger.
one
and one on
Remove dust cap from dummy connector on flange of Upper Mast A7A12.
paint shor LOWER MAST
HUORA UPPER MAST
ROADSIDE
CONTINUED
2-296
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
LOWER MAST2
b.
Continued . UPPER MAST Disconnect
Cable
A7A12W1P2 from
Connector RF Adapter
A7A11J1 .
LOWER MAST
C.
UPPER MAST
Connect Cable
A7A12W1P2 to
dummy connector on flange of Upper Mast A7A12.
d.
Install dust cap on A7A11J1 .
RF Adapter
LOWER MAST SPRING CLIP e.
Disconnect
Ground
Cable
A7A12W2 from Ground Connector
UPPER MAST
A7A11J2 .
f.
Stow Ground Cable A7A12W2 in spring clip on upper mast flange .
CONTINUED
T
2-297
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
2
g.
Continued .
Both crewmembers together slide Upper Mast Assembly A7A12 out of Lower Mast A7A11 .
LOWER MAST
UPPER MAST
h.
Rest upper mast in front cradle. Crewmember on work platform hold
upper
mast
Crewmember on
in
place .
outrigger climb
to work platform over wheels .
ROADSIDE
i.
Release two hood latches and open front and rear cradle clamps .
CONTINUED
2-298
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
-
Continued .
2
Both crewmembers together move upper mast to stow position . mast in cradle clamps.
j.
Place upper
CLAMP
UPPER MAST
HOOD LATCH
CRADLE LOWER MAST
ROADSIDE
k.
Close clamps on front and cradles
and
secure with
rear hood
latches .
NOTE
Two crewmembers working from rear LS work platform disconnect LS cables from all four canisters using step below.
3
DISCONNECT GM CABLES .
SHORTING PLUG MUST BE CONNECTED TO EACH LIVE GM AT 4A1J1 IMMEDIATELY AFTER CABLE CONNECTOR IS DIS-
WARNING
CONNECTED . OTHERWISE STATIC CHARGES MAY EXPLODE ORDNANCE DEVICES, RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
CONTINUED
2-299
TM 9-1440-600-10
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued 2-31 .
3
Continued.
If GMs are live , get shorting plugs from dummy connectors on launcher me-
a. chanics (LM ) .
UR DUMMY CONNECTOR FARSIDE
LR DUMMY CONNECTOR
UL DUMMY, CONNECTOR
ROADSIDE
LL DUMMY CONNECTOR
Disconnect cables from canisters.
b. If GM is live, install shorting plug on 4A1J1 of each canister. CONNECTOR
CABLE
A5W1P1 - UL
(2)
UL J1
23W2P2
(1 )
UL J2 UL J3
A5W20P1
A5W2P1 - LL
(2)
LL J1
23W2P3
(1 )
LL J2 LL J3
A5W3P1 - UL
UR J1
23W3P2
UR J2
A5W22P1
UR J3
23
A5W21P1
-2 A5W4P1 - LR
(2)
LR J1
23W3P3
(1 )
LR J2
A5W23P1
(3)
LR J3
TYPICAL 4 PLACES
CONTINUED
2-300
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
Continued .
3
NOTE
Perform step c for upper canisters only.
C.
Loosen hand
knob and
remove
clamp assembly that secures upper canister canister.
cables to
lower
TYPICAL 2 PLACES
d.
Connect large GM signal cable to large dummy connector at applicable position .
D
grung
UR DUMMY CONNECTOR FARSIDE
LR DUMMY CONNECTOR
UL DUMMY CONNECTOR
ROADSIDE LL DUMMY CONNECTOR CONTINUED
2-301
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
3
e.
Continued
Connect canister heater cable to small dummy connector at applicable position .
f.
Install dust cover on ground cable . Stow cable in spring clip at applicable position .
1.
All measurements are from edge of LS frame . Do not measure from overhanging platforms .
NOTES 2.
Make all measurements three times, once from each end of LS and once at about the center. Join these three points to establish location lines.
CONTINUED
2-302
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
4
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued PLACE VEHICLE MARKERS .
a.
Measure location for GMT 34 to 35 feet ( 10.36 to
10.67 meters) from
LS
baseline . b.
Place markers on measured line to mark far side of GMT.
BASELINE
LAUNCHING STATION
GMT LOCATION LINE 34-35 FT (10.36-10.67M)
34-35 FT (10.36-10.67M)
CONTINUED
2-303
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
4
C.
Continued .
Measure location for wrecker as described below. Level ground - 8 to 9 feet (2.43 to 2.74 meters) from LS baseline. •
LS uphill from wrecker - 7 to 8 feet (2.13 to 2.45 meters) from LS baseline .
•
LS downhill from wrecker - 9 to 10 feet (2.74 to 3.05 meters) from LS baseline .
d.
Place markers on measured line to mark near side of wrecker.
BASELINE
WRECKER LOCATION LINE
LAUNCHING STATION
CONTINUED
2-304
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
1.
NOTES
erator. Other crewmember observe vehicle position and signal first commander. 2.
5
Two crewmembers assist wrecker operator to position GMT. One crewmember stay at roadside corner of wrecker and signal op-
Driver take signals from crewmember at corner of wrecker only.
POSITION GMT.
a.
Guide wrecker with GMT to marked GMT location .
Far side of GMT must
be on GMT location line . Aline GMT CANISTER CENTER OF BALANCE with LS CANISTER CENTER OF BALANCE . Stop wrecker when GMT is on markers and canister center lines are alined .
GMT LOCATION LINE GUIDED MISSILE TRANSPORTER
CANISTER CENTER OF BALANCE
CANISTER CENTER OF BALANCE
LAUNCHING STATION LS BASELINE
CONTINUED
2-305
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
5
b.
Continued .
Wrecker operator set wrecker parking brake , set air brake hand control lever to applied position , and place transmission in neutral . Stay in cab and keep engine running.
C.
Check with wrecker crew to verify that live GMs for reload are safe and serviceable per TM 9-1410-600-14.
d.
Remove chock blocks from GMT stowage and chock GMT wheels.
CHOCK (EACH SIDE)
STOWAGE BOX
CURBSIDE
e.
When wheels are chocked , wrecker operator leave cab.
f.
Remove the two tag lines from GMT curbside vehicle stowage box and place them on GMT gooseneck.
CONTINUED
2-306
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
6
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
LOWER GMT LANDING LEGS.
a.
Unhook travel chain from GMT landing legs if applicable.
b.
Remove landing leg handcrank from retaining clip on curbside of GMT.
C.
Pull out handcrank until it locks in place.
O CURBSIDE
ROTATED 90°
d.
Using handcrank, lower leg until shoe sits firmly on ground .
CURBSIDE
م STOWAGE BOX
FIFTH WHEEL
CONTINUED
2-307
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
6
Continued .
e.
Continue to lower landing fifth wheel .
f.
Push handcrank back into retracted position and secure in retaining clip .
g.
Clear area around wrecker- GMT coupling .
legs until weightis slightly relieved from wrecker
WRECKER AIR BRAKE HAND CONTROL LEVER IN APPLIED POSITION BEFORE
Le
MUST BE
UNCOUPLING AIR BRAKE
LINES. OTHERWISE , GMT BRAKES WILL BE RELEASED WHEN AIR LINES ARE DISCONNECTED. INJURY OR DEATH
WARNING
MAY RESULT.
7
DISCONNECT GMT FROM WRECKER .
a.
Disconnect over-the- road trical cable from dust cover
and
elec-
GMT by raising pulling
cable
straight out from connector. b.
Disconnect over-the- road cable from wrecker and stow in wrecker roadside stowage box .
O CURBSIDE
2-308
CONTINUED
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
7
C.
Continued .
Close shutoff valves on both air lines at rear of wrecker.
STOWAGE BRACKET
AIR LINE SHUT OFF VALVE
AIR HOSE
TYPICAL 2 PLACES CURBSIDE
d.
Disconnect SERVICE air line and EMERGENCY air line from GMT
EMERGENCY AIR LINE
glad hands connectors.
SERVICE AIR LINE
e.
Coil and secure both air lines on stowage brackets on wrecker.
CONTINUED
2-309
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
7
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued —
f.
Continued .
Swing fifth wheel locking plunger safety latch aside.
SAFETY LATCH
LOCK PLUNGER LEVER
g.
Move fifth wheel locking plunger lever forward to open jaws and release GMT kingpin .
h.
Clear area around GMT-wrecker coupling .
i.
Have wrecker operator slowly drive wrecker forward wrecker approach ramps.
зряза
until
GMT is
clear of
GMT APPROACH RAMP WRECKER
200
OO CURBSIDE
CONTINUED
2-310
TM 9-1440-600-10
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD 8
— Continued
PREPARE WRECKER FOR RELOAD .
a.
Guide wrecker to position on location line marked above .
Vehicle frame on
side nearest LS must be on location line . Stop wrecker when center of crane cab is alined with LS and GMT CANISTER CENTER OF BALANCE.
Jaoq be WRECKER
GUIDED MISSILE TRANSPORTER
E
2-31 .
CANISTER CENTER OF BALANCE
LAUNCHING STATION
b.
CANISTER CENTER OF BALANCE
WRECKER LOCATION LINE
Wrecker operator set parking brake and set controls in wrecker cab to operate crane .
CONTINUED
2-311
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued ―
8
C.
Continued .
Remove the two outrigger bases , one on each side of equipment box :
handle from
(1 )
Unscrew clamp threaded post.
(2)
Remove clamp bar from threaded post .
(3)
Lift base straight up off threaded post .
CLAMP HANDLE CLAMP BAR THREADED POST
CURBSIDE
CONTINUED
2-312
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
8
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
Continued.
d.
Attach one base to curbside and one to roadside rear outrigger leg.
(1 )
Remove retaining clip and retaining pin from base.
(2)
Pull L-shaped pin from side of storage tube .
30:28 . บว STOWAGE TUBE
MENU
BASE
AO RETAINING23 ИМИЯАМ MLPINE THEVER
RETAINING CLIP woled
OT 2830DIRTUO
int
get2 mohs 209ta
LEG CURBSIDE
L-SHAPED PIN
(3)
Pull outrigger leg out of storage tube , just far enough to aline hole in leg with holes in base.
(4)
Use retaining pin and clip to secure base to leg .
CONTINUED
2-313
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued —
8
e.
Continued .
On
curbside
move
and
L-shaped
securing front
roadside , retaining
repin
outrigger leg in
storage tube.
109
(S)
CURBSIDE
WEAR WORK GLOVES AND BE CAREFUL WHEN LOWERING
WARNING OUTRIGGERS TO PREVENT INJURY TO HANDS.
Perform steps f thru j below for each of the four wrecker out-
NOTE
f.
riggers. Lower forward outriggers first.
Pull outrigger leg from storage tube until outrigger frame hits
stop , then lower outrigger base.
g.
Aline pin holes and install L-shaped retaining pin to secure outrigger in extended position .
CONTINUED
2-314
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE FROAD - Continued
8
Continued .
h.
Grasp outrigger leg and rotate it to lower outrigger
base .
Stop
when base just touches ground .
RETAINING PIN
i.
Install outrigger handle in one of the holes in screw collar at top of outrigger leg . Use handle to turn screw out until base presses slightly against ground .
j.
Check that outrigger leg is vertical .
k.
Repeat steps f through j until all four outriggers are in place .
I.
When all outriggers are lowered , wrecker operator must verify that:
(1 )
All outriggers put pressure against ground .
(2)
Retaining pins are installed on all outriggers .
(3)
On sloped terrain , wrecker is not leaning toward downhill side .
CONTINUED
2-315
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
9
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
GROUND GMT TO LS.
a.
Remove Ground Cable 27W1 from GMT curbside vehicle stowage box .
b.
Connect one end of Ground Cable 27W1 to GMT grounding connector at rear of adapter platform . Turn clockwise to lock.
OMMATER 19
STOWAGE CURBSIDE
C.
Connect other end of GMT Ground
Cable 27W1
to
LS Ground
Connector
42J4. Turn cable connector clockwise to lock.
1800
2 ye
90sign 918 219ppintuo nuot its litnu 16dt vlnev taur hotshego
point Lage
42J49A ி
exostw ,benewal 81s 2190 ச
y
06 910229phtu www rob
ROADSIDE
CONTINUED
2-316
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
10
PREPARE CRANE HOOK AND BOOM .
CRANE
OPERATOR
MUST RECEIVE
SIGNALS FROM
ONE
DESIGNATED CREWMEMBER ONLY. SIGNAL PERSON MUST WARNING
BE VISIBLE TO CRANE OPERATOR AT ALL TIMES. WRONG SIGNALS MAY RESULT IN INJURY OR DEATH .
At night use lights to signal crane operator.
Refer to FM 21-60
for visual signals guidance. NOTE
a.
Have crane operator take position in crane cab . Have designated crewmember in position to give signals to crane operator.
b.
Remove crane pivot-post lockpin.
30
xem of mood boxe of hotshego eneo lengia Samosas brie
oral
planetxe mood gosig seint evome
Rem 0
HOOK
SHIPPER LOCKPIN
1001 C.
Signal crane operator to unwind enough cable to allow hook to be removed from
eye
on
side
of
shipper.
CONTINUED
2-317
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
10
Continued .
HOOK IS HEAVY. EXERCISE CARE . INJURY OR DEATH MAY RESULT IF HOOK FALLS .
WARNING
d.
Remove hook from eye on side of shipper.
e.
Walk hook to end of wrecker and lower it slowly to end of cable.
f.
Remove clips from two boom extension retaining pins . Pull retaining pins from boom.
BOOM CLIPS
RETAINING PINS O.O ROADSIDE
g. h.
Signal crane operator to extend boom to maximum length . Remove three piece boom extension pushout rod from stowage and assemble rod .
1200 30810 oldso di
nicht bev OO ROADSIDE
CONTINUED
2-318
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
10
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
i.
Continued.
Hold pushout rod between V-shaped brackets at end of shipper and at end of boom extension .
BOOM EXTENSION
BOOM CLIPS
RETAINING PINS
O ROADSIDE
SHIPPER
j.
PUSHOUT ROD
Signal crane operator to slowly retract boom so that boom extension is slowly forced out of boom . Stop retracting boom when retaining pin holes in boom and boom extension are alined.
k.
Insert the two retaining pins to lock extension and boom together. Place clips on retaining pins.
I.
Remove pushout rod from boom assembly . Disassemble and stow rod.
CONTINUED
2-319
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
11
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
PREPARE CANISTER SLING .
a.
Install GMT ladder as follows:
(1 )
Remove two quick release pins securing ladder in stowage position .
CURBSIDE
PIN
PIN
OMAT
AOR
BRACKET
(2)
LADDER
Slide ladder from stowage position under canister.
(3)
Position ladder on roadside of GMT and engage ladder hooks
vidmezes mood mont bin GMT support slots .
CONTINUED
2-320
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 . 11
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued -
Continued .
WHEN HANDLING AN EMPTY SLING , SLING HOISTING SHACKLE MUST BE IN EMPTY POSITION . OTHERWISE
La
SLING
WILL TILT AND
MAY
INJURE
NEARBY
CREW-
WARNING MEMBERS .
b.
Check that load certification date on canister sling has not expired .
C.
Check that hoisting shackle on canister sling is in
EMPTY position . To change
position , proceed as follows:
pin
from
hoisting
(1 )
Unscrew shackle .
(2)
Aline holes in shackle with hole marked EMPTY.
(3)
Install pin to secure shackle to
Дина -
RATED LOAD 7500 LBS EMPTY
LOADED
sling .
DAT 3M
HтO у @
0знOTAW
отпор
BRA
CUM О СВИРАНИ ЦВИЯА С
O 8 of op
bemoheo
ALINEMENT PIN
ebic pawollo!
LOCKING PIN d.
Signal
crane
operator to
move
hook over canister sling on GMT. Connect crane hook to canister
TYPICAL 2 PLACES
sling . e.
Remove the two locking pins that CONTINUED
secure canister sling to GMT.
2-321
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
11
2-322
Continued .
LINES TIGHT AT ALL TIMES WHEN MOVING LOAD. KEEP EXCESS LINE UNDER CONTROL TO PREVENT
KEEP TAG Le TRIPPING
WARNING
f.
OR
CATCHING
TAG
LINE
ON
OBSTACLES .
SERIOUS INJURY MAY RESULT IF TAG LINES AND SUSPENDED LOAD ARE NOT CLOSELY CONTROLLED .
Attach one tag line to shackle at each end of canister sling .
SLING
TAG LINE
Le
CREWMEMBERS
ON
CREWMEMBERS
AND WARNED OF
LS
MUST
BE WATCHED UNSAFE
BY OTHER
CONDITIONS
WARNING TO PREVENT INJURY.
1.
If the two-stack offload option 14.
2.
On level ground offload canisters in following order :
NOTES
•
is to be performed ,
go to step
Upper canister nearest wrecker. Other upper canister. Lower canister nearest wrecker. Other lower canister.
CONTINUED
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
— 11
Continued .
3.
On sloped ground offload canisters in following order: •
Upper canister on downslope side.
Remaining upper canister.
4.
Lower canister on downslope side .
•
Remaining lower canister.
At night one crewmember hold light for crewmember performing task .
PREPARE LS CANISTERS FOR SINGLE CANISTER OFFLOAD .
If any live GMs are to be offloaded , check that :
(1 )
Torque tube handle is in LOCK о O DESSICANT HOLDER
position. (2)
No red paint shows to left of torque tube handle .
NOTE
о RECORDS
J2
DONOT LATCH OR UNLATCH UNLESS GM ELEVATED
UNLOCK
(3)
Quick- release pin is installed on right side of torque tube handle .
CK
a.
LO
12
•
RELIEF VALVE PUSH TO RELEASE PRESSURE O
Deep well socket goes over nut and fits on driver beneath the nut.
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-323
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued -
12
b.
Continued .
Using 1 /2 - inch drive ratchet head, 30-150 foot- pound torque wrench handle , 30-inch extension , and 3/4-inch deep well tiedown bolts on canister to be offloaded .
19tainso
swol pninisme
socket,
loosen the
four canister
. TIEDOWN
moheq nadmerwero noi tripil blot hedmamweia eno tripin
BOLT
2112 803 283т2MQUÍCK RELEASE PIN TYPICAL 4 PLACES edut euphoT
( †)
noitieoq
TIEDOWN BOLT
9 - biu
(S)
re bi aar or tobi eg By OTHE
edur suprot
QUICK RELEASE PIN TYPICAL 4 PLACES
C.
Remove quick release pin , rotate tiedown bolt to raised position , and install quick- release pin .
STAY CLEAR OF BOOM AND SLING WHEN THEY ARE IN WARNING
MOTION. TO PREVENT INJURY, DO NOT GET YOUR HANDS CAUGHT BETWEEN SLING AND CANISTER .
CONTINUED
2-324
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
12
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
-
d.
Continued.
Signal crane operator to move sling over canister. Guide sling to top center of canister with hoist hooks on sling alined with hoisting rings on canister.
CANISTER SLING
ANCHOR SHACKLE (4 PLACES)
HOIST HOOK (4 PLACES) HOISTING RING (4 PLACES)
3
FORWARD
e.
With crane supporting weight of sling ,
connect four sling hoist hooks to four
canister hoisting rings . Verify that sling anchor shackles and hoist hooks, and canister hoisting rings are not kinked or twisted .
CONTINUED
2-325
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
12
Continued.
HANDLING EMPTY CANISTER , SLING HOISTING SHACKLE MUST BE IN EMPTY POSITION. WHEN HANDLING
WHEN Ave
WARNING
CANISTER CONTAINING EITHER A GM OR BALLAST, SLING HOISTING SHACKLE MUST BE IN LOADED POSITION . OTHERWISE SLING WILL TILT AND MAY INJURE NEARBY CREWMEMBERS .
f.
Verify that sling hoisting shackle is in correct position for canister to be moved : EMPTY for empty canister or LOADED for canister with GM installed . If necessary, change shackle position as follows:
(1 )
Signal crane operator to lower sling gently onto canister.
(2)
Unscrew pin from hoisting shackle .
(3)
Aline holes in shackle with hole at correct position .
(4)
Install pin to secure shackle to sling.
O
RATED LOAD 7500 LBS LOADED
EMPTY
10121060 or retainso FORWARD HEN
THEY ARE
AT YOUR HAN
TRIED
2-326
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
12
Continued .
KEEP TAG LINES TIGHT AT ALL TIMES WHEN MOVING SUSLe
WARNING
PENDED LOAD. KEEP EXCESS LINE UNDER CONTROL TO PREVENT
TRIPPING
OR
CATCHING
TAG
LINES
ON
OBSTACLES. SERIOUS INJURY MAY RESULT IF TAG LINES AND SUSPENDED LOAD ARE NOT CLOSELY CONTROLLED .
g.
Remove two tag
lines from
sling
and
connect to canister: one tag
line to
front bottom anchor shackle and other tag line to rear bottom anchor shackle .
TAG LINES
13
OFFLOAD CANISTERS FROM LS ONE - BY-ONE .
FJ
DO NOT STAND UNDER OR IN PATH OF HOISTED LOAD.
WARNING
SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH MAY RESULT IF STRUCK BY MOVING LOAD .
་
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-327
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
13
Continued .
a.
Verify that tag lines are tended and all crewmembers are clear of canister to be moved.
b.
Signal crane
operator to take
a strain
on
load , then
slowly
raise
canister
about 6 inches so that it clears alinement pins and canister or LM beneath it.
6 INCHES
CURBSIDE
c.
Verify that tag lines and hoist hooks are securely attached to load .
CONTINUED
2-328
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD – Continued
13
d.
Continued .
Verify that pathway to area where offloaded canisters will be placed is clear.
WRECKER
GUIDED MISSILE TRANSPORTER
点
LAUNCHING STATION
TYPICAL
CONTINUED
2-329
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
13
Continued.
DO NOT STACK OFFLOADED CANISTERS ON TOP OF EACH OTHER .
CAUTION
NOTE
e.
Place offloaded canisters out of path that live from GMT to LS.
Signal crane operator to raise canister and
GMs will travel
move it slowly to area selected
for offloaded canisters . Keep pressure on tag lines for positive control of load .
f.
Signal crane operator to lower canister carefully to ground .
g.
Signal crane operator to lower sling to relieve load.
h.
With crane supporting
sling
weight,
disconnect four sling
hoist hooks from
four canister hoisting rings.
CANISTER SLING
HOIST HOOK (4 PLACES) HOISTING RING (4 PLACES)
FORWARD
CONTINUED
2-330
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
13
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued -
i.
Continued .
Lower hoisting rings flat against canister.
Le
WHEN HANDLING AN EMPTY SLING , SLING HOISTING SHACKLE MUST BE IN EMPTY POSITION OTHERWISE SLING
WARNING WILL TILT AND MAY INJURE NEARBY CREWMEMBERS .
H
j.
Check that hoisting shackle on sling is in EMPTY position . If necessary change shackle position as follows:
(1 )
Signal crane operator to lower sling gently onto canister. HOISTING SHACKLE
(2)
Unscrew shackle .
pin
from
hoisting
PIN RATED LOAD 7500 LBS EMPTY
(3)
Aline holes in shackle with hole marked EMPTY.
(4)
Install pin to secure shackle to sling .
LOADED
k.
Remove tag lines from canister. Attach one tag line to shackle at each end of sling .
1.
Repeat steps 12 and 13 for each canister remaining on LS , then go to step 16.
CONTINUED
2-331
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
Le
WARNING
BOTH CANISTERS MUST BE EMPTY TO LIFT A TWO-STACK. HOISTING
EQUIPMENT AND
CANISTER
TIEDOWNS
WILL
NOT STAND THE WEIGHT IF ONE CANISTER IS LOADED.
14
PREPARE LS CANISTERS FOR TWO-STACK OFFLOAD.
a.
Verify that all canisters on the LS are empty . Canisters must not contain GMs or ballast (weight to represent a GM) .
Le WARNING
b.
CREWMEMBERS
ON
LS
MUST BE WATCHED
BY OTHER
CREWMEMBERS AND WARNED OF UNSAFE CONDITIONS.
Using a 1 /2-inch drive ratchet head , a 30-150 foot- pound torque wrench handle , a 30- inch extension , and a 3/4- inch deep socket , check torque on both upper canister tiedown bolts as follows.
E
கு
கு
UPPER TIEDOWN BOLT TYPICAL 8 PLACES
.81
CONTINUED
2-332
TM 9-1440-600-10
-
Continued .
Set the torque wrench handle micrometer for 60 foot- pounds of torque .
(2)
Climb
6
(1 )
up on
12 1
14
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
NDS POU T FO- O
2-31 .
upper canisters .
Tighten the four upper (two on each canister) inside tiedown bolts until the torque wrench handle clicks off at 60 footpounds .
(3)
Climb down from the top. Tighten the four upper (two on each canister) outside tiedown bolts until the torque wrench clicks off at 60 foot- pounds.
Le
STAY CLEAR OF BOOM AND SLING WHEN THEY ARE IN MOTION. TO PREVENT INJURY, DO NOT GET YOUR HANDS
WARNING CAUGHT BETWEEN SLING AND CANISTER .
NOTE
Offload two-stack nearest wrecker first.
CONTINUED
2-333
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
-
14
C.
Continued .
Signal crane operator to move sling over upper canister of two-stack .
(The
two-stack nearest the wrecker first. ) Guide sling to top center of canister with hoist hooks on sling alined with hoisting rings on canister.
CANISTER
SLING
ANCHOR SHACKLE (4 PLACES)
HOIST HOOK (4 PLACES)
HOISTING RING (4 PLACES)
FORWARD
d.
With crane supporting weight of sling , connect four sling hoist hooks to four canister hoisting rings . Verify that sling anchor shackles and hoist hooks , and canister hoisting rings are not kinked or twisted .
CONTE NUED
2-334
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued -
14
Continued.
WHEN HANDLING Le
WARNING
SHACKLE SLING
MUST
WILL
EMPTY CANISTER , BE IN
TILT
AND
EMPTY MAY
SLING
POSITION .
INJURE
HOISTING
OTHERWISE
NEARBY
CREW-
MEMBERS.
e.
Verify that hoisting shackle on canister sling is in EMPTY position . To change position , proceed as follows.
(1 )
Unscrew shackle .
(2)
Aline holes in shackle with hole marked EMPTY.
(3)
pin
from
hoisting
RATED LOAD 7500 LBS
LOADED
EMPTY
Install pin to secure shackle to sling .
KEEP TAG LINES TIGHT AT ALL TIMES WHEN MOVING SUSLe WARNING
PENDED LOAD. KEEP EXCESS LINE UNDER CONTROL TO PREVENT
TRIPPING
OR
CATCHING
TAG
LINES
ON
OBSTACLES. SERIOUS INJURY MAY RESULT IF TAG LINES AND SUSPENDED LOAD ARE NOT CLOSELY CONTROLLED .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-335
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued -
14
f.
Continued .
Remove two tag
lines from
sling
and connect to canister:
one tag line to
front bottom anchor shackle and other tag line to rear bottom anchor shackle .
TAG LINES
CONTINUED
2-336
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
14
g.
Continued.
Using a 1 /2- inch drive ratchet head , a 30-150 foot- pound torque wrench handle , a 30- inch extension ,
and a 3/4-inch deep socket, loosen the lower tiedown
bolt on two-stack that has sling attached .
LOWER TIEDOWN BOLT TYPICAL 4 PLACES
ROADSIDE
h.
Remove quick- release pin , rotate tiedown
bolt to
raised
position ,
and install quick- release pin . i.
Climb up on upper canister between canisters on same end . Using
same tools ,
loosen lower
inside tiedown bolt.
j.
Secure inside tiedown bolt to raised position as in step h .
k.
Move to opposite end , bolts in raised position .
loosen inside and outside tiedown bolts and secure
CONTINUED
2-337
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
Le
DO NOT STAND UNDER OR IN PATH OF HOISTED LOAD. SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH MAY RESULT IF STRUCK BY
WARNINGS
MOVING LOAD .
⚫USE
EXTREME
HIGH
OR
CARE WHEN
GUSTY
WIND .
HANDLING
USE
TWO
TWO-STACKS IN
PEOPLE
ON
EACH
TAGLINE WHEN WIND IN HIGH OR GUSTY.
• KEEP TAG LINES TIGHT AT ALL TIMES WHEN MOVING SUSPENDED LOAD. KEEP EXCESS LINE UNDER CONTROL TO PREVENT
TRIPPING
OR
CATCHING
TAG
LINE
ON
OBSTACLES. SERIOUS INJURY MAY RESULT IF TAG LINES AND SUSPENDED LOAD ARE NOT CLOSELY CONTROLLED.
15
OFFLOAD TWO- STACK FROM LS.
a.
Tend both tag lines . Clear crewmembers from two-stack .
b.
Signal crane operator to take a strain on load , then slowly raise stack about 6 inches so that it clears LS alinement pins .
albiuin evomeЯ of glod biop
6 INCHES
69
nwobail slani bns
no Qudmilo
CURBSIDE
nobell ebieni etupe2 5
C.
Verify that tag lines and hoist hooks are securely attached to load .
CONTINUED
2-338
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
15
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
-
d.
Continued .
Verify that pathway to area where offloaded two-stack will be placed is clear.
WRECKER LAUNCHING STATION
TWO-STACK OFFLOAD
1. OBSERVE THE FOLLOWING WHEN PLACING EMPTY TWO-STACK ON THE GROUND : A. MAKE SURE WHEN SETTING A TWO-STACK ON A SLOPE THAT IT POINTS IN AN UPHILL/DOWNHILL DIRECTION. B. EXTEND WRECKER BOOM TO MAXIMUM LENGTH TO GET CANISTERS OUT OF THE WAY. C. PLACE CANISTERS OUT OF PATH THAT LIVE GM'S WILL TRAVEL BETWEEN GMT AND LS. 2. IF POSSIBLE , DO NOT MOVE LIVE GM'S OVER EMPTY CANISTERS ON THE GROUND.
GUIDED MISSILE TRANSPORTER
CONTINUED
2-339
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
15
Continued .
GROUND WHERE TWO-STACK IS TO BE PLACED MUST BE WARNING
CLEAR, OTHERWISE TWO-STACK MAY BE UNSTABLE AND FALL OVER .
WHEN SETTING A TWO-STACK ON A SLOPE , MAKE SURE La WARNING
NOTE
IT POINTS IN AN UPHILL/DOWNHILL WISE IT MAY FALL OVER .
DIRECTION .
OTHER-
Place offloaded two-stacks well away from path GMs must follow when moved from GMT to LS. Two-stack will be about 6.5 feet (2.0 m ) high .
Examine the site before offloading to determine
where to place two- stacks .
e.
Signal crane operator to raise canister and move it slowly to area selected for offloaded two-stacks . load .
Keep pressure on tag
lines for positive
f.
Signal crane operator to lower two-stack carefully to ground .
g.
Signal crane operator to lower sling to relieve load .
a WARNING
control of
DO NOT CLIMB UP ON A TWO-STACK UNLESS IT IS FIRMLY SEATED ON THE GROUND AND IS STABLE .
PUSH ON IT,
IF IT ROCKS , MOVE IT.
WEAR WORK GLOVES WHEN ON A TWO-STACK. BE SURE
WARNING
OF FIRM FOOT-HOLDS AND HAND-HOLDS AT ALL TIMES .
h.
Check that the two-stack is stable on the ground .
i.
Two crewmembers climb up on the two-stack , one at each end of the sling. Other crewmembers assist the two to climb the two- stack.
CONTINUED
2-340
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
15
Continued .
j.
Remove tag end of sling .
k.
With
lines from
crane supporting
two-stack .
sling
Attach
weight,
one tag
line to shackle on
disconnect four sling
hoist
each
hooks from
four canister hoisting rings.
CANISTER
SLING
HOIST HOOK (4 PLACES)
3
HOISTING RING (4 PLACES)
FORWARD
I.
Lower hoisting rings flat against canister.
m.
Crewmembers climb down from two-stack with assistance from crewmembers
on ground .
CONTINUED
2-341
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
15
16
Continued.
n.
Signal crane operator to move sling to side of two-stack and lower it enough to attach tag lines.
O.
Repeat steps 14 and 15 for remaining two- stack, then go to step 16.
INSPECT LM ALINEMENT PINS.
a.
Inspect each
of the
eight alinement pins on
launcher platform for defects :
cracks , bends , distortion , etc.
ALINEMENT PIN
TYPICAL 8 PLACES
b.
If any faults are found , notify the Maintenance Officer.
CREWMEMBERS ON GMT MUST BE WATCHED BY OTHER Le CREWMEMBERS
AND WARNED
OF
UNSAFE CONDITIONS
WARNING TO PREVENT INJURY .
CONTINUED
2-342
TM 9-1440-600-10
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
2-31 .
1.
On level ground offload canisters in the following order. •
Upper canister nearest wrecker.
•
Remaining upper canister .
NOTES
Lower canister nearest wrecker.
Remaining lower canister. 2.
On sloped ground , offload canisters in the following order : •
Upper canister on downslope side .
•
Remaining upper canister. Lower canister on downslope side.
• 3.
Remaining lower canister.
At night, one crewmember hold light for crewmember performing task .
PREPARE GMS ON GMT FOR OFFLOAD .
On each of the four canisters on
O DESSICANT HOLDER
GMT, check that :
O RECORDS
J2
(1 )
Torque tube handle is in LOCK
(2)
Quick- release pin is installed on
DONOT LATCH OR UNLATCH UNLESS GM ELEVATED PULL
UNLOCK
position .
K
a.
LOC
17
RELIEF VALVE PUSH TO RELEASE PRESSURE о
right side of torque tube handle .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-343
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued —
17
Continued .
(3)
No red paint shows to left of torque tube handle.
NOTE
b.
Deep well socket goes over nut and fits on driver beneath the nut.
Using 1 /2-inch drive ratchet head, 30-150 foot- pound torque wrench handle , 30-inch extension , and 3/4- inch deep socket, loosen the four canister tiedown bolts on the canister to be offloaded .
TIEDOWN BOLT
QUICK RELEASE PIN upto
CE
TYPICAL 4 PLACES esale - biu TIEDOWN BOLT
QUICK RELEASE PIN TYPICAL 4 PLACES
(S)
bie tright
C.
Remove quick- release pin , rotate each tiedown bolt to the raised position , and install quick- release pin .
CONTINUED
2-344
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
17
-
Continued
STAY CLEAR OF BOOM AND SLING WHEN THEY ARE IN WARNING
d.
MOTION. TO PREVENT INJURY, DO NOT GET YOUR HANDS CAUGHT BETWEEN SLING AND CANISTER .
Signal crane operator to move sling over canister. Guide sling to top center of canister with hoist hooks on sling alined with hoisting ring on canister.
en Supr .SMOL
FORWARD
e.
With crane supporting weight of sling , connect four sling hoist hooks to four canister hoisting rings . Verify that sling anchor shackles and hoist hooks, and canister hoisting rings are not kinked or twisted .
Le
WARNING
WHEN HANDLING LOADED CANISTER , SLING HOISTING SHACKLE MUST BE IN LOADED POSITION . OTHERWISE SLING
WILL TILT
AND
MAY
INJURE
NEARBY
CREW-
MEMBERS .
CONTINUED
2-345
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
Continued .
17
f.
Move canister sling hoisting shackle to LOADED position as follows :
(1 )
Signal crane operator to lower HOISTING SHACKLE
sling gently onto canister.
PIN Unscrew shackle .
(2)
pin from
hoisting TED LOAD 500 LBS EMPTY
(3)
Aline holes in shackle with hole marked LOADED .
(4)
Install pin to secure shackle to
LOADED
sling .
KEEP TAG LINES TIGHT AT ALL TIMES WHEN MOVING SUSPENDED LOAD. KEEP EXCESS LINE UNDER CONTROL TO PREVENT
TRIPPING
OR
CATCHING
TAG
LINE
ON
WARNING OBSTACLES. SERIOUS INJURY MAY RESULT IF TAG LINES AND SUSPENDED LOAD ARE NOT CLOSELY CONTROLLED .
g.
Remove the two tag lines from
sling and connect to canister . One tag line
to front bottom ring and other tag line to rear bottom ring .
1.
Load GMs onto LS in following order. Lower position farthest from wrecker.
NOTES •
Lower position nearest wrecker. Upper position farthest from wrecker.
Upper position nearest wrecker. 2.
If possible do not move canister across canisters on ground .
CONTINUED
2-346
Change 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
18
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
MOVE GM FROM GMT TO LS.
DO NOT STAND UNDER OR IN PATH OF HOISTED LOAD. SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH MAY RESULT IF STRUCK BY
WARNING
MOVING LOAD.
a.
Verify that tag lines are manned and all crewmembers are clear of canister.
b.
Signal
crane
operator to take
a strain
on
load , then
slowly raise
canister
about 6 inches so that it clears alinement pins and canister or GMT beneath it.
N
6 INCHES
ROADSIDE
C.
Verify that all hoist hooks and tag lines are canister.
d.
securely attached to
Disconnect GMT grounding cable from GM connector 4A1J3.
GMT GROUNDING CABLE
CONTINUED
2-347
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
18
e.
Continued .
Verify that pathway to LS is clear.
WRECKER
FORWARD
GUIDED MISSILE TRANSPORTER
FORWARD FORWARD
LAUNCHING STATION
FORWARD
CONTINUED
T
2-348
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued -
18
Continued .
f.
Signal crane operator to raise GM and move it toward LS.
g.
At halfway point, signal crane operator to stop . Verify that FORWARD arrow on canister will be pointing towards front of LS. Use taglines to rotate canister if necessary. Do not get under load .
CREWMEMBERS
WARNING
ON LS MUST BE WATCHED
CREWMEMBERS AND WARNED
OF
BY OTHER
UNSAFE
CONDITIONS
GM over alinement pins on
lower GM or
TO PREVENT INJURY.
h.
Signal crane operator to position LS as applicable .
TIEDOWN POINT (4 PLACES)
ALINEMENT PIN
ROADSIDE TYPICAL 8 PLACES
CONTINUED
2-349
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
18
Continued .
DO NOT HOLD OUTSIDE OF CANISTER SKIDS WHEN ALINING
GM WITH
ALINEMENT
PINS.
YOUR
HANDS CAN BE
WARNING SERIOUSLY INJURED IF GM SWAYS .
i.
Signal crane operator to lower canister until it is just above alinement pins . Manually aline canister with alinement pins.
19
j.
Signal crane operator to slowly lower canister onto alinement pins .
k.
Signal crane operator to lower sling to relieve tension on load .
CONNECT GROUNDING CABLE TO GM .
FR 5
a.
For the lower GMs.
(1 )
Remove ground cable from spring clip at applicable stowed position .
(2)
Connect grounding cable to GM.
GM
CONNECTOR
CABLE
LL
4A1J3
A5W21P1
LR
4A1J3
A5W23P1
CONTINUED
2-350
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
19
-
Continued.
b.
For the upper GMs.
(1 )
At applicable stowed rotate screw on
position , quick-
disconnect loop clamp 1 /4-turn CCW. (2)
Open
clamp
and
remove
ground cable from clamp. (3)
Remove end of ground cable from spring clip .
(4)
Connect GM .
grounding
cable to
GM
CONNECTOR
CABLE
UL
4A1J3
A5W20P1
UR
4A1J3
A5W22P1
CONTINUED
2-351
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
20
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
SECURE GMS TO LS.
a.
With crane supporting weight of sling ,
disconnect four hoist hooks on sling
from four hoisting rings on canister.
CANISTER SLING
HOIST HOOK (4 PLACES) HOISTING RING (4 PLACES)
FORWARD
b.
Lower hoisting rings flat against canister.
SLING HOISTING SHACKLE MUST BE IN EMPTY POSITION WHEN HANDLING EMPTY SLING . OTHERWISE SLING WILL
WARNING TILT AND MAY INJURE NEARBY CREWMEMBERS .
CONTINUED
2-352
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
20
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
Continued .
C.
Transfer sling hoisting shackle to EMPTY position as follows:
(1 )
Signal crane operator to lower
HOISTING SHACKLE
sling gently onto canister.
Unscrew shackle.
(2)
pin
from
hoisting
PIN
RATED LOAD 7500 LBS EMPTY
(3)
Aline holes in shackle with hole marked EMPTY.
(4)
Install pin to secure shackle to sling .
LOADED
d.
Remove tag lines from canister. Attach one tag line to shackle on each end of sling .
e.
Signal crane operator to move sling away from LS.
CONTINUED
2-353
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
20
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
-
Continued .
f.
Remove quick- release pins from bolts to down position .
four canister tiedown bolts and flip tiedown
Make sure
bolts
enter slot
in
lower support.
Install
quick- release pin .
m buri smo
TIEDOWN BOLT
QUICK RELEASE PIN
g.
Using
1 /2-inch drive ratchet head , 30-150 foot- pound torque wrench handle ,
30-inch extension , and 3/4- inch tiedown bolts as follows:
(1)
deep socket,
torque
each
of four canister
Set torque wrench handle micrometer to 60 foot- pounds .
CONTINUED
2-354
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
20
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
—
Continued.
(2)
al
Using torque wrench , tighten wrench clicks off.
each
of the four tiedown
bolts until torque
3718
ALENA
te2 1231-9018
live 192
h.
Repeat steps 17 thru 20 until all four GMs are loaded and secured on LS .
ade er
ans
BITE test is required now, before MRCTS tests are performed . NOTE
21
AT LCU DISPLAY PANEL A1A14, PERFORM LOCAL BITE TEST .
a.
Energize power.
(1 )
If LS was powered down , power it up per para 2-10.
(2)
If Generator Set A6 was deenergized , energize it per para 2-14 .
CONTINUED
2-355
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
Continued .
21
(3)
If DLTM A2 was deenergized , energize it per para 2-13.
(4)
If LEM A1 was deenergized , energize it per para 2-12.
b.
Check that all five BITE lights are off.
BITE
OOOOO с B E D A
C.
Set
BITE
TEST- OFF - STATUS
LAMP TEST switch to
BITE TEST
STATUS
OFF LAMP TEST. Check that all BITE STATUS LAMP TEST
lights are on . d.
Set switch to
BITE TEST. BITE
о
lights cycle on and off for 6 sec-
C
LAUNCH CONTROL UNIT O POWER SUPPLIES
onds. If all BITE lights remain on ,
BITE
"
.
Deenergize 2-15.
A1
per
VDC VDC MISSILE UPPERL LIPPER A HAZARD
O
O LEM
PLATFORM
O
f.
LAUNCHERLOCAL para
C
Set switch to OFF.
iO
e.
O
test passed .
O
O
0
RAISE STOP 10 10: START
O
0
G LAUNCHING STA
O
LOE PLATFORM 이이 이이 READY RAISED AZIMUTH READY OOO DISCON NECTED 0000
O
FIRINGPLATOON
O
OFF
O
10
Ô
NORMAL BITETEST STATUSLAMPS OFF DIM STATUS LAMPTEST
RELEASE HANDLE
MRCTS
22
PREPARE MRCTS FOR USE.
a.
Release strap assembly securing MRCTS A8 to LS stowage brack-
et.
CONTINUED STRAP
2-356
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
22
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
-
b.
Continued.
Set MRCTS A8 on work platform behind Launcher Missile Round Distributor (LMRD) A3 in position to test GM cables.
C.
Press PRESSURE RELIEF valve to relieve pressure in case.
d.
Release four latches and remove cover.
PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE
e.
Release two pushbutton fasteners on inner lid , swing open , and remove cable A8W1.
f.
9.
Set MRCTS OFF.
Close and secure inner lid.
POWER switch to Θ POWER ON
POWER SAFE TESTTO RESET
START
OFF STEP H O
MO OT
CONTINUED
2-357
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
22
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued -
h.
Continued .
Remove dust cap from
LMRD
connector A3J6 and from MRCTS
i.
Jack
Plug
connector A8J1 .
P1
LMRD A3J6
Connect MRCTS cable A8W1 as
P2
MRCTS A8J1
follows:
LMRD A3
A3J6 MRCTS A8
A8J1
j.
23
CABLE A8W1
lights by rotating lens cover fully Open dimmers on each of four MRCTS A8 CCW.
PERFORM MRCTS TEST AND CONNECT GM CABLES .
CHECK IDENTIFICATION SLEEVE ON EACH CABLE TO INSURE THAT YOU TEST AND CONNECT CORRECT CABLE TO GM . CAUTION
CONTINUED
2-358
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
23
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD – Continued
-
Continued .
Remove cables from stowed position .
a.
UR DUMMY CONNECTOR FARSIDE
A LR DUMMY CONNECTOR
UL DUMMY CONNECTOR
ROADSIDE LL DUMMY CONNECTOR
(1 )
Disconnect canister heater cable from small dummy connector at applicable position .
(2)
Disconnect large GM signal cable from large dummy connector at applicable position .
b.
Connect P1 of large GM signal cable (W1 , W2, W3 or W4) to MRCTS connector J2.
C.
Perform MRCTS test as follows:
(1 )
Energize LEM per para 2-12.
CONTINUED
2-359
TM 9-1440-600-10
P1 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued 233
-
Continued . A8J2
(2)
Θ
(3)
Set POWER switch to ON . Check POWER ON and SAFE TO TEST lights on .
(4)
5:
Press to test NO GO and GO lights . Lights on when pressed .
(5)
Momentarily hold RESET switch @
Θ
up. STEP display indicates 00 . Θ @
→ POWER ON
POWER SAFE TO NO GO ON TEST
Ө
GO
RESET
START
: O
Θ
OFF
STEP →
Θ
SAFE TO TEST LIGHT MUST STAY ON 98 WHEN WARNING
GOES
IT WILL
OFF
EXCEPT AT STEP
FLASH OFF. IF SAFE TO TEST
AND STAYS OFF,
LIGHT
DO NOT CONNECT CABLE
TO GM. OTHERWISE ORDNANCE
DEVICE MAY EXPLODE ,
RESULTING IN INJURY OR DEATH .
MRCTS takes about 35 seconds to step from 00 to 99. During
NOTE
step 98 , SAFE TO TEST light will go off, then on . This is normal . When step 99 is displayed and GOlight is on , test passed.
CONTINUED
2-360
TM 9-1440-600-1 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
23
-
Continued .
(6)
Momentarily hold START switc
POWER ON
up. STEP display starts count
Ө
Ꮎ
Θ SAFE POWER TESTTO NOGO ON
GO
ing. RESET
START (7)
After about 35 seconds , STE
OFF STEP
display 99 and GOlight come
A
on. Test has passed .
Θ
(8)
Set POWER switch to OFF .
+
☐ Ө
Ө
Ө
d.
Deenergize LEM A1 per para 2-15.
e.
Disconnect P1 of GM signal cable from MRCTS connector J2.
CHECK IDENTIFICATION SLEEVE ON EACH CABLE TO IN
SURE THAT YOU CONNECT THE CORRECT CABLE TO EACI GM .
CAUTION CONTINUED
2-36
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
23
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
Continued .
f.
Connect cables to GM. Remove shorting plug from
GM connector 4A1J1 just
before connecting cable to the connector.
06
CABLE
CONNECTOR
A5W1P1 - UL
(2)
UL J1
23W2P2
(1 )
UL J2
A5W2P1 - LL
LL J1
23W2P3
LL J2
A5W3P1 - UR
UR J1
23W3P2
UR J2
A5W4P1 - LR
(2)
LR J1
23W3P3
(1 )
LR J2
-2
TYPICAL 4 PLACES
NOTE Perform step g for upper GMs only.
g.
Install cable clamp assembly for upper GM cables on lower canister.
(1 )
Position cable clamp assembly
4 (1 ) on side of canister (2). (2)
3
Seat clamping block (3) fully behind outside flange (4) of canister (2) . Make sure cables are not kinked or twisted .
(3)
Tighten hand knob (6) to secure cable clamp assembly (1 ) to canister (2).
6
2
CONTINUED
2-362
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
23
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
-
Continued . 3 (4)
Open loop clamp (5) and lay upper GM ground cable in clamp .
(5)
Close loop clamp and rotate screw 1 /4- turn cw to lock
6 5
clamp .
24
h.
Repeat steps a thru g to test and connect all cables for all four GMs.
i.
Store shorting plugs removed from GMs on large dummy connectors .
STOW MRCTS.
a.
Disconnect cable A8W1P2 from from LMRD connector A3J6 .
MRCTS connector A8J1
and cable A8W1P1
CABLE A8W1 b.
Install protective covers on both MRCTS connectors and on LMRD
connector A3J6.
A C.
Install cable A8W1 in MRCTS inner lid.
PUSHBUTTON FASTENERS d.
Install
cover
on
MRCTS
and
secure with four cover latches.
B
CONTINUED
2-363
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
24
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
-
Continued .
RELEASE HANDLE
MRCTS
e.
Install MRCTS in stowage bracket with connectors facing direction of arrows on
bracket,
and
secure
with strap assembly.
STRAP
25
ENERGIZE LEM A1 PER PARA 2-12.
DO NOT LOAD AN WARNING
EMPTY TWO-STACK ONTO THE GMT.
UNCOUPLE THE TWO-STACK PER STEP 26a IF THE EMPTY CANISTERS ARE TO BE LOADED ONTO THE GMT.
e
NOTE
Perform steps 26 and 27 below only if canisters offloaded from LS are to be loaded onto GMT. If canisters are not to be loaded onto GMT , go to step 28.
26
LOAD OFFLOADED LS CANISTERS ONTO GMT.
STAY CLEAR OF BOOM AND SLING WHEN THEY ARE IN MOTION. DO NOT GET HANDS CAUGHT BETWEEN SLING WARNING AND CANISTER . SERIOUS INJURY CAN RESULT.
CONTINUED
2-364
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
-
Continued .
26
a.
If empty canisters were offloaded as follows:
as a two-stack,
uncouple each two-stack
(1 )
Loosen each of the four upper canister tiedown bolts.
(2)
Remove quick- release pin , rotate tiedown bolt to raised position , and install quick-release pin .
DA
(893
CONTINUED
2-365
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
26
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued -
b.
Continued .
Signal
crane
operator to
move sling
over canister on
ground .
Guide
sling
to top center of canister with hoist hooks on sling alined with hoisting rings on canister.
CANISTER SLING
ANCHOR SHACKLE (4 PLACES)
HOIST HOOK (4 PLACES) HOISTING RING (4 PLACES)
FORWARD
C.
With crane supporting weight of sling ,
connect the four sling hoist hooks to
four canister hoisting rings . Verify that sling anchor shackles and hoist hooks, and canister hoisting rings are not kinked or twisted .
CONTINUED
2-366
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued -
Continued .
26
WHEN HANDLING EMPTY CANISTER , SLING HOISTING SHACKLE MUST BE IN EMPTY POSITION . WHEN HANDLING CANISTER CONTAINING EITHER A GM OR BALLAST, SLING
WARNING
HOISTING
SHACKLE
MUST
BE
IN
LOADED POSITION .
OTHERWISE SLING WILL TILT AND MAY INJURE NEARBY PERSONNEL .
d.
Verify that sling hoisting shackle is in correct position for canister to be moved : EMPTY for empty canister or LOADED for canister with GM installed . If necessary, change shackle position as follows:
(1 )
Signal crane operator to lower sling gently onto canister.
(2)
Unscrew shackle .
pin
from
HOISTING SHACKLE
hoisting
PIN (3)
Aline holes in shackle with hole
RATED LOAD 7500 LBS
in correct position .
LOADED
EMPTY (4)
Install pin to secure shackle to sling .
KEEP TAG LINES TIGHT AT ALL TIMES WHEN MOVING SUSLa
WARNING
PENDED LOAD . KEEP EXCESS LINE UNDER CONTROL TO PREVENT
TRIPPING
OR
CATCHING
TAG
LINE
ON
OBSTACLES. SERIOUS INJURY MAY RESULT IF TAG LINES AND SUSPENDED LOAD ARE NOT CLOSELY CONTROLLED .
e.
Remove the two tag lines from
sling and connect to canister. One tag line
to front bottom anchor shackle and other tag line to rear bottom anchor shackle .
CONTINUED
Change 1
2-367
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
— 26
Continued .
La WARNING
DO NOT STAND UNDER OR IN PATH OF HOISTED LOAD. SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH MAY RESULT IF STRUCK BY MOVING LOAD.
f.
Signal crane operator to
take
a
strain
on
load , then
slowly raise
canister
about 6 inches above ground .
g.
Verify that tag lines and hoist hooks are securely attached to load .
h.
Signal crane operator to raise canister and move it towards GMT.
CONTINUED
2-368
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
26
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued -
i.
Continued.
At halfway point, signal crane operator to stop . Verify that
FORWARD arrow
on canister will be pointing toward front of GMT. Use tag lines to rotate canister if necessary . Do not get under hoisted load . Use flashlights if it is dark.
WRECKER
GUIDED MISSILE TRANSPORTER
FORWARD
LAUNCHING STATION
CONTINUED
2-369
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
26
2-370
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued -
Continued .
CREWMEMBERS ON GMT MUST BE WATCHED BY OTHER
La WARNING
CREWMEMBERS
AND WARNED OF
UNSAFE
CONDITIONS
TO PREVENT INJURY.
1.
Load GMs onto GMT in following order: Lower position farthest from wrecker.
·
Lower position nearest wrecker.
•
Upper position farthest from wrecker.
•
Upper position nearest wrecker.
NOTES
2.
Crewmembers stand
on
ground alongside
GMT to aline lower
canisters with GMT alinement pins .
CONTINUED
6
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
265
—
j.
Continued .
Signal crane operator to position lower canister as applicable .
canister over alinement
pins on
GMT or
ER
NS
D
wer
CURBSIDE ALINEMENT PINS
Le WARNING
DO NOT HOLD OUTSIDE OF CANISTER SKIDS WHEN ALINING CANISTER WITH ALINEMENT PINS. YOUR HANDS CAN BE SERIOUSLY INJURED IF CANISTER SWAYS .
CONTINUED
2-371
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued -
26
k.
Continued .
Signal crane operator to lower canister until it is just above alinement pins. Manually aline canister with alinement pins .
E
CURBSIDE ALINEMENT PIN
GMT
27
I.
Signal crane operator to lower canister slowly onto alinement pins .
m.
Signal crane operator to lower hook to relieve tension on load.
SECURE CANISTERS TO GMT.
a.
Disconnect the four hoist hooks on sling from the four hoisting rings on canister.
CONTINUED
2-372
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
27
Continued .
S
HOISTING RINGS ON LOWER GMS MUST BE IN DOWN POSITION, FLAT AGAINST CANISTER TO PREVENT DAMAGE TO CANISTERS .
CAUTION
CANISTER SLING
HOIST HOOK (4 PLACES)
130
HOISTING RING (4 PLACES)
FORWARD
b.
Lower hoisting rings flat against canister.
C.
Connect GMT grounding cable to canister connector 4A1J3.
GMT GROUNDING 'CABLE
CONTINUED
A
2-373
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD
27
- Continued
Continued .
Le
WHEN HANDLING AN EMPTY SLING , SLING HOISTING SHACKLE MUST BE IN EMPTY POSITION . OTHERWISE SLING
WILL
TILT
AND
MAY
INJURE
NEARBY
CREW-
WARNING MEMBERS .
d.
Transfer sling hoisting shackle toEMPTY
position as follows:
(1 )
Signal crane operator to lower sling gently onto canister.
(2)
Unscrew
hoisting
pin from
HOISTING SHACKLE
shackle . PIN (3)
Aline holes in shackle with hole markedEMPTY . EMPTY
(4)
€
RATED LOAD 7500 LBS LOADED
Install pin to secure shackle to sling .
e.
Remove taglines from of sling .
f.
Signal crane operator to move sling away from GMT.
g.
canister. Attach one tag line to shackle on each end
Remove quick- release pins from the four canister tiedown bolts and flip tiedown bolts to down positions .
Make sure bolts enter slot in lower support. Install
quick- release pin . h.
Using
1 /2-inch drive ratchet head ,
30-inch extension , and tiedown bolts as follows :
3/4- inch
30-150 foot- pound torque wrench handle,
deep socket ,
torque
each
of four
canister
CONTINUED
2-374
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
27
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
Continued .
(1 )
Set torque wrench handle micrometer to 60 foot - pounds.
(2)
Using torque wrench , wrench clicks off.
tighten
each
of the
four tiedown
bolts
until torque
TIEDOWN BOLT
QUICK RELEASE PIN
chen
do ptie port st i.
Repeat steps 26 and 27 for each canister to be loaded onto GMT.
e nch hand r e t s Urcani
CONTINUED
2-375
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
28
2-376
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
STOW GMT EQUIPMENT .
a.
Signal crane operator to position sling over GMT gooseneck .
O.C
O.O
ALINEMENT PIN b.
Aline sling with the two alinement pins on GMT gooseneck and signal crane operator to lower sling .
C.
Guide sling to engage alinement pins.
d.
Install locking pin in each of the two alinement pins to secure
LOCKING PIN
sling . TYPICAL 2 PLACES e.
Remove the two tag lines from the sling.
f.
Stow both tag lines in roadside GMT stowage box.
g.
Disconnect ground cable 27W1 between LS and GMT and stow cable.
CONTINUED
C
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
28
Continued .
(1 )
Under LEM A1 on LS, turn connector on GMT Grounding Cable 27W1 ccw to unlock.
(2)
(3)
Remove Cable 27W1 connector 42J4.
from
LS
At rear of GMT adapter platform , turn connector on Cable 27W1 ccw to unlock.
(4)
Remove
Cable
27W1
from
GMT grounding connector . (5)
Stow
Cable
27W1
in
GMT
curbside stowage box.
VIEW ON REAR CURBSIDE GMT
h.
Remove GMT ladder and stow it on GMT.
(1 )
Lift ladder from support slots .
CONTINUED
2-377
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
28
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
Continued .
(2)
Slide ladder into ladder stowage bracket under canisters on rear curbside of GMT.
CURBSIDE
-PIN
BRACKET
29
PIN
LADDER
(3)
Aline holes in top and bottom of GMT ladder with holes in stowage bracket .
(4)
Press and hold pushbutton on quick- release pin and slide pin through holes in ladder and bracket to secure ladder.
STOW WRECKER HOOK AND BOOM .
a.
Signal crane operator to retract boom .
CONTINUED C
2-378
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
29
b.
Continued .
Remove clip from two boom
ex-
tension retaining pins . Pull retaining pins from boom.
CLIPS
RETAINING PINS
C.
Signal
crane
operator to slowly
raise crane block until it contacts
EXTENSION
end of boom extension .
BOOM d.
Signal crane operator to continue to retract cable until boom extension is pulled to fully
retracted
position .
e.
Aline holes in boom and holes in extension . Insert the two retaining SHIPPER pins and secure with clips .
CRANE BLOCK
CONTINUED
2-379
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
29
Continued .
DO NOT STAND UNDER BOOM OR IN PATH OF BOOM. INJURY OR
DEATH
MAY
RESULT IF STRUCK BY MOVING
WARNING
BOOM.
f.
horizontal posi-
Lower boom to tion ,
centered
between
rear
wheels and fully retracted.
O.O ROADSIDE
g.
Install crane pivot- post lockpin to secure crane .
MOIRASTO
MOOR of
eld
O.O
0
ROADSIDE DONAT
nia LOCKPIN
h.
Signal crane operator to let out enough cable so that crane hook can be stowed in eye on side of shipper.
CONTINUED
2-380
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-31 .
29
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
-
i.
Continued .
Signal crane operator to retract cable until hook and cable are secure against shipper.
j.
30
Crane operator can secure crane operations .
PREPARE WRECKER FOR TRAVEL.
G
WARNIN
WEAR WORK GLOVES AND BE CAREFUL WHEN RAISING OUTRIGGERS TO PREVENT INJURY TO HANDS.
a.
Install outrigger handle
in screw
collar at top of outrigger.
b.
Using handle turn outrigger screw collar until outrigger base is lifted clear of ground . Remove handle .
C.
Grasp outrigger leg
and
turn it
clockwise to continue lifting base from ground . Continue until you reach screw stop .
CONTINUED
2-381
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
30
d.
Continued .
Remove L-shaped from
side
retaining
pin
of outrigger storage
tube .
RETAINING PIN
e.
Two crewmembers raise outrigger leg to horizontal,
then
push
leg
into storage tube.
NOTE
Perform steps f thru h for rear outrigger legs only.
f.
Remove retaining clip and pull retaining pin to release base from outrigger leg .
g.
Install pin in base and secure with retaining clip.
RETAINING PIN CONTINUED
CLIP
2-382
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD
-
- Continued
Continued.
30
h.
Store outrigger base on wrecker as follows :
(1 )
Lower base over threaded post on wrecker bed.
CLAMP HANDLE
Place clamp bar on threaded
(2)
CLAMP BAR
post, straddling base mounting bracket. (3)
THREADED POST
Screw handle onto threaded post to secure base to wrecker bed .
O CURBSIDE
i.
Aline retaining pin holes in leg with retaining pin holes in storage tube . Install retaining pin .
NOTE
Figure below is typical . Front outriggers have base attached .
ए
l
Youl
j.
Repeat steps a thru i above until all four outriggers are stowed .
k.
Have wrecker operator verify outrigger storage .
CONTINUED
2-383
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
31
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued
PREPARE GMT FOR TRAVEL.
a.
Aline wrecker with the GMT.
b.
Slowly back wrecker into position .
Be sure that kingpin
on GMT is in line
with fifth wheel jaws on wrecker.
CURBSIDE
C.
Before GMT kingpin plate begins to ride wrecker approach ramp , check that kingpin plate is above approach ramps .
d.
Slowly back wrecker until coupler
APPROACH RAMP
jaws on fifth wheel engage GMT kingpin .
COUPLER JAWS FIFTH WHEEL &
e.
Make sure that coupling is secure by inching wrecker forward . If coupling
is
not locked , rock wrecker back and forth slowly until kingpin is locked in fifth wheel.
CONTINUED
-384
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
31
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD- Continued
-
f.
Continued .
Remove landing leg hand crank from retaining clip on curbside of GMT, and pull it out until it locks in place .
O CURBSIDE
ROTATED 90°
g.
Using hand crank , raise GMT landing legs until they are completely elevated , and then secure hand crank in stowed position.
h.
Install landing legs travel chain if applicable .
CONTINUED
2-385
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
31
i.
Continued .
Get SERVICE and side of wrecker.
EMERGENCY air lines from stowage
bracket on either
EMERGENCY AIRLINE STOWAGE BRACKET SERVICE AIRLINE
3012
AIR LINE SHUT OFF VALVE
E AIR HOSE
TYPICAL 2 PLACES CURBSIDE
j.
Connect SERVICE and GMT .
k.
Open shutoff valves on both air lines.
EMERGENCY air lines to glad
hand connectors on
CONTINUED
2-386
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-31 .
GUIDED MISSILE RELOAD - Continued -
31
Continued .
I.
Connect over-the - road electrical cable from wrecker to GMT as follows :
(1)
Raise dust cover.
(2)
Push
over- the - road
DUST 'COVER cable
straight into GMT connector.
(3)
Hook spring -loaded dust cover onto cable connector to secure
&
cable . FRONT OF GMT
Remove chock blocks from GMT wheels and stow on GMT.
3
m.
ELECTRICAL CABLE
n.
Wrecker operator get in
cab and
operate lights
and
brakes .
Have
another
crewmember verify that GMT and wrecker lights work properly.
Procedures to be performed at this point depend on orders reNOTE
ceived . If LS is to rejoin firing platoon , crewmembers perform emplacement per para 2-8. If road march is to be performed , crewmembers perform march order per para 2-30
2-387
TM 9-1440-600-10
Section IV .
2-32 .
OPERATION UNDER UNUSUAL CONDITIONS
CHEMICAL , BIOLOGICAL , AND RADIOLOGICAL ENVIRONMENT
The launching station ( LS) is remotely operated . No special requirements are necessary to operate in this environment. Personnel comply with SOP for their protection .
2-33 .
1
HIGH VELOCITY WINDS
Road march - When wind speed is over 51
mph (45 knots) the launching station
(LS) should be parked in a protected place and tied down . 9-2330-357-14 for tiedown instructions .
2
2-34.
1
See semitrailer TM
Emplaced When wind speed is over 96.5 mph (85 knots) the LS must be tied down. See semitrailer TM 9-2330-357-14 for tiedown instructions .
EXTREME COLD WEATHER OPERATION
See TM 5-6115-464-12 for Generator Set A6 cold weather operation . Generator Set A6 requires special preparation when temperature reaches -25° F (-31.7°C) .
2
See TM 9-2330-357-14 for semitrailer cold weather operation .
CONTINUED
G
2-388
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-34 .
3
EXTREME COLD WEATHER OPERATION - Continued
Remove all snow and ice from snow and ice from :
•
launcher mechanics
(LM ) .
Be sure you
remove
Azimuth bearing gear teeth ( 1 ) .
Azimuth actuator pinion gear teeth (2). •
Two vent holes in each elevation actuator gear case (3) .
ROADSIDE TYPICAL 2 PLACES SHOWN RAISED
2 1
CONTINUED
2-389
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-34.
EXTREME COLD WEATHER OPERATION - Continued
Remove snow and ice from both air 4
exhaust louvers ( 1 ) and air inlet louver (2) on Launcher Electronics Module ( LEM ) A1
and
Data
Link
Terminal
1 2
Module ( DLTM) A2. Cover louvers as soon as possible after shutdown .
TYPICAL LEM A1 DLTM A2
Remove snow and ice from both air 5
flow louvers
on
Launcher
Missile
Round Distributor (LMRD) A3.
TYPICAL BOTH SIDES
NOTE
Perform steps 6 thru 10 below only when directed to turn canister
heaters on .
Remove canister heater Power Control
N
IO
6
UT
Box 23A1 cover by loosening 14 cap-
CA
0 C 12 VA
tive screws .
CONTINUED
C
2-390
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-34.
7
EXTREME COLD WEATHER OPERATION- Continued
O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O
On LEM Power Distribution Unit (PDU ) A1A2 , set CNVC OUT CANISTER
G
BLOWER OPE HTR AC circuit breaker to ON .
BLOWER ON OFF LCHRSVDCELEX PWRSPLY O
CNVC OUT CANISTER HTR AC
OFF
ENVE OUT CANISTERHTH
ON
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC MAIN A ON OFF
PWRORGSPLY ON OFF
LCHRELEX 28VDC SPLY FWR
MSL5VDC FWRSPLY
OFF
OFF
MOT UNITCONT AC ON OFF
MISSILE HEATER AC LIPA & MSL UPA AMSL ON OFF OFF
MAIN 8 ON OFF MS GYRO-CLOCK PWR SPLY ON OFF
PAFUTTL PWR SPLY
MS TWTFIL SPLY PWR ON OFF
OFF
LIVEL MOL OFF
LWRR MS ON OFF LAMPS ON OFF TEST
O
O
OFF
O
O
O
O
0
Ꮎ CANISTER HEATER POWER
8
UPHL LWRL UPRA LWRR
On Power Control Box 23A1 , set four CANISTER HEATER POWER circuit breakers to ON .
O
9
O
Insure that four CANISTER HEATER POWER lights are on .
GASKET ON POWER CONTROL BOX 23A1 COVER MUST BE PROPERLY SEATED AND SCREWS TIGHT TO KEEP WATER OUT OF POWER CONTROL BOX 23A1 .
CAUTION
10
Install canister heater Power Control Box 23A1 cover, and secure by tight-
ION E R
AUT
ening 14 captive screws.
NOTE
Perform steps 11
thru
15 below when directed to turn canister
heaters off.
CONTINUED
2-391
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-34.
11
EXTREME COLD WEATHER OPERATION - Continued
Remove canister heater Power Control
Box 23A1 cover by loosening 14 captive screws .
7B B B B ON
TI
U CA
0 C 12 VA
0 12 TP
@ CANISTER HEATER POWER
On Power Control Box 23A1 , set four CANISTER HEATER POWER circuit breakers to OFF .
9
0000 UPAL LWRL UPRR LWAR
13
Insure that four CANISTER HEATER POWER lights are off.
GASKET ON POWER CONTROL BOX 23A1 MUST BE PROPERLY SEATED AND SCREWS TIGHT TO KEEP WATER OUT OF POWER CONTROL BOX 23A1 . CAUTION
14
Install canister heater Power Control Box 23A1 cover, and secure by tightening 14 captive screws.
N
TIO
CAU
LO
CONTINUED
2-392
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-34.
EXTREME COLD WEATHER OPERATION - Continued
15 | On LEM - PDU A1A2 , set CNVC OUT CANISTER HTR AC circuit breaker to
O O O LCHR ELEX MDL POWER DISTRIBUTION UNIT O O BLOWER OPE
0
OFF . o
CNVC OUT CANISTER HTR AC Θ ON Θ
BLOWER OFF LCHRELEX PWR3 VDCSPLY O
LAUNCH ELECTRONICS AC MAINA O OFF
FWRORDSPL OFF
ELEX LCHR SPLY PWR28 VDC Ofe OFF
MAIN 8 OFF
MSL PWR5VDC SPLY
LOCK GVROPWR CSPLY
OFF
OFF
MSL PAFUITL FWR SPLY ON OFF
MS TWTFIL PWR SPLY ON OFF
O
MISSILE HEATER AC UPE MSL LIPA MSL ON ON CIFF OFF
LWR MSL OFF
OFF
OFF
O
CNVC OUTNTA CANISTER ON
MOT AC UNITCONT ON OFF
LAMPS TEST
®
O
16
Remove drain plug and drain water from LEM A1 , DLTM A2, and LMRD A3 immediately after shutdown per para 2-6.
17
After shutdown , call organizational maintenance , remove air filters and inspect them for dirt, in it.
dust,
and
moisture .
Replace
any filter that
is clogged
or has
moisture
18
Refer to TM 21-305 for special instructions on driving hazards .
19
When performing maintenance in rain or snow , use weather shield to protect LEM A1 or DLTM A2 . Assemble weather shield per para 2-39 . 2-40 .
Disassemble per para
CONTINUED
2-393
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-35.
EXTREME HOT WEATHER OPERATION
1
See TM 5-6115-464-12 for Generator Set A6 hot weather operation .
2
See TM 9-2330-357-14 for semitrailer hot weather operation .
3
Organizational maintenance should
remove air filters often and inspect them for
dirt, dust and moisture . Replace any filter that is clogged or has moisture in it.
2-36 .
1
SANDY OR DUSTY CONDITIONS
Use the general guides listed below for all launching station ( LS) parts :
•
Use shelters when possible to protect from blowing sand and dust.
•
Keep doors and panels closed as much as possible.
Remove sand and dust from inlets , outlets , and moving parts.
2
See TM 5-6115-464-12 for operating Generator Set A6 in sandy or dusty conditions .
3
See TM 9-2330-357-14 for operating semitrailer in sandy or dusty conditions .
CONTINUED
2-394
Remove sand and dust from :
•
Azimuth bearing gear teeth ( 1 ) .
•
Azimuth actuator pinion gear teeth (2). Two vent holes in each elevation actuator gear case (3) .
3 ROADSIDE TYPICAL 2 PLACES SHOWN RAISED
2
10
О (
4
SANDY OR DUSTY CONDITIONS 1 Continued
B
2-36 .
です
APP
TM 9-1440-600-10
[
CONTINUED
2-395
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-36.
5
SANDY OR DUSTY CONDITIONS - Continued
Remove sand and dust from both air exhaust louvers ( 1 ) and air inlet louver (2) on Launcher Electronics Module ( LEM ) A1
and Data Link Terminal Module ( DLTM )
A2 . Cover louvers as soon as possible after shutdown.
2
TYPICAL LEM A1 DLTM A2
6
Call organizational
maintenance to clean
doors and
panels gaskets
every time
before closing . Sand and dust will lower shielding effect and damage gaskets .
7
Shorten preventive maintenance checks and services interval for lubrication and air filter replacement .
8
When performing
maintenance ,
use weather shield to protect LEM A1
or DLTM
A2 . Assemble weather shield per para 2-39. Disassemble per para 2-40.
CONTINUED
2-396
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-37.
HIGH HUMIDITY
It is usually raining when humidity is high . Even when it is not raining high humidity will cause metal to rust. Keep metal clean and apply touch-up paint to surfaces where paint is broken .
1
Use the general guides listed below for all launching station (LS) parts : •
Use shelters when possible to protect from rain or snow.
•
Keep doors and panels closed as much as possible .
2
See TM 5-6115-464-12 for operating Generator Set A6 in high humidity.
3
See TM 9-2330-357-14 for operating semitrailer in high humidity.
4
Cover air exhaust louvers and air inlet louver on Launcher Electronics Module (LEM ) A1 and Data Link Terminal Module (DLTM) A2 as soon as possible after shutdown.
TYPICAL LEM A1 DLTM A2
5
Call organizational
maintenance to clean doors and
panels gaskets
every time
before closing . Moisture will lower gaskets shielding effect . CONTINUED
2-397
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-37.
6
HIGH HUMIDITY - Continued
Shorten
preventive
maintenance checks
and services
interval for lubrication ,
filter replacement , water draining and water removal from LEM A1 door channels .
7
When performing maintenance , use weather shield to protect LEM A1 A2. Assemble weather shield per para 2-39 . Disassemble per para 2-40.
8
Observe humidity indicator on each guided missile (GM) instrument panel . to TM 9-1410-600-14 for services .
2-398
air
and DLTM A2
or DLTM
Refer
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-38 .
CHANGING WEATHER
ALL 16 CANISTER TIEDOWN BOLTS MUST BE RETORQUED WHEN
OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE
HAS
BEEN
BELOW 32°F
(0°C) AND RISES ABOVE 32° F (0°C). CAUTION
GUIDED MISSILE (4)
UPPER TIEDOWN BOLT TYPICAL 8 PLACES ROADSIDE
LOWER TIEDOWN BOLT TYPICAL 8 PLACES
Personnel Required . Two Tools and Equipment Required . Head Ratchet, 1 /2- In . Drive
Handle, Wrench , Torque , 30-150 Foot- Pounds Extension , 1 /2- In . Drive, 30- In . Long CONTINUED
Socket , Deep Well , 3/4- In . , 1 /2- In . Drive
2-399
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-38 .
1
CHANGING WEATHER- Continued
Set the torque wrench handle micrometer for 60 foot- pounds of torque .
2
Climb up on
the
upper canisters .
the two lower inside tiedown clicks off at 60 foot- pounds .
Get
between
bolts on that end
།། 1 2
NDS POUOT FO-
6
3877
canisters
on
one
end .
until the torque wrench
Tighten handle
3
Tighten the two upper inside tiedown bolts until the torque wrench handle clicks off at 60 foot-pounds.
4
Repeat steps 2 and 3 for the four inside tiedown bolts on the other end .
5
Climb down from the top . Tighten the eight upper and lower outside tiedown bolts until the torque wrench clicks off at 60 foot- pounds .
2-400
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-39.
WEATHER SHIELD ASSEMBLY
Weather shield may be installed on Launcher Electronics module (LEM ) A1
or Data
Link Terminal Module ( DLTM ) A2.
CURBSIDE
Personnel Required . Two
FRONT STOWAGE CONTAINER
Tools and Equipment Required . None
1
On
curbside ,
release
hood latch
securing front stowage container end cover.
2
Remove bag containing weather shield kit from container.
8
3
Release three snap fasteners securing bag cover.
4
Remove weather shield kit from bag .
CONTINUED
2-401
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-39 .
5
WEATHER SHIELD ASSEMBLY- Continued
Put bag back in storage hood latch .
container.
Close container end cover and secure with
There are two support arms in kit. When support arms are inNOTE
6
stalled , the two hangers must be inboard and pointing up.
Install one support arm (2) in module
2 right side support blocks ( 1 ) with two
1 hangers (3) inboard and pointing up. Spring pin (4) must seat between two 3 support block pins (5).
7
Install other support arm in module left side support above .
block,
same as step 6
5
NOTE
8
If cross supports are installed in weather shield , go to step 10 below.
Lay weather shield on flat surface with inside down . The two sewn channels are on the inside. Fold side and back panels over the outside.
9
Insert one cross support into each sewn channel. Holes in ends of cross support should be visible on each end. Holes will clip into support arms installed above .
VIEW TURNED OVER FOR CLARITY
2-402
CONTINUED
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-39.
WEATHER SHIELD ASSEMBLY- Continued
If steps 8 and 9 were performed , go to step 11 .
NOTE
10
Unroll weather shield . Lay it on flat surface with inside down .
11
Using two people lift weather shield . Clip holes in each end of each cross support (3) into hangers ( 1 ) on support arms (2).
3
2
12
Fasten top of weather shield to top of module with 13 snap fasteners .
13
Fold side
and
back
panels
down .
Fasten side panels to side of module . Four snap fasteners on each side.
CONTINUED
2-403
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-39 .
14
WEATHER SHIELD ASSEMBLY- Continued
Fasten back panel to side panels. Eight snap fasteners on each side .
Three metal grommets at bottom
NOTE
2-404
of each side
used to tie panels to ground anchors.
panel
may be
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-40 .
WEATHER SHIELD DISASSEMBLY
CURBSIDE
FRONT STOWAGE CONTAINER
Personnel Required . Two Tools and Equipment Required . None
1
On
curbside ,
release
hood
latch
securing front stowage container end cover.
2
Remove weather shield kit bag from container.
NOTE
If side and rear panels are tied to ground be untied .
anchors they must
CONTINUED
2-405
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-40 .
3
WEATHER SHIELD DISASSEMBLY - Continued
Unsnap eight snap fasteners on each side that
secure
rear panel to
side
panels.
4
5
Neatly fold rear panel and two side panels over top of weather shield.
6
Unsnap
13
Unsnap four snap fasteners on each side that secure side panels to module.
fasteners that secure
weather shield to top of module .
CONTINUED
2-406
TM 9-1440-600-10
2-40.
WEATHER SHIELD DISASSEMBLY
- Continued
7
Using two people , lift weather shield to raise two cross supports ( 1 ) off support arm (2) hangers.
8
Lay weather shield
on flat surface .
Tightly roll weather shield cross supports inside .
2
up with
2 9
Install rolled up weather shield in bag .
1 10
Remove two support arms
(2) from
module support blocks (1 ).
11
Install two support arms in bag.
12
Close bag and secure with three snap fasteners .
13
Install bag containing weathershield kit in stowage container.
14
Close stowage container end cover and secure with hood latch .
CONTINUED
2-407
TM 9-1440-600-10 2-41 .
LIGHTNING SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
When possible, launching stations (LS) should be emplaced on sites with air terminals on telephone poles or towers and connected to earth through down conductors . When air terminals are not used , crewmembers must insure the LS is grounded through the ground rods . When lightning is near perform the following when directed by the Unit Commander:
1
Rotate platform to 180° position per para 2-22.
2
Lower platform per para 2-20 .
3
Power-down LS per para 2-11 .
4
Leave LS. Stay at least 800 feet (244 meters) away.
NOTE
When directed by Unit Commander to return to operation , perform the following :
€
5
Power- up LS per para 2-10.
6
Raise platform per para 2-19.
7
Rotate platform to azimuth directed by engagement control station (ECS) per para 2-22.
ENGAGEMENT CONTROL HANDLE
MUST BE
IN ROTATE
POSITION FOR ECS TO HAVE REMOTE CONTROL OF AZIMUTH POSITION. CAUTION
CONTINUED
2-408
TM 9-1440-600-10
APPENDIX A REFERENCES
A- 1 .
SCOPE
This appendix lists all forms, field manuals , and technical manuals referenced in this manual .
A-2.
A-3 .
A-4 .
FORMS
Recommended Changes to DA Publications
DA Form 2028-2
Quality Deficiency Report
SF 368
FIELD MANUALS
Basic Cold Weather Manual
FM 31-70
Field Artillery Survey
FM 6-2
First Aid for Soldiers
FM 21-11
Visual Signals
FM 21-60
TECHNICAL MANUALS
Hot Weather Clothing and Equipment
TM 10-276
Operator and Organizational Maintenance Manual: Generator Set, Diesel
TM 5-6115-464-12
Driven, Tactical Skid MTD. 15KW, 3 phase, 4 wire , 120/208 and 240/416 volts Operator , Organizational , and Intermediate
TM 9-1410-600-14
Maintenance Manual : Guided Missile , Aerial Intercept MIM- 104 Operator, Organizational , DS and GS
TM 9-2330-357-14
Maintenance Manual : Semitrailer , Flatbed, Radar Set and Launching Station M860 and M860A1
A- 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
A-4 .
TECHNICAL MANUALS - Continued
Organizational Maintenance Manual :
TM 9-1440-600-20
Launching Station M901 , Guided Missile, Semitrailer Mounted PATRIOT System Description
TM 9-1425-600-10
Shipping and Limited Storage
TM 9-1425-609-15
The Army Maintenance
TM 38-750
Management System (TAMMS)
A- 5 .
MISCELLANEOUS PUBLICATIONS
Electronics Key Generator KG - 30
KAO- 137E/TSEC
Lubrication Order: Launching Station M901 , Guided Missile , Semitrailer
LO 9-1440-600-14
Mounted
A- 2
TM 9-1440-600-10
APPENDIX B COMPONENTS OF END ITEM AND BASIC ISSUE ITEMS LISTS
Section I.
B -1 .
INTRODUCTION
SCOPE
This appendix lists components of end item and basic issue items for the launching station to help you inventory items required for safe and efficient operation .
B-2.
GENERAL
The Components of End Item and Basic Issue Items Lists are divided into the following sections:
Section II . Components of End Item . This listing is for informational purposes only, and is not authority to
requisition
replacements . These items are part of the end
item , but are removed and separately packaged for transportation or shipment. As part of the end item , these items must be with the end item whenever it is issued or transferred between property accounts . Illustrations are furnished to assist you in identifying the items .
b.
Section III . Basic Issue Items . These are the minimum essential items required
to place the launching station in operation , to operate it , and to perform emergency repairs . Although shipped separately packaged , BII must be with the launching station during operation
and whenever it is transferred
between
property accounts .
The illustrations will
assist you with hard -to-identify items . This manual is your authority to request/requisition replacement BII , based on TOE/MTOE authorization of the end item.
B -3 .
EXPLANATION OF COLUMNS
The following provides an explanation of columns found in the tabular listings.
a. Column (1 ) - Illustration Number ( Illus number of the illustration in which the item is shown .
Number) .
This column
indicates the
B-1
TM 9-1440-600-10
Section I.
INTRODUCTION - Continued
b.
Column (2)
National Stock Number. Indicates the National stock number as-
signed to the item and will be used for requisitioning purposes . c.
Column (3)
Description . Indicates the federal item
name and , if required , a
minimum description to identify and locate the item . The last line for each item indicates the FSCM (in parentheses) followed by the part number . If item needed differs for different models of this equipment , the column.
d.
model is shown
under the " Usable On "
heading in this
Column (4) - Unit of Measure ( U/M) . Indicates the measure used in performing
the actual operation/maintenance function . This measure is expressed by a two-character alphabetical abbreviation (e.g. , ea , in , pr) .
e. Column (5) - Quantity Required (Qty Rqr) . Indicates the quantity of the item authorized to be used with/on the equipment .
B-2
TM 9-1440-600-10
Section II .
COMPONENTS OF END ITEM
1
2
(1) ILLUS NUMBER
(2) NATIONAL STOCK NUMBER
1
1290-00-614-0008
(3) DESCRIPTION FSCM AND PART NUMBER
Aiming Circle M2 (in
U/M
(5) QTR RQR
EA
1
EA
6
EA
1
EA
1
EA
1
EA
1
EA
1
(4) USABLE ON CODE
storage box curbside)
(19200 ) 5800554 Not Illus-
Batteries (in storage
trated
box curbside) (55716) W-B-101
Not
Bell Crank (stored aft
Illustrated Not Illustrated
of launcher) ( 18876) 10250775-1
Container, Storage (located below launcher in front) (18876) 10250909-29
Not Illustrated
Not Illustrated 2
Container, Storage (aft end of launcher) (18876) 10250907-39 Coupling , Engagement (aft launcher) ( 18876) 10250774-1 Crank, Hand Actuator
(in storage box roadside) ( 18876) 10250828-29
B-3
TM 9-1440-600-10
Section II .
COMPONENTS OF END ITEM - Continued
4
3
5
6
(1 ) ILLUS NUMBER
Not Illus-
(2) NATIONAL STOCK NUMBER
5810-01-090-0814
(3) DESCRIPTION FSCM AND PART NUMBER
Electronic , Key
U/M
(5) QTR RQR
EA
1
EA
3
EA
1
EA
1
EA
1
EA
1
EA
1
(4) USABLE ON CODE
Generator TSEC/
trated
KG-30-124 (98230) (5A2A1 )
Not
Flashlight, Spec. (in
Illus-
storage box curbside)
trated 3
(55717) MIL- F-3747 1290-00-891-9999
Gunner Quadrant Fire
Control M1A1 (in storage box curbside)
(19200) 7197156 Not
Handle, Engagement
Illus-
(stored aft on
trated
launcher) ( 18876) 10250773-19
4
Kit , Weather Shield (in storage container 10250907-29) (18876) ( 10253780-19)
5
1440-00-109-1466
Lead , Electrical (stored roadside ) (18876) 10253829-9
6
6675-00-244-0446
Level, Rod MIL-
L-11566 (81349)
B-4
TM 9-1440-600-10
COMPONENTS OF END ITEM - Continued
Section II .
8
7
CBBB
HI 9
B
(1) ILLUS NUMBER
(2) NATIONAL STOCK NUMBER
7
(3) DESCRIPTION FSCM AND PART NUMBER
Missile Round Cable
U/M
(5) QTR RQR
EA
1
EA
2
EA
1
EA
1
EA
1
EA
1
(4) USABLE ON CODE
Test Set (stored aft of launcher) (18876) 11450280-29
Not
Pin , Quick Release
Illus-
(accompanies stor-
trated
age box curbside) (18876) 10250219-2
8
6675-00-514-5575
Pole, Range MILP-20192 (stored
aft of launcher) (81349) Not
Radio Set (stored
Illus-
in cab of truck )
trated
(80063) SC- D866058
9
5975-00-878-3791
Rod , Ground ST2 ,
TY2 (stored roadside) MIL-
R-11461 ( 81349) Not Illustrated
Security Equipment
(stored in cab of truck) (80063) SC- D-866060
B-5
TM 9-1440-600-10
Section II .
COMPONENTS OF END ITEM - Continued
10
(1 ) ILLUS NUMBER
(3) DESCRIPTION FSCM AND PART NUMBER
(2) NATIONAL STOCK NUMBER
Not
Spare Tire Kit
Illus-
U/M
(5) QTR RQR
EA
1
EA
2
EA
2
EA
1
(4)
U/M
(5) QTR RQR
EA
1
(4) USABLE ON CODE
(stored aft of
trated
truck) ( 18702) 12258236
Not
Support Tiedown
Illus-
(stored in storage
trated
container 10250907-
29) (18876) 10250219-2 10
Tool Kit (in
roadside storage box) ( 18876) 10252289-19
Not
Tape, Measuring (in storage box curb-
Illustrated
side) (55717) GGG-T- 106
Section III .
BASIC ISSUE ITEMS
1
(1) ILLUS NUMBER
3-6
1
(2) NATIONAL STOCK NUMBER
7510-00-889-3494
(3) DESCRIPTION FSCM AND PART NUMBER
Logbook Cover ( 19207) 11677003
USABLE ON CODE
TM 9-1440-600-10
APPENDIX C ADDITIONAL AUTHORIZATION
Section I.
C- 1 .
LIST
INTRODUCTION
SCOPE
This appendix lists additional items you are authorized for the support of the launching station .
C - 2.
GENERAL
This list identifies items that do
not have to accompany the launching station and
that do not have to be turned in with it . These items are all authorized to you by CTA , MTOE, TDA, or JTA.
C-3 .
EXPLANATION OF LISTING
National stock numbers , descriptions , and quantities are provided to help you identify and
request the additional items you
require to support this equipment . The items are
listed in alphabetical sequence by item name under the type document ( i.e. , CTA, MTOE , TDA, or JTA) which authorizes the item (s ) to you . If the item you require differs between serial numbers of the same model , effective serial numbers are shown in the last line of the description .
C- 1
TM 9-1440-600-10 Section II .
(1 ) NATIONAL STOCK NUMBER
ADDITIONAL AUTHORIZATION LIST
(2) DESCRIPTION FSCM & PART NUMBER
USABLE ON CODE
(3)
(4)
U/M
QTY AUTH
EA
3
EA
3
EA
1
EA
1
EA
1
EA
1
EA
1
EA
1
EA
3
EA
1
EA
1
MTOE AUTHORIZED ITEMS 1080-00-623-7295
CAMOUFLAGE SCREEN SUPPORT SYSTEM WOODLAND/DESERT PLASTIC POLES (97403)
1080-00-103-1246
CAMOUFLAGE SCREEN SYSTEM : WOODLAND LT. WT. RADAR SET W/O SUPPORT SYSTEM (98230)
5810-01-058-2513
CASE , BATTERY 2 -A1J/TSEC ON 199089 (98230)
5820-00-351-3003
INSTALLATION KIT, MK- 1454/UR/VRC 53, 64, GRC 125, 160 (80063)
5820-01-063-1984
INSTALLATION KIT, 1910/VF/GRC- 160 IN M818 SC- D-866058
(80063) 5810-01-043-1047
INSTALLATION KIT, MK- 1852/VRC F/KY- 57 W/GRC- 160- IN M818 (80063)
5820-00-223-7473
RADIO SET ; AN/GRC- 160 (80063) PPL-4326
5810-01-026-9621
VEHICULAR POWER SUPPLY VPS HYP-57 TSEC (98230) ON 241780
CTA AUTHORIZED ITEMS 4240-00-022-2946
AURAL PROTECTOR : SOUND W/O HELEMET
(81349) MIL- P -38268 8465-00-001-6476
SHELF CARGO SUPPORT RACKSACK
(81349) MIL-S-43834 8465-00-001-6477
STRAP, WEBBING (ARGO TIEDOWN) (81349) MIL- S-43828
C- 2
TM 9-1440-600-10
APPENDIX D EXPENDABLE SUPPLIES AND MATERIALS LIST
Section I.
D- 1 .
INTRODUCTION
SCOPE
This appendix lists expendable supplies and materials you will need to operate and maintain the launching station . These items are authorized to you
by CTA 50-970 ,
Ex-
pendable Items (Except Medical , Class V , Repair Parts , and Heraldic Items) .
D-2.
EXPLANATION OF COLUMNS
a.
Column ( 1 ) - Item Number. This number is assigned to the entry in the listing
and is referenced in the narrative instructions to identify the material ( e.g. , “ Use cleaning compound , item 5 , App . D" ) .
Level . This column identifies the lowest level of maintenance that b. Column (2) requires the listed item .
C - Operator/Crew
O - Organizational Maintenance H - Intermediate Maintenance
c.
Column (3) - National Stock Number. This is the National stock number assigned
to the item ; use it to request or requisition the item .
d. Column (4) - Description . Indicates the Federal item name and , if required , a description to identify the item . The last line for each item indicates the Federal Supply Code for Manufacturer (FSCM ) in parentheses followed by the part number.
D-1
TM 9-1440-600-10
Section I.
e.
INTRODUCTION - Continued
Column (5) - Unit of Measure ( U/M) . Indicates the measure used in performing
the actual maintenance function . This measure is expressed by a two- character alphabetical abbreviation (e.g. , ea , in , pr) . If the unit of measure differs from the unit of issue , requisition the lowest unit of issue that will satisfy your requirements.
Section II .
D-2
(1 ) ITEM NUMBER
1
EXPENDABLE SUPPLIES AND MATERIEL LIST
(4)
(5)
LEVEL
(3) NATIONAL STOCK NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
U/M
C
9505-00-221-2650
Wire, nonelectrical
LB
(2)
TM 9-1440-600-10 GLOSSARY
AAL
BII
Additional authorization list
LP
Lubrication order
LOS
Line-of-sight Lower right
Basic Issue Items LR
BITE
Built-in-test - equipment
CCIP
Computer-To-Communications interface processor
CTA
Components of end item list Common table of allowances
DLT
Data link terminal
DLTM
Data link terminal module
ECS Engagement control station
FP FSCM
Motor control unit
MRCTS
Missile round cable test set
MTOE
Modified table of equipment
para PCP
Paragraph Power control panel
PDU
Power distribution unit
PIFA
Power input filter assembly Preventive maintenance
PMCS Federal supply code for manufacturers
checks and service
QDR
Quality deficiency report
Guided missile transporter
RS
Radar set
Joint table of allowances
SOP
Standard operating procedure
TDA
Table of distribution and allow-
TM TOE
Technical manual
Table of equipment
T.W.T.
Traveling wave tube
Guided missile
GMT
JTA LCU
Launch control unit
LE
Launcher electronics
LED
Light emitting diode Launcher electronics module
LL
MCU
Firing platoon
GM
LEM
Launching station Launching station test set
ances
LM
Lower left Launcher mechanics
LMRD
Launcher missile tributor
round
dis-
OFF
COEIL
LS LSTS
UL
Upper left
UR
Upper right
GLOSSARY 1 /(GLOSSARY 2 blank)
)
)
TM 9-1440-600-10
INDEX Para
Subject
Page
A Actuators , elevation Electrically lower
2-20
2-190
Electrically raise Location and description
2-19
2-185
1-6
1-12
Manual operation
2-21
2-195
Principles of operation
2-1D
2-28
Aiming circle 1-6
1-11
2-8
2-94
Location and purpose
2-1D
2-28
Use
2-8
2-111
Storage
Use in emplacement Alignment datum
Alinement pin 2-31
2-342
2-1D
2-28
Location and description
1-6
1-8
Principles of operation
2-1D
2-29
2-29
2-243
Electrically operate
2-22
2-199
Location
1-6
1-13
Manual operations
2-23
2-202
Nomenclature cross- reference
1-4
1-2
2-1D
2-29
Inspection Location and purpose Antenna , data link
Auto synchronizing , data link Azimuth actuator
Principles of operation Azimuth bearing
Location and description Principles of operation Azimuth drive motor
Location
1-6
1-13
2-1
2-29
1-6
1-13
Nomenclature cross- reference
1-4
1-2
Purpose
2-1D
2-29
Azimuth drive unit
Location and description Principles of operation Azimuth limits and rates
1-6
1-13
2-1D
2-29
1-8
1-16
2-23
2-202
2-18
2-183
Azimuth limit switches (see limit switches , azimuth)
Azimuth manual operations B
Bearing (see azimuth bearing) BITE test
Index 1
TM 9-1440-600-10
INDEX - Continued Para
Subject
Page
Blackout conditions Emplacement Guided missile reload
2-8
2-41
2-31
2-285
March order
2-30
2-247
2-21
2-197
Cold weather operation
2-34
2-390
Controls and indicators
2-1F
2-31
Location and description
1-6
1-11
Single
2-31
2-323
Two-stack
2-31
2-332
1-5
1-4
Changing weather, procedures for
2-38
2-399
Checks, preventive maintenance
2-6
2-35
Chemical , biological , and radiological environment
2-32
2-388
Energizing , control for Location
2-1B
2-17
1-6
1-10
Nomenclature cross-reference
1-4
1-2
2-34
2-388
2-1B
2-13
Brake, elevation motors C Cable test set, missile round (see missile round cable test set) Canister heaters power control box
Canisters, offload
Capabilities and features of equipment CCW and cw limit switches (see limit switches, azimuth) Centrifugal fan (see fan)
Clock power supply
Cold weather operation Computer-To-Communications - Interface Processor (also see data link terminal) Controls and indicators
1-6
1-10
2-1
2-1
Curbside stowage box
1-6
1-11
Front stowage
1-6
1-7
Rear stowage
1-6
1-9
Location Controls and indicators
Containers, location
1-6
1-8
Cross- reference , nomenclature
1-4
1-1
Curbside stowage box , location
1-6
1-11
Roadside stowage box
D
Data link antenna Location and description
1-6
1-8
Principles of operation
2-1D
2-29
Index 2
TM 9-1440-600-10
INDEX - Continued
Subject
Para
Page
Data link mast assembly Location and description
1-6
1-8
Principles of operation
2-1D
2-29
Data link terminal (also see data link terminal module) Assemblies included in
1-4
1-2
Auto synchronizing
2-29
2-243
Loopback test Quick start
2-27
2-227
2-25
2-209
Slave synchronizing
2-28
2-235
Tuning Turn -on
2-26
2-213
2-24
2-205
Controls and indicators
2-1B
2-10
Deenergizing
2-16
2-179
Energizing
2-13
2-167
Location and description
1-6
1-10
Position of controls prior to application of power Preventive maintenance checks and services
2-9
2-127
2-6
2-35
Data link terminal module (also see data link terminal)
Deenergize Data link terminal module
2-16
2-179
Generator set
2-17
2-182
Launcher electronics module
2-15
2-175
Description Major components Controls and indicators
1-6
1-5
2-1
2-1
2-1
2-1
1-7
1-13
1-6
1-13
2-1D
2-29
Dimensions
1-8
1-14
Display panel , LCU (also see launcher electronics module) Controls and indicators
2-1A
2-6
1-6
1-7
Distributor modules , launcher missile round distributor , location
1-6
1-9
DLT power supply ( also see data link terminal ) Controls and indicators
2-1B
2-21
1-6
1-10
Designators , reference Differences between models Digital encoder Location Purpose Digital processor (see computer -to- communication interface processor)
Location
Location
Nomenclature cross- reference Dusty and sandy conditions
1-4
1-2
2-36
2-394
Index 3
TM 9-1440-600-10
INDEX - Continued Para
Page
Subject
E
Electrically operate launcher mechanics Lower
2-20
2-190
Raise
2-19
2-185
2-22
2-199
1-8
1-15
2-1B
2-11
1-6
1-10
Electrically lower
2-20
2-190
Electrically raise
2-19
2-185
Handcrank operations
2-21
2-195
Rotate Electrical power requirements Electronic key generator (also see data link terminal) Controls and indicators Location Elevation actuators
1-6
1-12
2-1D
2-28
Nomenclature cross- reference
1-4
1-2
2-1D
2-28
Purpose
Location and description Principles of operation Elevation drive motors
Elevation handcranks 1-6
1-8
2-21
2-195
1-8
1-15
Storage
Use in operation Elevation limits and rates Emplacement
Maximum ground slope
1-8
1-15
Maximum wind velocity
1-8
1-15
Procedure
2-8
2-39
Site selection
2-8
2-39
16
1-13
2-1
2-29
2-13
2-167
Generator set
2-14
2-169
Launcher electronics module
2-12
2-161
2-1D
2-27
2-1D
2-27
2-1
2-1
2-30
2-251
2-8
2-120
1-8
1-14
Encoder, digital Location Purpose Energizing Data link terminal module
Engagement control handle Location Principles of operation
Engagement control station Control of launching station Transfer control from (go to local)
Transfer control to (go to remote)
Equipment data
Index 4
TM 9-1440-600-1
INDEX - Continued Para
Subject
Page
Equipment description (also see individual equipment)
1-6
1-5
Equipment improvement recommendations
1-3
1-1
Equipment purpose , capabilities , and features Extreme weather operations
1-5
1-4
Changing weather
2-38
2-399
Cold
2-34
2-390
High humidity Hot
2-37
2-397
2-35
2-394
Lightning
2-41
2-408
Sandy or dusty
2-36
2-394
Control for
2-1B
2-17
Location
1-6
1-10
Control for
2-1A
2-3
Location
1-6
1-7
1-4
1-2
1-5
1-4
Launcher/Location alinement data
2-8
2-40
Maintenance
1-2
1-1
1-6
1-7
Low state reporting
2-1C
2-22
Power-down for
2-11
2-152
Power- up following
2-10
2-133
12
1-1
Nomenclature cross - reference
1-4
1-1
Preventive maintenance checks and services
2-6
2-35
2-5
2-33
Controls and indicators
2-1C
2-22
Deenergizing
2-17
2-182
Energizing Location and description
2-14
2-169
1-6
1-6
Nomenclature cross- reference
1-4
1-2
Position of controls prior to application of power
2-9
2-127
Refuel , power-down for
2-11
2-152
Refuel , power- up following
2-10
2-133
F Fan Data link terminal module
Launcher electronics module
Nomenclature cross- reference
Features , equipment Forms
Front stowage container, location
Fuel , generator set
G
General information Maintenance forms , records , and reports
General procedures for services and inspections Generator set
Index 5
TM 9-1440-600-10
INDEX - Continued
Para
Subject
Page
Greasing
2-7
2-38
Guided missile , reload
2-31
2-283
Guided missile transporter , use in reload Gunner's quadrant
2-31
2-283
Storage
1-6
1-11
Use in emplacement
2-8
2-110
H Handcranks, elevation
Storage
1-6
1-8
Use in emplacement
2-8
2-103
Use in operations
2-21
2-195
Height
1-8
1-14
High humidity operations
2-37
2-397
High velocity wind
1-8
1-15
Hot weather operation
2-35
2-394
Improvement recommendations , equipment
1-3
1-1
Indicators , description and use
2-1
2-1
Input requirements , electrical power
1-8
1-15
Inspections , general procedures Intervals, preventive maintenance
2-5
2-33
2-4
2-33
2-1B
2-11
1-6
1-10
2-1D
2-28
K Key generator, electronic (also see data link terminal) Controls and indicators
Location L
Launcher base Description Location
1-6
1-12
Nomenclature cross- reference
1-4
1-3
1-5
1-4
Controls and indicators
2-1A
2-2
Deenergizing
2-15
2-175
Energizing Location and description
2-12
2-161
1-6
1-7
Position of controls prior to application of power
2-9
2-123
Preventive maintenance checks and services
2-6
2-35
Azimuth manual operations
2-23
2-202
Description
1-6
1-12
Electrically lower
2-20
2-190
Launcher electronics , assemblies included in Launcher electronics module
Launcher mechanics
Index 6
TM 9-1440-600-10
INDEX - Continued Subject
Para
Page
Electrically raise
2-19
2-185
Electrically rotate
2-22
2-199
Elevation handcrank operations
2-21
2-195
2-1D
2-27
1-6
1-9
2-31
2-356
Azimuth manual operation
2-23
2-202
Description
1-6
1-12
Electrically lower
2-20
2-190
Electrically raise
2-19
2-185
Principles of operation Launcher missile round distributor
Location and description Test, during reload Launcher platform
Elevation handcrank
2-21
2-195
Principles of operation
2-1D
2-28
Data
1-8
1-14
Description
1-6
1-5
Emplacement March order
2-8
2-39
2-30
2-247
Principles of operation Purpose, capabilities , and features
2-1
2-1
1-5
1-4
Launching station
Reload, guided missiles Launching station test set , nomenclature
2-31
2-283
1-4
1-3
2-1A
2-6
LCU display panel Controls and indicators
Location
1-6
1-7
Nomenclature cross- reference
1-4
1-3
Principles of operation
2-1A
2-6
1-8
1-14
Lightning safety precautions
2-41
2-408
Limits, elevation and azimuth
1-8
1-15
1-4
1-3
Length Leveling (see outrigger control panel)
Limit switches, azimuth (ccw and cw ) Nomenclature cross- reference Principles of operation Local operations , transfer to
2-1D
2-28
2-30
2-251
(also see engagement control station) 1-6
1-5
Loopback, data link terminal
2-27
2-227
Lower launcher platform
2-20
2-190
Lubrication
2-7
2-38
Location and description of major components
Index 7
TM 9-1440-600-10
INDEX - Continued Para
Subject
Page
M Maintenance forms , records , and reports
1-2
1-1
Major components , location and description
1-6
1-5
2-23
2-202
Manual operations Azimuth Elevation
March order, procedure
2-21
2-195
2-30
2-247
2-1E
2-30
Missile round cable test set Controls and indicators
1-6
1-6
2-31
2-356
1-7
1-13
Energizing , control for
2-1A
2-5
Location
1-6
1-7
Nomenclature cross- reference
1-4
1-3
1-4
1-2
2-1D
2-28
Location and description Use during reload Models, differences between Motor, azimuth drive (see azimuth drive motor) Motor control unit
Motors, elevation drive Nomenclature cross-reference Purpose
N Nighttime Emplacement Guided missile reload
2-8
2-41
2-31
2-285
March order
2-30
2-247
1-4
1-1
2-7
2-38
Controls and indicators
2-1G
2-32
Location and description
1-6
1-10
Nomenclature cross- reference Noninterrupt power (see over-the- road power) O
Oiling Outrigger control panel
Use for leveling
2-8
C-79
Use in connecting tractor
2-30
2-275
1-6
1-6
Outriggers, location
Over-the- road power Control for
2-1A
2-5
Deenergize in emplacement
2-8
2-64
Deenergize in power- up
2-10
2-145
Energize in march order
2-30
2-263
Energize in power-down
2-11
2-156
Input requirement
1-8
1-15
Tractor supplied
2-1B
2-10
Use in reload
2-31
2-296
Index 8
C
TM 9-1440-600-10
INDEX - Continued Para
Subject
Page
P Platform , launcher (see launcher platform) Pole, range (see range pole) Pointer Nomenclature cross- reference
Position of controls prior to application of power
1-4
1-3
2-9
2-123
1-8
1-15
Power (also see over-the- road power) Input requirements Power control box , canister heaters (see canister heaters
power control box) Power control panel 25
2-5
Controls and indicators
2-1A
Location
1-6
1-7
2-1B
2-17
Power distribution unit , data link terminal module Controls and indicators
Location
1-6
1-10
Nomenclature cross- reference
1-4
1-3
Controls and indicators
2-1A
2-3
Location
1-6
1-7
Power distribution unit , launcher electronics module
1-4
1-3
Power-down
2-11
2-152
Power input filter assembly, location
1-6
1-10
1-8
1-15
Controls for
2-1B
2-17
Nomenclature cross - reference
1-4
1-3
Controls for
2-1A
2-4
Nomenclature cross- reference
1-4
1-3
2-10
2-133
2-1B
2-17
Pressure switch , launcher electronics module Indicator
2-1A
2-3
Preventive maintenance checks and services
2-6
2-35
Principles of operation
2-1
2-1
1-5
1-4
2-25
2-209
Nomenclature cross- reference
Power, over-the- road (see over-the- road power)
Power requirements , input Power supplies, clock (see clock power supply) Power supplies, data link terminal module
Power supplies , launcher electronics module
Power supply, DLT (see DLT power supply) Power-up Pressure switch , data link terminal module
Indicator
Processor (see computer-to-communications interface processor) Purpose, capabilities and features
Q Quick start , data link terminal
Index 9
TM 9-1440-600-10
INDEX - Continued Para
Subject
Page
R Radio frequency tuner (also see data link terminal) Controls and indicators
2-1B
2-19
Location
1-6
1-10
Radio, voice , location and use
2-1
2-1
Raise launcher platform
2-19
2-185
Storage
1-6
1-7
Use in emplacement
2-8
2-103
Rates , azimuth and elevation
1-8
1-15
Rear stowage container, location
1-6
1-9
Receiver-transmitter (also see data link terminal ) Controls and indicators
2-1B
2-16
1-6
1-10
Range pole
Location
Records and reports
1-2
1-1
Reference designators
2-1
2-1
Reload , guided missile
2-31
2-285
Remote operations , transfer to (also see engagement
2-8
2-120
control station) Reporting of equipment improvement recommendations
1-3
1-1
Responsibility for preventive maintenance
2-3
2-33
1-6
1-8
2-22
2-199
Run time meter
2-1A
2-5
Emplacement
2-8
2-41
Lightning
2-41
2-408
S
Roadside stowage box , location Rotate launcher mechanics
Safety precautions
March order
2-30
2-247
Reload, guided missile
2-31
2-285
Scope of manual
1-1
1-1
Semiautomatic BITE test
2-18
2-183
Controls and indicators
2-1G
2.32
Description
1-6
1-6
Purpose
1-5
1-4
2-5
2-33
1-4
1-3
Semitrailer
Sensor switch (see travel lock sensor switch and zero lock sensor switch ) Services and inspections , general procedures for Shorting plug Nomenclature cross- reference Use in reload
2-31
2-300
Site selection and preparation
2-8
2-39
Sling , canister (use in reload)
2-31
2-320
Index 10
TM 9-1440-600-10
INDEX - Continued Para
Page
After leveling
1-8
1-16
Maximum ground
1-8
1-16
Description
2-1D
2-28
Location
1-6
1-12
Curbside
1-6
1-11
Roadside
1-6
1-8
1-6
1-7
1-6
1-9
Auto
2-29
2-243
Emplacement
2-8
2-113
Slave
2-28
2-235
Subject
Slope
Steadyrest
Stowage box, location
Stowage container, location Front Rear Switch , pressure (see pressure switch) Synchronizing , data link terminal
T
20
Technical principles of operation
2-1
2-1
Temperature, equipment data
1-8
1-16
1-6
1-6
1-5
1-4
Location and purpose
2-1D
2-28
Nomenclature cross- reference
1-4
1-3
Location and purpose
2-1D
2-28
Nomenclature cross- reference
1-4
1-3
Test sets (see launching station test set and missile
round cable test set) Tractor
Description Purpose Travel lockpin
Travel lock sensor switch
Tuner, radio frequency (see radio frequency tuner) Tuning, data link terminal
2-26
2-213
Turn-on, data link terminal Turntable
2-24
2-205
1-6
1-13
Location and description Nomenclature cross- reference
Principles of operation Two-stack offload
1-4
1-3
2-1D
2-28
2-31
2-332
V Vehicle positions, reload
2-31
2-286
Voice radio, location and use
2-1
2-1
Index 11
TM 9-1440-600-10
INDEX - Continued Para
Subject
Page
W Weather (see extreme weather operations) Weather shield Assembly
2-39
2-401
Disassembly
2-40
2-405
Storage
1-6
1-7
1-8
1-14
1-8
1-14
Weight Width
Winds Maximum
1-8
1-15
Operation in high winds
2-33
2-388
2-31
2-286
Engagement control handle positions
2-1D
2-27
Principles of operation
2-1D
2-29
Location and purpose
2-1D
2-29
Nomenclature cross- reference
1-4
1-3
Wrecker, use in reload
N
Zero lock plunger
Zero lock sensor switch
Index 12
By Order of the Secretary of the Army: JOHN A. WICKHAM , JR. General, United States Army Chief of Staff Official : ROBERT M. JOYCE
Major General, United States Army The Adjutant General
Distribution :
To be distributed in accordance with DA Form 12-32 , Section III , Maintenance requirements for PATRIOT Missile System .
U.S. GOVERNMENT PRINTING OFFICE :
1984-746-036 : 3024
Organizational
RECOMMENDED CHANGES TO EQUIPMENT TECHNICAL PUBLICATIONS
SOMETHING
FL
33040
PUBLICATION TITLE Unit of Radar Set AN/MPQ- 50 Tested at the HFC
7 Sep 72
PIN-POINT WHERE IT IS
BE EXACT.
PAGE NO
Key West ,
DATE SENT 14 January 1979
PUBLICATION DATE
TM 9-1430-550-34-1
WITH THIS PUBLICATION ?
FROM: (PRINT YOUR UNIT'S COMPLETE ADDRESS) CDR, 1st Bn , 65th ADA ATTN : SP4 John Doe
THEN. JOT DOWN THE DOPE ABOUT IT ON THIS FORM, CAREFULLY TEAR IT OUT. FOLD IT AND DROP IT IN THE MAIL
PUBLICATION NUMBER
WRONG
PARAGRAPH
9-19
FIGURE NO
TABLE NO
IN THIS SPACE TELL WHAT IS WRONG AND WHAT SHOULD BE DONE ABOUT IT:
"B " Ready Relay K11 is shown with two # 9 contacts . That contact which is wired to pin 8 of relay K16
9-5
should be changed to contact # 10 .
21-2
21-2
step 1C
Reads :
Multimeter B indicates 600 K ohms to 9000
K ohms .
Change to read : minimum .
Multimeter B indicates 600 K ohms
Reason : Circuit being checked could measure infinity . Multimeter can read above 9000 K ohms and still be correct .
E L P
NOTE TO THE READER:
M A S
Your comments will go directly to the writer responsible for this manual, and he will prepare To help him in the reply that is returned to you. his evaluation of your recommendations , please explain the reason for each of your recommendations , unless the reason is obvious .
All comments will be appreciated, and will be given immediate attention. Handwritten comments are e abl accept .
For your convenience, blank " tear out " forms, preprinted, addressed, and ready to mail, are included in this manual .
PRINTED NAME. GRADE OR TITLE. AND TELEPHONE NUMBER
SIGN HERE
SP4 John Doe , Autovon 222-222
ORM79 2028-2 DA , F JUL
PREVIOUS EDITIONS ARE OBSOLETE .
PS --IF YOUR OUTFIT WANTS TO KNOW ABOUT YOUR RECOMMENDATION MAKE A CARBON COPY OF THIS AND GIVE IT TO YOUR HEADQUARTERS
C
RECOMMENDED CHANGES TO EQUIPMENT TECHNICAL PUBLICATIONS
SOMETHING
WRONG
WITH THIS PUBLICATION ?
FROM: (PRINT YOUR UNIT'S COMPLETE ADDRESS) THEN.. JOT DOWN THE DOPE ABOUT IT ON THIS FORM, CAREFULLY TEAR IT OUT, FOLD IT AND DROP IT IN THE MAIL!
PUBLICATION NUMBER
BE EXACT. PAGE NO
DATE SENT
PUBLICATION DATE
PUBLICATION TITLE
PIN-POINT WHERE IT IS PARAGRAPH
FIGURE NO
TABLE NO
IN THIS SPACE TELL WHAT IS WRONG AND WHAT SHOULD BE DONE ABOUT IT:
PRINTED NAME. GRADE OR TITLE , AND TELEPHONE NUMBER
DA1JFO RM 2028-2 UL79
PREVIOUS EDITIONS ARE OBSOLETE .
SIGN HERE.
P.S --IF YOUR OUTFIT WANTS TO KNOW ABOUT YOUR RECOMMENDATION MAKE A CARBON COPY OF THIS AND GIVE IT TO YOUR HEADQUARTERS
REVERSE OF DA FORM 2020-2
PERFORATED LINE ALONG TEAR
FILL IN YOUR UNIT'S ADDRESS
FOLD BACK DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY POSTAGE AND FEES PAID DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY DOD 314 U.S.MAIL OFFICIAL BUSINESS PENALTY FOR PRIVATE USE $300
Commander U. S. Army Missile Command DRSMI -SNPM ATTN : Redstone Arsenal , AL 35898
RECOMMENDED CHANGES TO EQUIPMENT TECHNICAL PUBLICATIONS
SOMETHING
WRONG
WITH THIS PUBLICATION ?
FROM: (PRINT YOUR UNIT'S COMPLETE ADDRESS)
THEN.. JOT DOWN THE DOPE ABOUT IT ON THIS FORM, CAREFULLY TEAR IT OUT. FOLD IT AND DROP IT IN THE MAIL!
PUBLICATION DATE
PUBLICATION NUMBER
BE EXACT. PAGE NO
DATE SENT
PUBLICATION TITLE
PIN-POINT WHERE IT IS
PARAGRAPH
FIGURE NO
TABLE NO
IN THIS SPACE TELL WHAT IS WRONG AND WHAT SHOULD BE DONE ABOUT IT:
PRINTED NAME, GRADE OR TITLE. AND TELEPHONE NUMBER
DA1, FORM JUL79 202 8-
2
PREVIOUS EDITIONS ARE OBSOLETE .
SIGN HERE
P.S --IF YOUR OUTFIT WANTS TO KNOW ABOUT YOUR RECOMMENDATION MAKE A CARBON COPY OF THIS AND GIVE IT TO YOUR HEADQUARTERS .
REVERSE OF DA FORM 2020-2
PERFORATED ALONG TEAR LINE
FILL IN YOUR UNIT'S ADDRESS
FOLD BACK DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY POSTAGE AND FEES PAID DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY DOD 314
USMAIL OFFICIAL BUSINESS PENALTY FOR PRIVATE USE $300
Commander
U. S. Army Missile Command DRSMI - SNPM ATTN : 35898 Redstone Arsenal , AL
IM -ID FBD
A SYSTEM DESCRIPTION PARAMETERS &DESIGNATIONS PAINTING &MARKING A GUIDE SOFTWARE USER AAB /ACA DISPLAY &CONTROL GROUP & COMPUTER CONTROL WEAPON /ACA AAA COMPUTER CCOMMAND &OORDINATION INTERLOCKS &POWER H , ARD UNIT CONTROL PERIPHERAL ,, ASS UNIT M STORAGE COPY C STORAGE & OMPUTER UNIT RECOVERY MAINTENANCE PANEL INPUT OUTPUT / UNIT CONTROL MONOLITHIC UNIT MEMORY A / CAA AAAA CENTRAL UNIT PROCESSOR A / BK AAE UNIT CONTROL INTERFACE RADAR /WEAPON / DAAACC DATA TERMINAL LINK AACA /ACCA X UNIT RROUTING INTERFACE / ADIO LOGIC /ACCB CB AA &M ODEMS COMMUNICATIONS -UHF ,V AAD ENGAGEMENT STATION CONTROL ABH SET RADAR ABA CONTROL UNIT INPUT OUTPUT / UNIT ABI UNIT INTERFACE MTR &X GEN TRIGGER GROUP & GROUP SYSTEM ANTENNA RADAR STEERING GROUP BEAM CONTROL UNIT ABF PROCESSOR ABC - XCITER ETRANSMITTER DTRANSMITTER &F- INAL AMPLIFIER RIVER ABD UNIT ABEA INPUT OUTPUT / CONTROL ABEB WAVEFORM GENERATOR ABEC EXPANSION PULSE ABEG END FRONT LENS END FRONT ABEK COMPARATOR RADAR IF T / RACK ABEE SEARCH RECEIVER ABEF GROUP CANCELLER LOBE SIDE PROCESSOR ECCM ABED ABEJ DIGITAL TRACK ABEM PROCESSOR ACTIVE -VIAMISSILE CORRELATION PROCESSORABEH ABEL POWER DC ABBA CONTROL O /UTPUT INPUT ABBB DIGITAL 1 PROCESSOR SIGNAL SIGNAL ABBC PROCESSOR 2SIGNAL DIGITAL PROCESSOR GROUP PROCESSOR 3&SIGNAL DIGITAL AB3D TESTS CROSSOVER ABG IFF SYSTEM ACD INFORMATION &COORDINATION CENTRAL AG ANTENNA GROUP MAST AFA CONTROL GROUP RELAY ROUND MISSILE AD STATION LAUNCHING SET LAUNCHING TEST STATION EQUIPMENT MBATTALION &AINTENANCE SUPPLY OPERATOR TRAINING DESTRUCTION
COVERAGE
XX
X
X 9-4935-600-14
9-1430-603-10 9-1430-604-10 9-1410-600-14 9-1440-600-10 9-4935-603-12
/-2 9-1430-602-20 9-1430-602-10-1 9-1430-803-20 9-1430-604-20 9-1410-600-14 9-1440-600-20 9-4935-603-12 9-4935-600-14 XXX XXXX
9-4935-600-14
9-1410-600-14
9-1430-601-34-23 9-1430-601-34-24
X X
9-1430-601-34-6 9-1430-601-34-7 9-1430-601-34-8 9-1430-601-34-9 9-1430-601-34-10 9-1430-601-34-11 9-1430-601-34-12 9-1430-601-34-13 9-1430-601-34-14 9-1430-601-34-15 9-1430-601-34-16 9-1430-601-34-17 9-1430-601-34-18 9-1430-601-34-19 9-1430-601-34-20 9-1430-601-34-21 9-1430-601-34-22
9-1430-601-34-5
9-1430-601-34-3 9-1430-601-34-4
9-1425-604-14-3 9-1425-604-14-4 9-1425-604-14-5 9-1425-605-14 9-1425-606-14 9-1425-607-14 9-1425-608-14
9-1425-604-14-3 9-1425-604-14-4 9-1425-604-14-5 9-1425-605-14 9-1425-606-14 9-1425-607-14 9-1425-608-14 9-1430-600-20 9-1430-600-10-1 /-2 9-1430-601-20 9-1430-601-10-1 /-2
9-1425-604-14-3 9-1425-604-14-4 9-1425-604-14-5 9-1425-605-14 9-1425-606-14 9-1425-607-14 9-1425-608-14
9-1425-604-14-2
9-1425-604-14-2
9-1425-604-14-2
9-1425-604-14-1
9-1425-604-14-1
9-1425-604-14-1
TX X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
X X
MANUALS PATRIOT
OTHER
9-1430-602-24P 9-1430-602-34-1 /-2 9-1430-603-24P /-2 9-1430-603-34-1 9-1430-604-34-1 9-1430-604-24P /-2 9-1410-600-24P LO9-1440-600-14 9-1440-600-24P 9-1440-600-34-1 /-2 9-4935-603-24P /-2 9-4935-603-34-1 9-4935-600-24P 9-6920-600-14 43-0002-23
LO9-1430-600-14 9-1430-600-24P /-2 9-1430-600-34-1 9-1430-601-34-1 -9-1430-601-24P / 2
ORGANIZATIONALINTERMEDIATE OPERATION & MAINTENANCE MAINTENANCE RPSTL MAINTENANCE ICC RS AMG CRG ECS MR BSME LS XXXXXXXX 9-1425-600-12 9-1425-600-12 9-1425-600-34 XXXXXXXX TB9-1425-600-14 TB9-1425-600-14 TB9-1425-600-14 XXXXXXXX 9-1425-601-14 9-1425-601-14 9-1425-601-14 9-1425-602-34 9-1425-602-12 9-1425-602-12 9-1425-603-14 9-1425-603-14 9-1425-603-14
MAJOR ITEMS
AAAC /A XCAC AAAB /AX XCAB XX X X X X XX XXX X X X X
CAD XX /A AAAD
XX /ACAE AAAE
XX XX
X